comparison etc/NEWS @ 90428:a8190f7e546e

Merge from emacs--devo--0 Patches applied: * emacs--devo--0 (patch 285-296) - Update from CVS - Merge from gnus--rel--5.10 - Update from CVS: admin/FOR-RELEASE: Update refcard section. * gnus--rel--5.10 (patch 102-104) - Update from CVS Revision: emacs@sv.gnu.org/emacs--unicode--0--patch-64
author Miles Bader <miles@gnu.org>
date Wed, 07 Jun 2006 18:05:10 +0000
parents a5812696f7bf 2f0ef040dfe3
children 138027c8c982
comparison
equal deleted inserted replaced
90427:ddb25860d044 90428:a8190f7e546e
1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2003-05-21 1 GNU Emacs NEWS -- history of user-visible changes. 2006-06-04
2 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006 2 Copyright (C) 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
3 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 3 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 See the end for copying conditions. 4 See the end for copying conditions.
5 5
6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org. 6 Please send Emacs bug reports to bug-gnu-emacs@gnu.org.
7 For older news, see the file ONEWS 7 If possible, use M-x report-emacs-bug.
8 You can narrow news to the specific version by calling 8
9 `view-emacs-news' with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n. 9 This file is about changes in emacs version 22.
10
11 See files NEWS.21, NEWS.20, NEWS.19, NEWS.18, and NEWS.1-17 for changes
12 in older emacs versions.
13
14 You can narrow news to a specific version by calling `view-emacs-news'
15 with a prefix argument or by typing C-u C-h C-n.
10 16
11 Temporary note: 17 Temporary note:
12 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated. 18 +++ indicates that the appropriate manual has already been updated.
13 --- means no change in the manuals is called for. 19 --- means no change in the manuals is called for.
14 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or --- 20 When you add a new item, please add it without either +++ or ---
145 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian. 151 with simplified and traditional characters), French, and Italian.
146 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup 152 Type `C-u C-h t' to choose one of them in case your language setup
147 doesn't automatically select the right one. 153 doesn't automatically select the right one.
148 154
149 --- 155 ---
156 ** A Portuguese translation of Emacs' reference card has been added.
157 Its name is `pt-br-refcard.tex'. The corresponding PostScript file is
158 also included.
159
160
161 ---
150 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available. 162 ** A French translation of the `Emacs Survival Guide' is available.
151 163
152 --- 164 ---
153 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand. 165 ** Emacs now includes support for loading image libraries on demand.
154 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure 166 (Currently this feature is only used on MS Windows.) You can configure
826 it remains unchanged. 838 it remains unchanged.
827 839
828 +++ 840 +++
829 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'. 841 *** New user option `history-delete-duplicates'.
830 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical 842 If set to t when adding a new history element, all previous identical
831 elements are deleted. 843 elements are deleted from the history list.
832 844
833 ** Redisplay changes: 845 ** Redisplay changes:
834 846
835 +++ 847 +++
836 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode. 848 *** The mode line position information now comes before the major mode.
1055 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'. 1067 disabled by customizing the variable `use-file-dialog'.
1056 1068
1057 --- 1069 ---
1058 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can 1070 *** The pop up menus for Lucid now stay up if you do a fast click and can
1059 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32). 1071 be navigated with the arrow keys (like Gtk+, Mac and W32).
1072
1073 +++
1074 *** The menu bar for Motif/Lesstif/Lucid/Gtk+ can be navigated with keys.
1075 Pressing F10 shows the first menu in the menu bar. Navigation is done with
1076 the arrow keys, select with the return key and cancel with the escape keys.
1060 1077
1061 +++ 1078 +++
1062 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have 1079 *** The Lucid menus can display multilingual text in your locale. You have
1063 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example 1080 to explicitly specify a fontSet resource for this to work, for example
1064 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'. 1081 `-xrm "Emacs*fontSet: -*-helvetica-medium-r-*--*-120-*-*-*-*-*-*,*"'.
1145 1162
1146 +++ 1163 +++
1147 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default. 1164 *** Under X, mouse-wheel-mode is turned on by default.
1148 1165
1149 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes: 1166 ** Multilingual Environment (Mule) changes:
1167
1168 *** You can disable character translation for a file using the -*-
1169 construct. Include `enable-character-translation: nil' inside the
1170 -*-...-*- to disable any character translation that may happen by
1171 various global and per-coding-system translation tables. You can also
1172 specify it in a local variable list at the end of the file. For
1173 shortcut, instead of using this long variable name, you can append the
1174 character "!" at the end of coding-system name specified in -*-
1175 construct or in a local variable list. For example, if a file has the
1176 following header, it is decoded by the coding system `iso-latin-1'
1177 without any character translation:
1178 ;; -*- coding: iso-latin-1!; -*-
1150 1179
1151 --- 1180 ---
1152 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup 1181 *** Language environment and various default coding systems are setup
1153 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale 1182 more correctly according to the current locale name. If the locale
1154 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines. 1183 name doesn't specify a charset, the default is what glibc defines.
1366 +++ 1395 +++
1367 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps 1396 *** New Dired command `dired-do-touch' (bound to T) changes timestamps
1368 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer. 1397 of marked files with the value entered in the minibuffer.
1369 1398
1370 +++ 1399 +++
1400 *** The Dired command `dired-goto-file' is now bound to j, not M-g.
1401 This is to avoid hiding the global key binding of M-g.
1402
1403 +++
1371 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now 1404 *** In Dired's ! command (dired-do-shell-command), `*' and `?' now
1372 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded 1405 control substitution of the file names only when they are surrounded
1373 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards 1406 by whitespace. This means you can now use them as shell wildcards
1374 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the 1407 too. If you want to use just plain `*' as a wildcard, type `*""'; the
1375 double quotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent 1408 double quotes make no difference in the shell, but they prevent
1376 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'. 1409 special treatment in `dired-do-shell-command'.
1377 1410
1378 +++ 1411 +++
1379 *** In Dired, the w command now copies the current line's file name 1412 *** In Dired, the w command now stores the current line's file name
1380 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, copies absolute file names. 1413 into the kill ring. With a zero prefix arg, it stores the absolute file name.
1381 1414
1382 +++ 1415 +++
1383 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode. 1416 *** In Dired-x, Omitting files is now a minor mode, dired-omit-mode.
1384 1417
1385 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command 1418 The mode toggling command is bound to M-o. A new command
2055 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme 2088 (`scheme-expand-current-form'). The commands actually sent to the Scheme
2056 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command', 2089 subprocess are controlled by the user options `scheme-trace-command',
2057 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'. 2090 `scheme-untrace-command' and `scheme-expand-current-form'.
2058 2091
2059 --- 2092 ---
2060 ** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp, BSD make and imake. 2093 ** Changes in Makefile mode
2094
2095 *** Makefile mode has submodes for automake, gmake, makepp, BSD make and imake.
2061 2096
2062 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter three 2097 The former two couldn't be differentiated before, and the latter three
2063 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable 2098 are new. Font-locking is robust now and offers new customizable
2064 faces. 2099 faces.
2100
2101 *** The variable `makefile-query-one-target-method' has been renamed
2102 to `makefile-query-one-target-method-function'. The old name is still
2103 available as alias.
2065 2104
2066 +++ 2105 +++
2067 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top 2106 ** In Outline mode, `hide-body' no longer hides lines at the top
2068 of the file that precede the first header line. 2107 of the file that precede the first header line.
2069 2108
2676 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style, 2715 When this option is enabled, SGML tags are inserted in XML style,
2677 i.e., there is always a closing tag. 2716 i.e., there is always a closing tag.
2678 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis 2717 By default, its setting is inferred on a buffer-by-buffer basis
2679 from the file name or buffer contents. 2718 from the file name or buffer contents.
2680 2719
2720 *** The variable `sgml-transformation' has been renamed to
2721 `sgml-transformation-function'. The old name is still available as
2722 alias.
2723
2681 +++ 2724 +++
2682 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support. 2725 *** `xml-mode' is now an alias for `sgml-mode', which has XML support.
2683 2726
2684 ** TeX modes: 2727 ** TeX modes:
2685 2728
2752 *** The variables `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert' and 2795 *** The variables `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert' and
2753 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert' have been renamed to 2796 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert' have been renamed to
2754 `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert-function' and 2797 `bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert-function' and
2755 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert-function'. The old names are 2798 `bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert-function'. The old names are
2756 still available as aliases. 2799 still available as aliases.
2800
2801 ** In Artist mode the variable `artist-text-renderer' has been
2802 renamed to `artist-text-renderer-function'. The old name is still
2803 available as alias.
2757 2804
2758 +++ 2805 +++
2759 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now 2806 ** In Enriched mode, `set-left-margin' and `set-right-margin' are now
2760 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l' 2807 by default bound to `C-c [' and `C-c ]' instead of the former `C-c C-l'
2761 and `C-c C-r'. 2808 and `C-c C-r'.
3364 3411
3365 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS 3412 C-x C-f passes the file name to `find-file' with non-nil WILDCARDS
3366 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'. 3413 argument, which visits multiple files, and C-x d passes it to `dired'.
3367 3414
3368 --- 3415 ---
3369 ** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction. 3416 ** Changes in Skeleton
3417
3418 *** In skeleton.el, `-' marks the `skeleton-point' without interregion interaction.
3370 3419
3371 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer 3420 `@' has reverted to only setting `skeleton-positions' and no longer
3372 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark 3421 sets `skeleton-point'. Skeletons which used @ to mark
3373 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The 3422 `skeleton-point' independent of `_' should now use `-' instead. The
3374 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along 3423 updated `skeleton-insert' docstring explains these new features along
3375 with other details of skeleton construction. 3424 with other details of skeleton construction.
3376 3425
3426 *** The variables `skeleton-transformation', `skeleton-filter', and
3427 `skeleton-pair-filter' have been renamed to
3428 `skeleton-transformation-function', `skeleton-filter-function', and
3429 `skeleton-pair-filter-function'. The old names are still available
3430 as aliases.
3431
3377 --- 3432 ---
3378 ** Hideshow mode changes 3433 ** Hideshow mode changes
3379 3434
3380 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay 3435 *** New variable `hs-set-up-overlay' allows customization of the overlay
3381 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch 3436 used to effect hiding for hideshow minor mode. Integration with isearch
3481 --- 3536 ---
3482 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead. 3537 ** iso-acc.el is now obsolete. Use one of the latin input methods instead.
3483 3538
3484 --- 3539 ---
3485 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted. 3540 ** cplus-md.el has been deleted.
3541
3542 ** Ewoc changes
3543
3544 *** The new function `ewoc-delete' deletes specified nodes.
3545
3546 *** `ewoc-create' now takes optional arg NOSEP, which inhibits insertion of
3547 a newline after each pretty-printed entry and after the header and footer.
3548 This allows you to create multiple-entry ewocs on a single line and to
3549 effect "invisible" nodes by arranging for the pretty-printer to not print
3550 anything for those nodes.
3551
3552 For example, these two sequences of expressions behave identically:
3553
3554 ;; NOSEP nil
3555 (defun PP (data) (insert (format "%S" data)))
3556 (ewoc-create 'PP "start\n")
3557
3558 ;; NOSEP t
3559 (defun PP (data) (insert (format "%S\n" data)))
3560 (ewoc-create 'PP "start\n\n" "\n" t)
3561
3486 3562
3487 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems 3563 * Changes in Emacs 22.1 on non-free operating systems
3488 3564
3489 +++ 3565 +++
3490 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile. 3566 ** The HOME directory defaults to Application Data under the user profile.
3598 ** The variable `mac-command-key-is-meta' is obsolete. Use 3674 ** The variable `mac-command-key-is-meta' is obsolete. Use
3599 `mac-command-modifier' and `mac-option-modifier' instead. 3675 `mac-command-modifier' and `mac-option-modifier' instead.
3600 3676
3601 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1 3677 * Incompatible Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3602 3678
3679 ** The function find-operation-coding-system accepts a cons (FILENAME
3680 . BUFFER) in an argument correponding to the target.
3681
3603 --- 3682 ---
3604 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have 3683 ** The variables post-command-idle-hook and post-command-idle-delay have
3605 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead. 3684 been removed. Use run-with-idle-timer instead.
3606 3685
3607 +++ 3686 +++
3628 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed. 3707 ** Support for Mocklisp has been removed.
3629 3708
3630 +++ 3709 +++
3631 ** The variable `memory-full' now remains t until 3710 ** The variable `memory-full' now remains t until
3632 there is no longer a shortage of memory. 3711 there is no longer a shortage of memory.
3712
3633 3713
3634 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1 3714 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 22.1
3635 3715
3636 ** General Lisp changes: 3716 ** General Lisp changes:
3637 3717
4274 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now 4354 *** Functions `file-name-sans-extension' and `file-name-extension' now
4275 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as 4355 ignore the leading dots in file names, so that file names such as
4276 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless. 4356 `.emacs' are treated as extensionless.
4277 4357
4278 +++ 4358 +++
4279 *** `copy-file' now takes an additional option arg MUSTBENEW.
4280
4281 This argument works like the MUSTBENEW argument of write-file.
4282
4283 +++
4284 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return 4359 *** `visited-file-modtime' and `calendar-time-from-absolute' now return
4285 a list of two integers, instead of a cons. 4360 a list of two integers, instead of a cons.
4286 4361
4287 +++ 4362 +++
4288 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which 4363 *** `file-chase-links' now takes an optional second argument LIMIT which
4372 +++ 4447 +++
4373 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which 4448 *** New function `minibuffer-selected-window' returns the window which
4374 was selected when entering the minibuffer. 4449 was selected when entering the minibuffer.
4375 4450
4376 +++ 4451 +++
4377 *** `read-from-minibuffer' now accepts an additional argument KEEP-ALL
4378 saying to put all inputs in the history list, even empty ones.
4379
4380 +++
4381 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which 4452 *** The `read-file-name' function now takes an additional argument which
4382 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satisfy. The 4453 specifies a predicate which the file name read must satisfy. The
4383 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument 4454 new variable `read-file-name-predicate' contains the predicate argument
4384 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this 4455 while reading the file name from the minibuffer; the predicate in this
4385 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list. 4456 variable is used by read-file-name-internal to filter the completion list.
4396 +++ 4467 +++
4397 *** The new function `read-directory-name' is for reading a directory name. 4468 *** The new function `read-directory-name' is for reading a directory name.
4398 4469
4399 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better 4470 It is like `read-file-name' except that the defaulting works better
4400 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories. 4471 for directories, and completion inside it shows only directories.
4472
4473 +++
4474 *** The new variable `history-add-new-input' specifies whether to add new
4475 elements in history. If set to nil, minibuffer reading functions don't
4476 add new elements to the history list, so it is possible to do this
4477 afterwards by calling `add-to-history' explicitly.
4401 4478
4402 ** Completion changes: 4479 ** Completion changes:
4403 4480
4404 +++ 4481 +++
4405 *** The new function `minibuffer-completion-contents' returns the contents 4482 *** The new function `minibuffer-completion-contents' returns the contents
5670 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a 5747 help out the test coverage tool. The macro `noreturn' suppresses a
5671 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does 5748 red splotch. It is an error if the argument to `noreturn' does
5672 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument. 5749 return. The macro `1value' suppresses a brown splotch for its argument.
5673 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals 5750 This macro is a no-op except during test-coverage -- then it signals
5674 an error if the argument actually returns differing values. 5751 an error if the argument actually returns differing values.
5752
5753
5675 5754
5676 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.3
5677
5678 ** Support for GNU/Linux on little-endian MIPS and on IBM S390 has
5679 been added.
5680
5681
5682 * Changes in Emacs 21.3
5683
5684 ** The obsolete C mode (c-mode.el) has been removed to avoid problems
5685 with Custom.
5686
5687 ** UTF-16 coding systems are available, encoding the same characters
5688 as mule-utf-8.
5689
5690 ** There is a new language environment for UTF-8 (set up automatically
5691 in UTF-8 locales).
5692
5693 ** Translation tables are available between equivalent characters in
5694 different Emacs charsets -- for instance `e with acute' coming from the
5695 Latin-1 and Latin-2 charsets. User options `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode'
5696 and `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' respectively turn on translation
5697 between ISO 8859 character sets (`unification') on encoding
5698 (e.g. writing a file) and decoding (e.g. reading a file). Note that
5699 `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is useful and safe, but
5700 `unify-8859-on-decoding-mode' can cause text to change when you read
5701 it and write it out again without edits, so it is not generally advisable.
5702 By default `unify-8859-on-encoding-mode' is turned on.
5703
5704 ** In Emacs running on the X window system, the default value of
5705 `selection-coding-system' is now `compound-text-with-extensions'.
5706
5707 If you want the old behavior, set selection-coding-system to
5708 compound-text, which may be significantly more efficient. Using
5709 compound-text-with-extensions seems to be necessary only for decoding
5710 text from applications under XFree86 4.2, whose behavior is actually
5711 contrary to the compound text specification.
5712
5713
5714 * Installation changes in Emacs 21.2
5715
5716 ** Support for BSD/OS 5.0 has been added.
5717
5718 ** Support for AIX 5.1 was added.
5719
5720
5721 * Changes in Emacs 21.2
5722
5723 ** Emacs now supports compound-text extended segments in X selections.
5724
5725 X applications can use `extended segments' to encode characters in
5726 compound text that belong to character sets which are not part of the
5727 list of approved standard encodings for X, e.g. Big5. To paste
5728 selections with such characters into Emacs, use the new coding system
5729 compound-text-with-extensions as the value of selection-coding-system.
5730
5731 ** The default values of `tooltip-delay' and `tooltip-hide-delay'
5732 were changed.
5733
5734 ** On terminals whose erase-char is ^H (Backspace), Emacs
5735 now uses normal-erase-is-backspace-mode.
5736
5737 ** When the *scratch* buffer is recreated, its mode is set from
5738 initial-major-mode, which normally is lisp-interaction-mode,
5739 instead of using default-major-mode.
5740
5741 ** The new option `Info-scroll-prefer-subnodes' causes Info to behave
5742 like the stand-alone Info reader (from the GNU Texinfo package) as far
5743 as motion between nodes and their subnodes is concerned. If it is t
5744 (the default), Emacs behaves as before when you type SPC in a menu: it
5745 visits the subnode pointed to by the first menu entry. If this option
5746 is nil, SPC scrolls to the end of the current node, and only then goes
5747 to the first menu item, like the stand-alone reader does.
5748
5749 This change was already in Emacs 21.1, but wasn't advertised in the
5750 NEWS.
5751
5752
5753 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 21.2
5754
5755 ** The meanings of scroll-up-aggressively and scroll-down-aggressively
5756 have been interchanged, so that the former now controls scrolling up,
5757 and the latter now controls scrolling down.
5758
5759 ** The variable `compilation-parse-errors-filename-function' can
5760 be used to transform filenames found in compilation output.
5761
5762
5763 * Installation Changes in Emacs 21.1
5764
5765 See the INSTALL file for information on installing extra libraries and
5766 fonts to take advantage of the new graphical features and extra
5767 charsets in this release.
5768
5769 ** Support for GNU/Linux on IA64 machines has been added.
5770
5771 ** Support for LynxOS has been added.
5772
5773 ** There are new configure options associated with the support for
5774 images and toolkit scrollbars. Use the --help option in `configure'
5775 to list them.
5776
5777 ** You can build a 64-bit Emacs for SPARC/Solaris systems which
5778 support 64-bit executables and also on Irix 6.5. This increases the
5779 maximum buffer size. See etc/MACHINES for instructions. Changes to
5780 build on other 64-bit systems should be straightforward modulo any
5781 necessary changes to unexec.
5782
5783 ** There is a new configure option `--disable-largefile' to omit
5784 Unix-98-style support for large files if that is available.
5785
5786 ** There is a new configure option `--without-xim' that instructs
5787 Emacs to not use X Input Methods (XIM), if these are available.
5788
5789 ** `movemail' defaults to supporting POP. You can turn this off using
5790 the --without-pop configure option, should that be necessary.
5791
5792 ** This version can be built for the Macintosh, but does not implement
5793 all of the new display features described below. The port currently
5794 lacks unexec, asynchronous processes, and networking support. See the
5795 "Emacs and the Mac OS" appendix in the Emacs manual, for the
5796 description of aspects specific to the Mac.
5797
5798 ** Note that the MS-Windows port does not yet implement various of the
5799 new display features described below.
5800
5801
5802 * Changes in Emacs 21.1
5803
5804 ** Emacs has a new redisplay engine.
5805
5806 The new redisplay handles characters of variable width and height.
5807 Italic text can be used without redisplay problems. Fonts containing
5808 oversized characters, i.e. characters larger than the logical height
5809 of a font can be used. Images of various formats can be displayed in
5810 the text.
5811
5812 ** Emacs has a new face implementation.
5813
5814 The new faces no longer fundamentally use X font names to specify the
5815 font. Instead, each face has several independent attributes--family,
5816 height, width, weight and slant--that it may or may not specify.
5817 These attributes can be merged from various faces, and then together
5818 specify a font.
5819
5820 Faces are supported on terminals that can display color or fonts.
5821 These terminal capabilities are auto-detected. Details can be found
5822 under Lisp changes, below.
5823
5824 ** Emacs can display faces on TTY frames.
5825
5826 Emacs automatically detects terminals that are able to display colors.
5827 Faces with a weight greater than normal are displayed extra-bright, if
5828 the terminal supports it. Faces with a weight less than normal and
5829 italic faces are displayed dimmed, if the terminal supports it.
5830 Underlined faces are displayed underlined if possible. Other face
5831 attributes such as `overline', `strike-through', and `box' are ignored
5832 on terminals.
5833
5834 The command-line options `-fg COLOR', `-bg COLOR', and `-rv' are now
5835 supported on character terminals.
5836
5837 Emacs automatically remaps all X-style color specifications to one of
5838 the colors supported by the terminal. This means you could have the
5839 same color customizations that work both on a windowed display and on
5840 a TTY or when Emacs is invoked with the -nw option.
5841
5842 ** New default font is Courier 12pt under X.
5843
5844 ** Sound support
5845
5846 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and FreeBSD (Voxware
5847 driver and native BSD driver, a.k.a. Luigi's driver). Currently
5848 supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio (*.au).
5849 You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes' to enable
5850 sound support.
5851
5852 ** Emacs now resizes mini-windows if appropriate.
5853
5854 If a message is longer than one line, or minibuffer contents are
5855 longer than one line, Emacs can resize the minibuffer window unless it
5856 is on a frame of its own. You can control resizing and the maximum
5857 minibuffer window size by setting the following variables:
5858
5859 - User option: max-mini-window-height
5860
5861 Maximum height for resizing mini-windows. If a float, it specifies a
5862 fraction of the mini-window frame's height. If an integer, it
5863 specifies a number of lines.
5864
5865 Default is 0.25.
5866
5867 - User option: resize-mini-windows
5868
5869 How to resize mini-windows. If nil, don't resize. If t, always
5870 resize to fit the size of the text. If `grow-only', let mini-windows
5871 grow only, until they become empty, at which point they are shrunk
5872 again.
5873
5874 Default is `grow-only'.
5875
5876 ** LessTif support.
5877
5878 Emacs now runs with the LessTif toolkit (see
5879 <http://www.lesstif.org>). You will need version 0.92.26, or later.
5880
5881 ** LessTif/Motif file selection dialog.
5882
5883 When Emacs is configured to use LessTif or Motif, reading a file name
5884 from a menu will pop up a file selection dialog if `use-dialog-box' is
5885 non-nil.
5886
5887 ** File selection dialog on MS-Windows is supported.
5888
5889 When a file is visited by clicking File->Open, the MS-Windows version
5890 now pops up a standard file selection dialog where you can select a
5891 file to visit. File->Save As also pops up that dialog.
5892
5893 ** Toolkit scroll bars.
5894
5895 Emacs now uses toolkit scroll bars if available. When configured for
5896 LessTif/Motif, it will use that toolkit's scroll bar. Otherwise, when
5897 configured for Lucid and Athena widgets, it will use the Xaw3d scroll
5898 bar if Xaw3d is available. You can turn off the use of toolkit scroll
5899 bars by specifying `--with-toolkit-scroll-bars=no' when configuring
5900 Emacs.
5901
5902 When you encounter problems with the Xaw3d scroll bar, watch out how
5903 Xaw3d is compiled on your system. If the Makefile generated from
5904 Xaw3d's Imakefile contains a `-DNARROWPROTO' compiler option, and your
5905 Emacs system configuration file `s/your-system.h' does not contain a
5906 define for NARROWPROTO, you might consider adding it. Take
5907 `s/freebsd.h' as an example.
5908
5909 Alternatively, if you don't have access to the Xaw3d source code, take
5910 a look at your system's imake configuration file, for example in the
5911 directory `/usr/X11R6/lib/X11/config' (paths are different on
5912 different systems). You will find files `*.cf' there. If your
5913 system's cf-file contains a line like `#define NeedWidePrototypes NO',
5914 add a `#define NARROWPROTO' to your Emacs system configuration file.
5915
5916 The reason for this is that one Xaw3d function uses `double' or
5917 `float' function parameters depending on the setting of NARROWPROTO.
5918 This is not a problem when Imakefiles are used because each system's
5919 imake configuration file contains the necessary information. Since
5920 Emacs doesn't use imake, this has do be done manually.
5921
5922 ** Tool bar support.
5923
5924 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. For details
5925 of how to define a tool bar, see the page describing Lisp-level
5926 changes. Tool-bar global minor mode controls whether or not it is
5927 displayed and is on by default. The appearance of the bar is improved
5928 if Emacs has been built with XPM image support. Otherwise monochrome
5929 icons will be used.
5930
5931 To make the tool bar more useful, we need contributions of extra icons
5932 for specific modes (with copyright assignments).
5933
5934 ** Tooltips.
5935
5936 Tooltips are small X windows displaying a help string at the current
5937 mouse position. The Lisp package `tooltip' implements them. You can
5938 turn them off via the user option `tooltip-mode'.
5939
5940 Tooltips also provides support for GUD debugging. If activated,
5941 variable values can be displayed in tooltips by pointing at them with
5942 the mouse in source buffers. You can customize various aspects of the
5943 tooltip display in the group `tooltip'.
5944
5945 ** Automatic Hscrolling
5946
5947 Horizontal scrolling now happens automatically if
5948 `automatic-hscrolling' is set (the default). This setting can be
5949 customized.
5950
5951 If a window is scrolled horizontally with set-window-hscroll, or
5952 scroll-left/scroll-right (C-x <, C-x >), this serves as a lower bound
5953 for automatic horizontal scrolling. Automatic scrolling will scroll
5954 the text more to the left if necessary, but won't scroll the text more
5955 to the right than the column set with set-window-hscroll etc.
5956
5957 ** When using a windowing terminal, each Emacs window now has a cursor
5958 of its own. By default, when a window is selected, the cursor is
5959 solid; otherwise, it is hollow. The user-option
5960 `cursor-in-non-selected-windows' controls how to display the
5961 cursor in non-selected windows. If nil, no cursor is shown, if
5962 non-nil a hollow box cursor is shown.
5963
5964 ** Fringes to the left and right of windows are used to display
5965 truncation marks, continuation marks, overlay arrows and alike. The
5966 foreground, background, and stipple of these areas can be changed by
5967 customizing face `fringe'.
5968
5969 ** The mode line under X is now drawn with shadows by default.
5970 You can change its appearance by modifying the face `mode-line'.
5971 In particular, setting the `:box' attribute to nil turns off the 3D
5972 appearance of the mode line. (The 3D appearance makes the mode line
5973 occupy more space, and thus might cause the first or the last line of
5974 the window to be partially obscured.)
5975
5976 The variable `mode-line-inverse-video', which was used in older
5977 versions of emacs to make the mode-line stand out, is now deprecated.
5978 However, setting it to nil will cause the `mode-line' face to be
5979 ignored, and mode-lines to be drawn using the default text face.
5980
5981 ** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
5982
5983 Different parts of the mode line have been made mouse-sensitive on all
5984 systems which support the mouse. Moving the mouse to a
5985 mouse-sensitive part in the mode line changes the appearance of the
5986 mouse pointer to an arrow, and help about available mouse actions is
5987 displayed either in the echo area, or in the tooltip window if you
5988 have enabled one.
5989
5990 Currently, the following actions have been defined:
5991
5992 - Mouse-1 on the buffer name in the mode line goes to the next buffer.
5993
5994 - Mouse-3 on the buffer-name goes to the previous buffer.
5995
5996 - Mouse-2 on the read-only or modified status in the mode line (`%' or
5997 `*') toggles the status.
5998
5999 - Mouse-3 on the major mode name displays a major mode menu.
6000
6001 - Mouse-3 on the mode name displays a minor-mode menu.
6002
6003 ** Hourglass pointer
6004
6005 Emacs can optionally display an hourglass pointer under X. You can
6006 turn the display on or off by customizing group `cursor'.
6007
6008 ** Blinking cursor
6009
6010 M-x blink-cursor-mode toggles a blinking cursor under X and on
6011 terminals having terminal capabilities `vi', `vs', and `ve'. Blinking
6012 and related parameters like frequency and delay can be customized in
6013 the group `cursor'.
6014
6015 ** New font-lock support mode `jit-lock-mode'.
6016
6017 This support mode is roughly equivalent to `lazy-lock' but is
6018 generally faster. It supports stealth and deferred fontification.
6019 See the documentation of the function `jit-lock-mode' for more
6020 details.
6021
6022 Font-lock uses jit-lock-mode as default support mode, so you don't
6023 have to do anything to activate it.
6024
6025 ** The default binding of the Delete key has changed.
6026
6027 The new user-option `normal-erase-is-backspace' can be set to
6028 determine the effect of the Delete and Backspace function keys.
6029
6030 On window systems, the default value of this option is chosen
6031 according to the keyboard used. If the keyboard has both a Backspace
6032 key and a Delete key, and both are mapped to their usual meanings, the
6033 option's default value is set to t, so that Backspace can be used to
6034 delete backward, and Delete can be used to delete forward. On
6035 keyboards which either have only one key (usually labeled DEL), or two
6036 keys DEL and BS which produce the same effect, the option's value is
6037 set to nil, and these keys delete backward.
6038
6039 If not running under a window system, setting this option accomplishes
6040 a similar effect by mapping C-h, which is usually generated by the
6041 Backspace key, to DEL, and by mapping DEL to C-d via
6042 `keyboard-translate'. The former functionality of C-h is available on
6043 the F1 key. You should probably not use this setting on a text-only
6044 terminal if you don't have both Backspace, Delete and F1 keys.
6045
6046 Programmatically, you can call function normal-erase-is-backspace-mode
6047 to toggle the behavior of the Delete and Backspace keys.
6048
6049 ** The default for user-option `next-line-add-newlines' has been
6050 changed to nil, i.e. C-n will no longer add newlines at the end of a
6051 buffer by default.
6052
6053 ** The <home> and <end> keys now move to the beginning or end of the
6054 current line, respectively. C-<home> and C-<end> move to the
6055 beginning and end of the buffer.
6056
6057 ** Emacs now checks for recursive loads of Lisp files. If the
6058 recursion depth exceeds `recursive-load-depth-limit', an error is
6059 signaled.
6060
6061 ** When an error is signaled during the loading of the user's init
6062 file, Emacs now pops up the *Messages* buffer.
6063
6064 ** Emacs now refuses to load compiled Lisp files which weren't
6065 compiled with Emacs. Set `load-dangerous-libraries' to t to change
6066 this behavior.
6067
6068 The reason for this change is an incompatible change in XEmacs's byte
6069 compiler. Files compiled with XEmacs can contain byte codes that let
6070 Emacs dump core.
6071
6072 ** Toggle buttons and radio buttons in menus.
6073
6074 When compiled with LessTif (or Motif) support, Emacs uses toolkit
6075 widgets for radio and toggle buttons in menus. When configured for
6076 Lucid, Emacs draws radio buttons and toggle buttons similar to Motif.
6077
6078 ** The menu bar configuration has changed. The new configuration is
6079 more CUA-compliant. The most significant change is that Options is
6080 now a separate menu-bar item, with Mule and Customize as its submenus.
6081
6082 ** Item Save Options on the Options menu allows saving options set
6083 using that menu.
6084
6085 ** Highlighting of trailing whitespace.
6086
6087 When `show-trailing-whitespace' is non-nil, Emacs displays trailing
6088 whitespace in the face `trailing-whitespace'. Trailing whitespace is
6089 defined as spaces or tabs at the end of a line. To avoid busy
6090 highlighting when entering new text, trailing whitespace is not
6091 displayed if point is at the end of the line containing the
6092 whitespace.
6093
6094 ** C-x 5 1 runs the new command delete-other-frames which deletes
6095 all frames except the selected one.
6096
6097 ** The new user-option `confirm-kill-emacs' can be customized to
6098 let Emacs ask for confirmation before exiting.
6099
6100 ** The header line in an Info buffer is now displayed as an emacs
6101 header-line (which is like a mode-line, but at the top of the window),
6102 so that it remains visible even when the buffer has been scrolled.
6103 This behavior may be disabled by customizing the option
6104 `Info-use-header-line'.
6105
6106 ** Polish, Czech, German, and French translations of Emacs' reference card
6107 have been added. They are named `pl-refcard.tex', `cs-refcard.tex',
6108 `de-refcard.tex' and `fr-refcard.tex'. Postscript files are included.
6109
6110 ** An `Emacs Survival Guide', etc/survival.tex, is available.
6111
6112 ** A reference card for Dired has been added. Its name is
6113 `dired-ref.tex'. A French translation is available in
6114 `fr-drdref.tex'.
6115
6116 ** C-down-mouse-3 is bound differently. Now if the menu bar is not
6117 displayed it pops up a menu containing the items which would be on the
6118 menu bar. If the menu bar is displayed, it pops up the major mode
6119 menu or the Edit menu if there is no major mode menu.
6120
6121 ** Variable `load-path' is no longer customizable through Customize.
6122
6123 You can no longer use `M-x customize-variable' to customize `load-path'
6124 because it now contains a version-dependent component. You can still
6125 use `add-to-list' and `setq' to customize this variable in your
6126 `~/.emacs' init file or to modify it from any Lisp program in general.
6127
6128 ** C-u C-x = provides detailed information about the character at
6129 point in a pop-up window.
6130
6131 ** Emacs can now support 'wheeled' mice (such as the MS IntelliMouse)
6132 under XFree86. To enable this, use the `mouse-wheel-mode' command, or
6133 customize the variable `mouse-wheel-mode'.
6134
6135 The variables `mouse-wheel-follow-mouse' and `mouse-wheel-scroll-amount'
6136 determine where and by how much buffers are scrolled.
6137
6138 ** Emacs' auto-save list files are now by default stored in a
6139 sub-directory `.emacs.d/auto-save-list/' of the user's home directory.
6140 (On MS-DOS, this subdirectory's name is `_emacs.d/auto-save.list/'.)
6141 You can customize `auto-save-list-file-prefix' to change this location.
6142
6143 ** The function `getenv' is now callable interactively.
6144
6145 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
6146 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
6147
6148 ** The new command M-x delete-trailing-whitespace RET will delete the
6149 trailing whitespace within the current restriction. You can also add
6150 this function to `write-file-hooks' or `local-write-file-hooks'.
6151
6152 ** When visiting a file with M-x find-file-literally, no newlines will
6153 be added to the end of the buffer even if `require-final-newline' is
6154 non-nil.
6155
6156 ** The new user-option `find-file-suppress-same-file-warnings' can be
6157 set to suppress warnings ``X and Y are the same file'' when visiting a
6158 file that is already visited under a different name.
6159
6160 ** The new user-option `electric-help-shrink-window' can be set to
6161 nil to prevent adjusting the help window size to the buffer size.
6162
6163 ** New command M-x describe-character-set reads a character set name
6164 and displays information about that.
6165
6166 ** The new variable `auto-mode-interpreter-regexp' contains a regular
6167 expression matching interpreters, for file mode determination.
6168
6169 This regular expression is matched against the first line of a file to
6170 determine the file's mode in `set-auto-mode' when Emacs can't deduce a
6171 mode from the file's name. If it matches, the file is assumed to be
6172 interpreted by the interpreter matched by the second group of the
6173 regular expression. The mode is then determined as the mode
6174 associated with that interpreter in `interpreter-mode-alist'.
6175
6176 ** New function executable-make-buffer-file-executable-if-script-p is
6177 suitable as an after-save-hook as an alternative to `executable-chmod'.
6178
6179 ** The most preferred coding-system is now used to save a buffer if
6180 buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and it is safe for the buffer
6181 contents. (The most preferred is set by set-language-environment or
6182 by M-x prefer-coding-system.) Thus if you visit an ASCII file and
6183 insert a non-ASCII character from your current language environment,
6184 the file will be saved silently with the appropriate coding.
6185 Previously you would be prompted for a safe coding system.
6186
6187 ** The many obsolete language `setup-...-environment' commands have
6188 been removed -- use `set-language-environment'.
6189
6190 ** The new Custom option `keyboard-coding-system' specifies a coding
6191 system for keyboard input.
6192
6193 ** New variable `inhibit-iso-escape-detection' determines if Emacs'
6194 coding system detection algorithm should pay attention to ISO2022's
6195 escape sequences. If this variable is non-nil, the algorithm ignores
6196 such escape sequences. The default value is nil, and it is
6197 recommended not to change it except for the special case that you
6198 always want to read any escape code verbatim. If you just want to
6199 read a specific file without decoding escape codes, use C-x RET c
6200 (`universal-coding-system-argument'). For instance, C-x RET c latin-1
6201 RET C-x C-f filename RET.
6202
6203 ** Variable `default-korean-keyboard' is initialized properly from the
6204 environment variable `HANGUL_KEYBOARD_TYPE'.
6205
6206 ** New command M-x list-charset-chars reads a character set name and
6207 displays all characters in that character set.
6208
6209 ** M-x set-terminal-coding-system (C-x RET t) now allows CCL-based
6210 coding systems such as cpXXX and cyrillic-koi8.
6211
6212 ** Emacs now attempts to determine the initial language environment
6213 and preferred and locale coding systems systematically from the
6214 LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG environment variables during startup.
6215
6216 ** New language environments `Polish', `Latin-8' and `Latin-9'.
6217 Latin-8 and Latin-9 correspond respectively to the ISO character sets
6218 8859-14 (Celtic) and 8859-15 (updated Latin-1, with the Euro sign).
6219 GNU Intlfonts doesn't support these yet but recent X releases have
6220 8859-15. See etc/INSTALL for information on obtaining extra fonts.
6221 There are new Leim input methods for Latin-8 and Latin-9 prefix (only)
6222 and Polish `slash'.
6223
6224 ** New language environments `Dutch' and `Spanish'.
6225 These new environments mainly select appropriate translations
6226 of the tutorial.
6227
6228 ** In Ethiopic language environment, special key bindings for
6229 function keys are changed as follows. This is to conform to "Emacs
6230 Lisp Coding Convention".
6231
6232 new command old-binding
6233 --- ------- -----------
6234 f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-buffer f5
6235 S-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-region f5
6236 C-f3 ethio-fidel-to-sera-mail-or-marker f5
6237
6238 f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-buffer unchanged
6239 S-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-region unchanged
6240 C-f4 ethio-sera-to-fidel-mail-or-marker unchanged
6241
6242 S-f5 ethio-toggle-punctuation f3
6243 S-f6 ethio-modify-vowel f6
6244 S-f7 ethio-replace-space f7
6245 S-f8 ethio-input-special-character f8
6246 S-f9 ethio-replace-space unchanged
6247 C-f9 ethio-toggle-space f2
6248
6249 ** There are new Leim input methods.
6250 New input methods "turkish-postfix", "turkish-alt-postfix",
6251 "greek-mizuochi", "TeX", and "greek-babel" are now part of the Leim
6252 package.
6253
6254 ** The rule of input method "slovak" is slightly changed. Now the
6255 rules for translating "q" and "Q" to "`" (backquote) are deleted, thus
6256 typing them inserts "q" and "Q" respectively. Rules for translating
6257 "=q", "+q", "=Q", and "+Q" to "`" are also deleted. Now, to input
6258 "`", you must type "=q".
6259
6260 ** When your terminal can't display characters from some of the ISO
6261 8859 character sets but can display Latin-1, you can display
6262 more-or-less mnemonic sequences of ASCII/Latin-1 characters instead of
6263 empty boxes (under a window system) or question marks (not under a
6264 window system). Customize the option `latin1-display' to turn this
6265 on.
6266
6267 ** M-; now calls comment-dwim which tries to do something clever based
6268 on the context. M-x kill-comment is now an alias to comment-kill,
6269 defined in newcomment.el. You can choose different styles of region
6270 commenting with the variable `comment-style'.
6271
6272 ** New user options `display-time-mail-face' and
6273 `display-time-use-mail-icon' control the appearance of mode-line mail
6274 indicator used by the display-time package. On a suitable display the
6275 indicator can be an icon and is mouse-sensitive.
6276
6277 ** On window-systems, additional space can be put between text lines
6278 on the display using several methods
6279
6280 - By setting frame parameter `line-spacing' to PIXELS. PIXELS must be
6281 a positive integer, and specifies that PIXELS number of pixels should
6282 be put below text lines on the affected frame or frames.
6283
6284 - By setting X resource `lineSpacing', class `LineSpacing'. This is
6285 equivalent to specifying the frame parameter.
6286
6287 - By specifying `--line-spacing=N' or `-lsp N' on the command line.
6288
6289 - By setting buffer-local variable `line-spacing'. The meaning is
6290 the same, but applies to the a particular buffer only.
6291
6292 ** The new command `clone-indirect-buffer' can be used to create
6293 an indirect buffer that is a twin copy of the current buffer. The
6294 command `clone-indirect-buffer-other-window', bound to C-x 4 c,
6295 does the same but displays the indirect buffer in another window.
6296
6297 ** New user options `backup-directory-alist' and
6298 `make-backup-file-name-function' control the placement of backups,
6299 typically in a single directory or in an invisible sub-directory.
6300
6301 ** New commands iso-iso2sgml and iso-sgml2iso convert between Latin-1
6302 characters and the corresponding SGML (HTML) entities.
6303
6304 ** New X resources recognized
6305
6306 *** The X resource `synchronous', class `Synchronous', specifies
6307 whether Emacs should run in synchronous mode. Synchronous mode
6308 is useful for debugging X problems.
6309
6310 Example:
6311
6312 emacs.synchronous: true
6313
6314 *** The X resource `visualClass, class `VisualClass', specifies the
6315 visual Emacs should use. The resource's value should be a string of
6316 the form `CLASS-DEPTH', where CLASS is the name of the visual class,
6317 and DEPTH is the requested color depth as a decimal number. Valid
6318 visual class names are
6319
6320 TrueColor
6321 PseudoColor
6322 DirectColor
6323 StaticColor
6324 GrayScale
6325 StaticGray
6326
6327 Visual class names specified as X resource are case-insensitive, i.e.
6328 `pseudocolor', `Pseudocolor' and `PseudoColor' all have the same
6329 meaning.
6330
6331 The program `xdpyinfo' can be used to list the visual classes
6332 supported on your display, and which depths they have. If
6333 `visualClass' is not specified, Emacs uses the display's default
6334 visual.
6335
6336 Example:
6337
6338 emacs.visualClass: TrueColor-8
6339
6340 *** The X resource `privateColormap', class `PrivateColormap',
6341 specifies that Emacs should use a private colormap if it is using the
6342 default visual, and that visual is of class PseudoColor. Recognized
6343 resource values are `true' or `on'.
6344
6345 Example:
6346
6347 emacs.privateColormap: true
6348
6349 ** Faces and frame parameters.
6350
6351 There are four new faces `scroll-bar', `border', `cursor' and `mouse'.
6352 Setting the frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
6353 `scroll-bar-background' sets foreground and background color of face
6354 `scroll-bar' and vice versa. Setting frame parameter `border-color'
6355 sets the background color of face `border' and vice versa. Likewise
6356 for frame parameters `cursor-color' and face `cursor', and frame
6357 parameter `mouse-color' and face `mouse'.
6358
6359 Changing frame parameter `font' sets font-related attributes of the
6360 `default' face and vice versa. Setting frame parameters
6361 `foreground-color' or `background-color' sets the colors of the
6362 `default' face and vice versa.
6363
6364 ** New face `menu'.
6365
6366 The face `menu' can be used to change colors and font of Emacs' menus.
6367
6368 ** New frame parameter `screen-gamma' for gamma correction.
6369
6370 The new frame parameter `screen-gamma' specifies gamma-correction for
6371 colors. Its value may be nil, the default, in which case no gamma
6372 correction occurs, or a number > 0, usually a float, that specifies
6373 the screen gamma of a frame's display.
6374
6375 PC monitors usually have a screen gamma of 2.2. smaller values result
6376 in darker colors. You might want to try a screen gamma of 1.5 for LCD
6377 color displays. The viewing gamma Emacs uses is 0.4545. (1/2.2).
6378
6379 The X resource name of this parameter is `screenGamma', class
6380 `ScreenGamma'.
6381
6382 ** Tabs and variable-width text.
6383
6384 Tabs are now displayed with stretch properties; the width of a tab is
6385 defined as a multiple of the normal character width of a frame, and is
6386 independent of the fonts used in the text where the tab appears.
6387 Thus, tabs can be used to line up text in different fonts.
6388
6389 ** Enhancements of the Lucid menu bar
6390
6391 *** The Lucid menu bar now supports the resource "margin".
6392
6393 emacs.pane.menubar.margin: 5
6394
6395 The default margin is 4 which makes the menu bar appear like the
6396 LessTif/Motif one.
6397
6398 *** Arrows that indicate sub-menus are now drawn with shadows, as in
6399 LessTif and Motif.
6400
6401 ** A block cursor can be drawn as wide as the glyph under it under X.
6402
6403 As an example: if a block cursor is over a tab character, it will be
6404 drawn as wide as that tab on the display. To do this, set
6405 `x-stretch-cursor' to a non-nil value.
6406
6407 ** Empty display lines at the end of a buffer may be marked with a
6408 bitmap (this is similar to the tilde displayed by vi and Less).
6409
6410 This behavior is activated by setting the buffer-local variable
6411 `indicate-empty-lines' to a non-nil value. The default value of this
6412 variable is found in `default-indicate-empty-lines'.
6413
6414 ** There is a new "aggressive" scrolling method.
6415
6416 When scrolling up because point is above the window start, if the
6417 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-up-aggressively' is a
6418 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6419 fraction of the window's height from the top of the window.
6420
6421 When scrolling down because point is below the window end, if the
6422 value of the buffer-local variable `scroll-down-aggressively' is a
6423 number, Emacs chooses a new window start so that point ends up that
6424 fraction of the window's height from the bottom of the window.
6425
6426 ** You can now easily create new *Info* buffers using either
6427 M-x clone-buffer, C-u m <entry> RET or C-u g <entry> RET.
6428 M-x clone-buffer can also be used on *Help* and several other special
6429 buffers.
6430
6431 ** The command `Info-search' now uses a search history.
6432
6433 ** Listing buffers with M-x list-buffers (C-x C-b) now shows
6434 abbreviated file names. Abbreviations can be customized by changing
6435 `directory-abbrev-alist'.
6436
6437 ** A new variable, backup-by-copying-when-privileged-mismatch, gives
6438 the highest file uid for which backup-by-copying-when-mismatch will be
6439 forced on. The assumption is that uids less than or equal to this
6440 value are special uids (root, bin, daemon, etc.--not real system
6441 users) and that files owned by these users should not change ownership,
6442 even if your system policy allows users other than root to edit them.
6443
6444 The default is 200; set the variable to nil to disable the feature.
6445
6446 ** The rectangle commands now avoid inserting undesirable spaces,
6447 notably at the end of lines.
6448
6449 All these functions have been rewritten to avoid inserting unwanted
6450 spaces, and an optional prefix now allows them to behave the old way.
6451
6452 ** The function `replace-rectangle' is an alias for `string-rectangle'.
6453
6454 ** The new command M-x string-insert-rectangle is like `string-rectangle',
6455 but inserts text instead of replacing it.
6456
6457 ** The new command M-x query-replace-regexp-eval acts like
6458 query-replace-regexp, but takes a Lisp expression which is evaluated
6459 after each match to get the replacement text.
6460
6461 ** M-x query-replace recognizes a new command `e' (or `E') that lets
6462 you edit the replacement string.
6463
6464 ** The new command mail-abbrev-complete-alias, bound to `M-TAB'
6465 (if you load the library `mailabbrev'), lets you complete mail aliases
6466 in the text, analogous to lisp-complete-symbol.
6467
6468 ** The variable `echo-keystrokes' may now have a floating point value.
6469
6470 ** If your init file is compiled (.emacs.elc), `user-init-file' is set
6471 to the source name (.emacs.el), if that exists, after loading it.
6472
6473 ** The help string specified for a menu-item whose definition contains
6474 the property `:help HELP' is now displayed under X, on MS-Windows, and
6475 MS-DOS, either in the echo area or with tooltips. Many standard menus
6476 displayed by Emacs now have help strings.
6477
6478 --
6479 ** New user option `read-mail-command' specifies a command to use to
6480 read mail from the menu etc.
6481
6482 ** The environment variable `EMACSLOCKDIR' is no longer used on MS-Windows.
6483 This environment variable was used when creating lock files. Emacs on
6484 MS-Windows does not use this variable anymore. This change was made
6485 before Emacs 21.1, but wasn't documented until now.
6486
6487 ** Highlighting of mouse-sensitive regions is now supported in the
6488 MS-DOS version of Emacs.
6489
6490 ** The new command `msdos-set-mouse-buttons' forces the MS-DOS version
6491 of Emacs to behave as if the mouse had a specified number of buttons.
6492 This comes handy with mice that don't report their number of buttons
6493 correctly. One example is the wheeled mice, which report 3 buttons,
6494 but clicks on the middle button are not passed to the MS-DOS version
6495 of Emacs.
6496
6497 ** Customize changes
6498
6499 *** Customize now supports comments about customized items. Use the
6500 `State' menu to add comments, or give a prefix argument to
6501 M-x customize-set-variable or M-x customize-set-value. Note that
6502 customization comments will cause the customizations to fail in
6503 earlier versions of Emacs.
6504
6505 *** The new option `custom-buffer-done-function' says whether to kill
6506 Custom buffers when you've done with them or just bury them (the
6507 default).
6508
6509 *** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6510 does not allow you to save customizations in your `~/.emacs' init
6511 file. This is because saving customizations from such a session would
6512 wipe out all the other customizationss you might have on your init
6513 file.
6514
6515 ** If Emacs was invoked with the `-q' or `--no-init-file' options, it
6516 does not save disabled and enabled commands for future sessions, to
6517 avoid overwriting existing customizations of this kind that are
6518 already in your init file.
6519
6520 ** New features in evaluation commands
6521
6522 *** The commands to evaluate Lisp expressions, such as C-M-x in Lisp
6523 modes, C-j in Lisp Interaction mode, and M-:, now bind the variables
6524 print-level, print-length, and debug-on-error based on the new
6525 customizable variables eval-expression-print-level,
6526 eval-expression-print-length, and eval-expression-debug-on-error.
6527
6528 The default values for the first two of these variables are 12 and 4
6529 respectively, which means that `eval-expression' now prints at most
6530 the first 12 members of a list and at most 4 nesting levels deep (if
6531 the list is longer or deeper than that, an ellipsis `...' is
6532 printed).
6533
6534 <RET> or <mouse-2> on the printed text toggles between an abbreviated
6535 printed representation and an unabbreviated one.
6536
6537 The default value of eval-expression-debug-on-error is t, so any error
6538 during evaluation produces a backtrace.
6539
6540 *** The function `eval-defun' (C-M-x) now loads Edebug and instruments
6541 code when called with a prefix argument.
6542
6543 ** CC mode changes.
6544
6545 Note: This release contains changes that might not be compatible with
6546 current user setups (although it's believed that these
6547 incompatibilities will only show in very uncommon circumstances).
6548 However, since the impact is uncertain, these changes may be rolled
6549 back depending on user feedback. Therefore there's no forward
6550 compatibility guarantee wrt the new features introduced in this
6551 release.
6552
6553 *** The hardcoded switch to "java" style in Java mode is gone.
6554 CC Mode used to automatically set the style to "java" when Java mode
6555 is entered. This has now been removed since it caused too much
6556 confusion.
6557
6558 However, to keep backward compatibility to a certain extent, the
6559 default value for c-default-style now specifies the "java" style for
6560 java-mode, but "gnu" for all other modes (as before). So you won't
6561 notice the change if you haven't touched that variable.
6562
6563 *** New cleanups, space-before-funcall and compact-empty-funcall.
6564 Two new cleanups have been added to c-cleanup-list:
6565
6566 space-before-funcall causes a space to be inserted before the opening
6567 parenthesis of a function call, which gives the style "foo (bar)".
6568
6569 compact-empty-funcall causes any space before a function call opening
6570 parenthesis to be removed if there are no arguments to the function.
6571 It's typically useful together with space-before-funcall to get the
6572 style "foo (bar)" and "foo()".
6573
6574 *** Some keywords now automatically trigger reindentation.
6575 Keywords like "else", "while", "catch" and "finally" have been made
6576 "electric" to make them reindent automatically when they continue an
6577 earlier statement. An example:
6578
6579 for (i = 0; i < 17; i++)
6580 if (a[i])
6581 res += a[i]->offset;
6582 else
6583
6584 Here, the "else" should be indented like the preceding "if", since it
6585 continues that statement. CC Mode will automatically reindent it after
6586 the "else" has been typed in full, since it's not until then it's
6587 possible to decide whether it's a new statement or a continuation of
6588 the preceding "if".
6589
6590 CC Mode uses Abbrev mode to achieve this, which is therefore turned on
6591 by default.
6592
6593 *** M-a and M-e now moves by sentence in multiline strings.
6594 Previously these two keys only moved by sentence in comments, which
6595 meant that sentence movement didn't work in strings containing
6596 documentation or other natural language text.
6597
6598 The reason it's only activated in multiline strings (i.e. strings that
6599 contain a newline, even when escaped by a '\') is to avoid stopping in
6600 the short strings that often reside inside statements. Multiline
6601 strings almost always contain text in a natural language, as opposed
6602 to other strings that typically contain format specifications,
6603 commands, etc. Also, it's not that bothersome that M-a and M-e misses
6604 sentences in single line strings, since they're short anyway.
6605
6606 *** Support for autodoc comments in Pike mode.
6607 Autodoc comments for Pike are used to extract documentation from the
6608 source, like Javadoc in Java. Pike mode now recognize this markup in
6609 comment prefixes and paragraph starts.
6610
6611 *** The comment prefix regexps on c-comment-prefix may be mode specific.
6612 When c-comment-prefix is an association list, it specifies the comment
6613 line prefix on a per-mode basis, like c-default-style does. This
6614 change came about to support the special autodoc comment prefix in
6615 Pike mode only.
6616
6617 *** Better handling of syntactic errors.
6618 The recovery after unbalanced parens earlier in the buffer has been
6619 improved; CC Mode now reports them by dinging and giving a message
6620 stating the offending line, but still recovers and indent the
6621 following lines in a sane way (most of the time). An "else" with no
6622 matching "if" is handled similarly. If an error is discovered while
6623 indenting a region, the whole region is still indented and the error
6624 is reported afterwards.
6625
6626 *** Lineup functions may now return absolute columns.
6627 A lineup function can give an absolute column to indent the line to by
6628 returning a vector with the desired column as the first element.
6629
6630 *** More robust and warning-free byte compilation.
6631 Although this is strictly not a user visible change (well, depending
6632 on the view of a user), it's still worth mentioning that CC Mode now
6633 can be compiled in the standard ways without causing trouble. Some
6634 code have also been moved between the subpackages to enhance the
6635 modularity somewhat. Thanks to Martin Buchholz for doing the
6636 groundwork.
6637
6638 *** c-style-variables-are-local-p now defaults to t.
6639 This is an incompatible change that has been made to make the behavior
6640 of the style system wrt global variable settings less confusing for
6641 non-advanced users. If you know what this variable does you might
6642 want to set it to nil in your .emacs, otherwise you probably don't
6643 have to bother.
6644
6645 Defaulting c-style-variables-are-local-p to t avoids the confusing
6646 situation that occurs when a user sets some style variables globally
6647 and edits both a Java and a non-Java file in the same Emacs session.
6648 If the style variables aren't buffer local in this case, loading of
6649 the second file will cause the default style (either "gnu" or "java"
6650 by default) to override the global settings made by the user.
6651
6652 *** New initialization procedure for the style system.
6653 When the initial style for a buffer is determined by CC Mode (from the
6654 variable c-default-style), the global values of style variables now
6655 take precedence over the values specified by the chosen style. This
6656 is different than the old behavior: previously, the style-specific
6657 settings would override the global settings. This change makes it
6658 possible to do simple configuration in the intuitive way with
6659 Customize or with setq lines in one's .emacs file.
6660
6661 By default, the global value of every style variable is the new
6662 special symbol set-from-style, which causes the value to be taken from
6663 the style system. This means that in effect, only an explicit setting
6664 of a style variable will cause the "overriding" behavior described
6665 above.
6666
6667 Also note that global settings override style-specific settings *only*
6668 when the initial style of a buffer is chosen by a CC Mode major mode
6669 function. When a style is chosen in other ways --- for example, by a
6670 call like (c-set-style "gnu") in a hook, or via M-x c-set-style ---
6671 then the style-specific values take precedence over any global style
6672 values. In Lisp terms, global values override style-specific values
6673 only when the new second argument to c-set-style is non-nil; see the
6674 function documentation for more info.
6675
6676 The purpose of these changes is to make it easier for users,
6677 especially novice users, to do simple customizations with Customize or
6678 with setq in their .emacs files. On the other hand, the new system is
6679 intended to be compatible with advanced users' customizations as well,
6680 such as those that choose styles in hooks or whatnot. This new system
6681 is believed to be almost entirely compatible with current
6682 configurations, in spite of the changed precedence between style and
6683 global variable settings when a buffer's default style is set.
6684
6685 (Thanks to Eric Eide for clarifying this explanation a bit.)
6686
6687 **** c-offsets-alist is now a customizable variable.
6688 This became possible as a result of the new initialization behavior.
6689
6690 This variable is treated slightly differently from the other style
6691 variables; instead of using the symbol set-from-style, it will be
6692 completed with the syntactic symbols it doesn't already contain when
6693 the style is first initialized. This means it now defaults to the
6694 empty list to make all syntactic elements get their values from the
6695 style system.
6696
6697 **** Compatibility variable to restore the old behavior.
6698 In case your configuration doesn't work with this change, you can set
6699 c-old-style-variable-behavior to non-nil to get the old behavior back
6700 as far as possible.
6701
6702 *** Improvements to line breaking and text filling.
6703 CC Mode now handles this more intelligently and seamlessly wrt the
6704 surrounding code, especially inside comments. For details see the new
6705 chapter about this in the manual.
6706
6707 **** New variable to recognize comment line prefix decorations.
6708 The variable c-comment-prefix-regexp has been added to properly
6709 recognize the line prefix in both block and line comments. It's
6710 primarily used to initialize the various paragraph recognition and
6711 adaptive filling variables that the text handling functions uses.
6712
6713 **** New variable c-block-comment-prefix.
6714 This is a generalization of the now obsolete variable
6715 c-comment-continuation-stars to handle arbitrary strings.
6716
6717 **** CC Mode now uses adaptive fill mode.
6718 This to make it adapt better to the paragraph style inside comments.
6719
6720 It's also possible to use other adaptive filling packages inside CC
6721 Mode, notably Kyle E. Jones' Filladapt mode (http://wonderworks.com/).
6722 A new convenience function c-setup-filladapt sets up Filladapt for use
6723 inside CC Mode.
6724
6725 Note though that the 2.12 version of Filladapt lacks a feature that
6726 causes it to work suboptimally when c-comment-prefix-regexp can match
6727 the empty string (which it commonly does). A patch for that is
6728 available from the CC Mode web site (http://www.python.org/emacs/
6729 cc-mode/).
6730
6731 **** The variables `c-hanging-comment-starter-p' and
6732 `c-hanging-comment-ender-p', which controlled how comment starters and
6733 enders were filled, are not used anymore. The new version of the
6734 function `c-fill-paragraph' keeps the comment starters and enders as
6735 they were before the filling.
6736
6737 **** It's now possible to selectively turn off auto filling.
6738 The variable c-ignore-auto-fill is used to ignore auto fill mode in
6739 specific contexts, e.g. in preprocessor directives and in string
6740 literals.
6741
6742 **** New context sensitive line break function c-context-line-break.
6743 It works like newline-and-indent in normal code, and adapts the line
6744 prefix according to the comment style when used inside comments. If
6745 you're normally using newline-and-indent, you might want to switch to
6746 this function.
6747
6748 *** Fixes to IDL mode.
6749 It now does a better job in recognizing only the constructs relevant
6750 to IDL. E.g. it no longer matches "class" as the beginning of a
6751 struct block, but it does match the CORBA 2.3 "valuetype" keyword.
6752 Thanks to Eric Eide.
6753
6754 *** Improvements to the Whitesmith style.
6755 It now keeps the style consistently on all levels and both when
6756 opening braces hangs and when they don't.
6757
6758 **** New lineup function c-lineup-whitesmith-in-block.
6759
6760 *** New lineup functions c-lineup-template-args and c-indent-multi-line-block.
6761 See their docstrings for details. c-lineup-template-args does a
6762 better job of tracking the brackets used as parens in C++ templates,
6763 and is used by default to line up continued template arguments.
6764
6765 *** c-lineup-comment now preserves alignment with a comment on the
6766 previous line. It used to instead preserve comments that started in
6767 the column specified by comment-column.
6768
6769 *** c-lineup-C-comments handles "free form" text comments.
6770 In comments with a long delimiter line at the start, the indentation
6771 is kept unchanged for lines that start with an empty comment line
6772 prefix. This is intended for the type of large block comments that
6773 contain documentation with its own formatting. In these you normally
6774 don't want CC Mode to change the indentation.
6775
6776 *** The `c' syntactic symbol is now relative to the comment start
6777 instead of the previous line, to make integers usable as lineup
6778 arguments.
6779
6780 *** All lineup functions have gotten docstrings.
6781
6782 *** More preprocessor directive movement functions.
6783 c-down-conditional does the reverse of c-up-conditional.
6784 c-up-conditional-with-else and c-down-conditional-with-else are
6785 variants of these that also stops at "#else" lines (suggested by Don
6786 Provan).
6787
6788 *** Minor improvements to many movement functions in tricky situations.
6789
6790 ** Dired changes
6791
6792 *** New variable `dired-recursive-deletes' determines if the delete
6793 command will delete non-empty directories recursively. The default
6794 is, delete only empty directories.
6795
6796 *** New variable `dired-recursive-copies' determines if the copy
6797 command will copy directories recursively. The default is, do not
6798 copy directories recursively.
6799
6800 *** In command `dired-do-shell-command' (usually bound to `!') a `?'
6801 in the shell command has a special meaning similar to `*', but with
6802 the difference that the command will be run on each file individually.
6803
6804 *** The new command `dired-find-alternate-file' (usually bound to `a')
6805 replaces the Dired buffer with the buffer for an alternate file or
6806 directory.
6807
6808 *** The new command `dired-show-file-type' (usually bound to `y') shows
6809 a message in the echo area describing what type of file the point is on.
6810 This command invokes the external program `file' do its work, and so
6811 will only work on systems with that program, and will be only as
6812 accurate or inaccurate as it is.
6813
6814 *** Dired now properly handles undo changes of adding/removing `-R'
6815 from ls switches.
6816
6817 *** Dired commands that prompt for a destination file now allow the use
6818 of the `M-n' command in the minibuffer to insert the source filename,
6819 which the user can then edit. This only works if there is a single
6820 source file, not when operating on multiple marked files.
6821
6822 ** Gnus changes.
6823
6824 The Gnus NEWS entries are short, but they reflect sweeping changes in
6825 four areas: Article display treatment, MIME treatment,
6826 internationalization and mail-fetching.
6827
6828 *** The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
6829 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
6830
6831 If you used procmail like in
6832
6833 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
6834 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
6835 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
6836 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
6837
6838 this now has changed to
6839
6840 (setq mail-sources
6841 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
6842 :suffix ".in")))
6843
6844 More information is available in the info doc at Select Methods ->
6845 Getting Mail -> Mail Sources
6846
6847 *** Gnus is now a MIME-capable reader. This affects many parts of
6848 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
6849 Separate MIME packages like RMIME, mime-compose etc., will probably no
6850 longer work; remove them and use the native facilities.
6851
6852 The FLIM/SEMI package still works with Emacs 21, but if you want to
6853 use the native facilities, you must remove any mailcap.el[c] that was
6854 installed by FLIM/SEMI version 1.13 or earlier.
6855
6856 *** Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too many
6857 parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables. There
6858 are built-in facilities equivalent to those of gnus-mule.el, which is
6859 now just a compatibility layer.
6860
6861 *** gnus-mule.el is now just a compatibility layer over the built-in
6862 Gnus facilities.
6863
6864 *** gnus-auto-select-first can now be a function to be
6865 called to position point.
6866
6867 *** The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
6868 summary buffers and NOV files.
6869
6870 *** `gnus-article-display-hook' has been removed. Instead, a number
6871 of variables starting with `gnus-treat-' have been added.
6872
6873 *** The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now work in a
6874 subtly different manner.
6875
6876 *** New web-based backends have been added: nnslashdot, nnwarchive
6877 and nnultimate. nnweb has been revamped, again, to keep up with
6878 ever-changing layouts.
6879
6880 *** Gnus can now read IMAP mail via nnimap.
6881
6882 *** There is image support of various kinds and some sound support.
6883
6884 ** Changes in Texinfo mode.
6885
6886 *** A couple of new key bindings have been added for inserting Texinfo
6887 macros
6888
6889 Key binding Macro
6890 -------------------------
6891 C-c C-c C-s @strong
6892 C-c C-c C-e @emph
6893 C-c C-c u @uref
6894 C-c C-c q @quotation
6895 C-c C-c m @email
6896 C-c C-o @<block> ... @end <block>
6897 M-RET @item
6898
6899 *** The " key now inserts either " or `` or '' depending on context.
6900
6901 ** Changes in Outline mode.
6902
6903 There is now support for Imenu to index headings. A new command
6904 `outline-headers-as-kill' copies the visible headings in the region to
6905 the kill ring, e.g. to produce a table of contents.
6906
6907 ** Changes to Emacs Server
6908
6909 *** The new option `server-kill-new-buffers' specifies what to do
6910 with buffers when done with them. If non-nil, the default, buffers
6911 are killed, unless they were already present before visiting them with
6912 Emacs Server. If nil, `server-temp-file-regexp' specifies which
6913 buffers to kill, as before.
6914
6915 Please note that only buffers are killed that still have a client,
6916 i.e. buffers visited with `emacsclient --no-wait' are never killed in
6917 this way.
6918
6919 ** Both emacsclient and Emacs itself now accept command line options
6920 of the form +LINE:COLUMN in addition to +LINE.
6921
6922 ** Changes to Show Paren mode.
6923
6924 *** Overlays used by Show Paren mode now use a priority property.
6925 The new user option show-paren-priority specifies the priority to
6926 use. Default is 1000.
6927
6928 ** New command M-x check-parens can be used to find unbalanced paren
6929 groups and strings in buffers in Lisp mode (or other modes).
6930
6931 ** Changes to hideshow.el
6932
6933 *** Generalized block selection and traversal
6934
6935 A block is now recognized by its start and end regexps (both strings),
6936 and an integer specifying which sub-expression in the start regexp
6937 serves as the place where a `forward-sexp'-like function can operate.
6938 See the documentation of variable `hs-special-modes-alist'.
6939
6940 *** During incremental search, if Hideshow minor mode is active,
6941 hidden blocks are temporarily shown. The variable `hs-headline' can
6942 be used in the mode line format to show the line at the beginning of
6943 the open block.
6944
6945 *** User option `hs-hide-all-non-comment-function' specifies a
6946 function to be called at each top-level block beginning, instead of
6947 the normal block-hiding function.
6948
6949 *** The command `hs-show-region' has been removed.
6950
6951 *** The key bindings have changed to fit the Emacs conventions,
6952 roughly imitating those of Outline minor mode. Notably, the prefix
6953 for all bindings is now `C-c @'. For details, see the documentation
6954 for `hs-minor-mode'.
6955
6956 *** The variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' has been removed, and
6957 hideshow.el now always behaves as if this variable were set to t.
6958
6959 ** Changes to Change Log mode and Add-Log functions
6960
6961 *** If you invoke `add-change-log-entry' from a backup file, it makes
6962 an entry appropriate for the file's parent. This is useful for making
6963 log entries by comparing a version with deleted functions.
6964
6965 **** New command M-x change-log-merge merges another log into the
6966 current buffer.
6967
6968 *** New command M-x change-log-redate fixes any old-style date entries
6969 in a log file.
6970
6971 *** Change Log mode now adds a file's version number to change log
6972 entries if user-option `change-log-version-info-enabled' is non-nil.
6973 Unless the file is under version control the search for a file's
6974 version number is performed based on regular expressions from
6975 `change-log-version-number-regexp-list' which can be customized.
6976 Version numbers are only found in the first 10 percent of a file.
6977
6978 *** Change Log mode now defines its own faces for font-lock highlighting.
6979
6980 ** Changes to cmuscheme
6981
6982 *** The user-option `scheme-program-name' has been renamed
6983 `cmuscheme-program-name' due to conflicts with xscheme.el.
6984
6985 ** Changes in Font Lock
6986
6987 *** The new function `font-lock-remove-keywords' can be used to remove
6988 font-lock keywords from the current buffer or from a specific major mode.
6989
6990 *** Multi-line patterns are now supported. Modes using this, should
6991 set font-lock-multiline to t in their font-lock-defaults.
6992
6993 *** `font-lock-syntactic-face-function' allows major-modes to choose
6994 the face used for each string/comment.
6995
6996 *** A new standard face `font-lock-doc-face'.
6997 Meant for Lisp docstrings, Javadoc comments and other "documentation in code".
6998
6999 ** Changes to Shell mode
7000
7001 *** The `shell' command now accepts an optional argument to specify the buffer
7002 to use, which defaults to "*shell*". When used interactively, a
7003 non-default buffer may be specified by giving the `shell' command a
7004 prefix argument (causing it to prompt for the buffer name).
7005
7006 ** Comint (subshell) changes
7007
7008 These changes generally affect all modes derived from comint mode, which
7009 include shell-mode, gdb-mode, scheme-interaction-mode, etc.
7010
7011 *** Comint now by default interprets some carriage-control characters.
7012 Comint now removes CRs from CR LF sequences, and treats single CRs and
7013 BSs in the output in a way similar to a terminal (by deleting to the
7014 beginning of the line, or deleting the previous character,
7015 respectively). This is achieved by adding `comint-carriage-motion' to
7016 the `comint-output-filter-functions' hook by default.
7017
7018 *** By default, comint no longer uses the variable `comint-prompt-regexp'
7019 to distinguish prompts from user-input. Instead, it notices which
7020 parts of the text were output by the process, and which entered by the
7021 user, and attaches `field' properties to allow emacs commands to use
7022 this information. Common movement commands, notably beginning-of-line,
7023 respect field boundaries in a fairly natural manner. To disable this
7024 feature, and use the old behavior, customize the user option
7025 `comint-use-prompt-regexp-instead-of-fields'.
7026
7027 *** Comint now includes new features to send commands to running processes
7028 and redirect the output to a designated buffer or buffers.
7029
7030 *** The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command reads a command and
7031 buffer name from the mini-buffer. The command is sent to the current
7032 buffer's process, and its output is inserted into the specified buffer.
7033
7034 The command M-x comint-redirect-send-command-to-process acts like
7035 M-x comint-redirect-send-command but additionally reads the name of
7036 the buffer whose process should be used from the mini-buffer.
7037
7038 *** Packages based on comint now highlight user input and program prompts,
7039 and support choosing previous input with mouse-2. To control these features,
7040 see the user-options `comint-highlight-input' and `comint-highlight-prompt'.
7041
7042 *** The new command `comint-write-output' (usually bound to `C-c C-s')
7043 saves the output from the most recent command to a file. With a prefix
7044 argument, it appends to the file.
7045
7046 *** The command `comint-kill-output' has been renamed `comint-delete-output'
7047 (usually bound to `C-c C-o'); the old name is aliased to it for
7048 compatibility.
7049
7050 *** The new function `comint-add-to-input-history' adds commands to the input
7051 ring (history).
7052
7053 *** The new variable `comint-input-history-ignore' is a regexp for
7054 identifying history lines that should be ignored, like tcsh time-stamp
7055 strings, starting with a `#'. The default value of this variable is "^#".
7056
7057 ** Changes to Rmail mode
7058
7059 *** The new user-option rmail-user-mail-address-regexp can be
7060 set to fine tune the identification of the correspondent when
7061 receiving new mail. If it matches the address of the sender, the
7062 recipient is taken as correspondent of a mail. If nil, the default,
7063 `user-login-name' and `user-mail-address' are used to exclude yourself
7064 as correspondent.
7065
7066 Usually you don't have to set this variable, except if you collect
7067 mails sent by you under different user names. Then it should be a
7068 regexp matching your mail addresses.
7069
7070 *** The new user-option rmail-confirm-expunge controls whether and how
7071 to ask for confirmation before expunging deleted messages from an
7072 Rmail file. You can choose between no confirmation, confirmation
7073 with y-or-n-p, or confirmation with yes-or-no-p. Default is to ask
7074 for confirmation with yes-or-no-p.
7075
7076 *** RET is now bound in the Rmail summary to rmail-summary-goto-msg,
7077 like `j'.
7078
7079 *** There is a new user option `rmail-digest-end-regexps' that
7080 specifies the regular expressions to detect the line that ends a
7081 digest message.
7082
7083 *** The new user option `rmail-automatic-folder-directives' specifies
7084 in which folder to put messages automatically.
7085
7086 *** The new function `rmail-redecode-body' allows to fix a message
7087 with non-ASCII characters if Emacs happens to decode it incorrectly
7088 due to missing or malformed "charset=" header.
7089
7090 ** The new user-option `mail-envelope-from' can be used to specify
7091 an envelope-from address different from user-mail-address.
7092
7093 ** The variable mail-specify-envelope-from controls whether to
7094 use the -f option when sending mail.
7095
7096 ** The Rmail command `o' (`rmail-output-to-rmail-file') now writes the
7097 current message in the internal `emacs-mule' encoding, rather than in
7098 the encoding taken from the variable `buffer-file-coding-system'.
7099 This allows to save messages whose characters cannot be safely encoded
7100 by the buffer's coding system, and makes sure the message will be
7101 displayed correctly when you later visit the target Rmail file.
7102
7103 If you want your Rmail files be encoded in a specific coding system
7104 other than `emacs-mule', you can customize the variable
7105 `rmail-file-coding-system' to set its value to that coding system.
7106
7107 ** Changes to TeX mode
7108
7109 *** The default mode has been changed from `plain-tex-mode' to
7110 `latex-mode'.
7111
7112 *** latex-mode now has a simple indentation algorithm.
7113
7114 *** M-f and M-p jump around \begin...\end pairs.
7115
7116 *** Added support for outline-minor-mode.
7117
7118 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
7119
7120 *** RefTeX has new support for index generation. Index entries can be
7121 created with `C-c <', with completion available on index keys.
7122 Pressing `C-c /' indexes the word at the cursor with a default
7123 macro. `C-c >' compiles all index entries into an alphabetically
7124 sorted *Index* buffer which looks like the final index. Entries
7125 can be edited from that buffer.
7126
7127 *** Label and citation key selection now allow to select several
7128 items and reference them together (use `m' to mark items, `a' or
7129 `A' to use all marked entries).
7130
7131 *** reftex.el has been split into a number of smaller files to reduce
7132 memory use when only a part of RefTeX is being used.
7133
7134 *** a new command `reftex-view-crossref-from-bibtex' (bound to `C-c &'
7135 in BibTeX-mode) can be called in a BibTeX database buffer in order
7136 to show locations in LaTeX documents where a particular entry has
7137 been cited.
7138
7139 ** Emacs Lisp mode now allows multiple levels of outline headings.
7140 The level of a heading is determined from the number of leading
7141 semicolons in a heading line. Toplevel forms starting with a `('
7142 in column 1 are always made leaves.
7143
7144 ** The M-x time-stamp command (most commonly used on write-file-hooks)
7145 has the following new features:
7146
7147 *** The patterns for finding the time stamp and for updating a pattern
7148 may match text spanning multiple lines. For example, some people like
7149 to have the filename and date on separate lines. The new variable
7150 time-stamp-inserts-lines controls the matching for multi-line patterns.
7151
7152 *** More than one time stamp can be updated in the same file. This
7153 feature is useful if you need separate time stamps in a program source
7154 file to both include in formatted documentation and insert in the
7155 compiled binary. The same time-stamp will be written at each matching
7156 pattern. The variable time-stamp-count enables this new feature; it
7157 defaults to 1.
7158
7159 ** Partial Completion mode now completes environment variables in
7160 file names.
7161
7162 ** Ispell changes
7163
7164 *** The command `ispell' now spell-checks a region if
7165 transient-mark-mode is on, and the mark is active. Otherwise it
7166 spell-checks the current buffer.
7167
7168 *** Support for synchronous subprocesses - DOS/Windoze - has been
7169 added.
7170
7171 *** An "alignment error" bug was fixed when a manual spelling
7172 correction is made and re-checked.
7173
7174 *** Italian, Portuguese, and Slovak dictionary definitions have been added.
7175
7176 *** Region skipping performance has been vastly improved in some
7177 cases.
7178
7179 *** Spell checking HTML buffers has been improved and isn't so strict
7180 on syntax errors.
7181
7182 *** The buffer-local words are now always placed on a new line at the
7183 end of the buffer.
7184
7185 *** Spell checking now works in the MS-DOS version of Emacs.
7186
7187 ** Makefile mode changes
7188
7189 *** The mode now uses the abbrev table `makefile-mode-abbrev-table'.
7190
7191 *** Conditionals and include statements are now highlighted when
7192 Fontlock mode is active.
7193
7194 ** Isearch changes
7195
7196 *** Isearch now puts a call to `isearch-resume' in the command history,
7197 so that searches can be resumed.
7198
7199 *** In Isearch mode, C-M-s and C-M-r are now bound like C-s and C-r,
7200 respectively, i.e. you can repeat a regexp isearch with the same keys
7201 that started the search.
7202
7203 *** In Isearch mode, mouse-2 in the echo area now yanks the current
7204 selection into the search string rather than giving an error.
7205
7206 *** There is a new lazy highlighting feature in incremental search.
7207
7208 Lazy highlighting is switched on/off by customizing variable
7209 `isearch-lazy-highlight'. When active, all matches for the current
7210 search string are highlighted. The current match is highlighted as
7211 before using face `isearch' or `region'. All other matches are
7212 highlighted using face `isearch-lazy-highlight-face' which defaults to
7213 `secondary-selection'.
7214
7215 The extra highlighting makes it easier to anticipate where the cursor
7216 will end up each time you press C-s or C-r to repeat a pending search.
7217 Highlighting of these additional matches happens in a deferred fashion
7218 using "idle timers," so the cycles needed do not rob isearch of its
7219 usual snappy response.
7220
7221 If `isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup' is set to t, highlights for
7222 matches are automatically cleared when you end the search. If it is
7223 set to nil, you can remove the highlights manually with `M-x
7224 isearch-lazy-highlight-cleanup'.
7225
7226 ** VC Changes
7227
7228 VC has been overhauled internally. It is now modular, making it
7229 easier to plug-in arbitrary version control backends. (See Lisp
7230 Changes for details on the new structure.) As a result, the mechanism
7231 to enable and disable support for particular version systems has
7232 changed: everything is now controlled by the new variable
7233 `vc-handled-backends'. Its value is a list of symbols that identify
7234 version systems; the default is '(RCS CVS SCCS). When finding a file,
7235 each of the backends in that list is tried in order to see whether the
7236 file is registered in that backend.
7237
7238 When registering a new file, VC first tries each of the listed
7239 backends to see if any of them considers itself "responsible" for the
7240 directory of the file (e.g. because a corresponding subdirectory for
7241 master files exists). If none of the backends is responsible, then
7242 the first backend in the list that could register the file is chosen.
7243 As a consequence, the variable `vc-default-back-end' is now obsolete.
7244
7245 The old variable `vc-master-templates' is also obsolete, although VC
7246 still supports it for backward compatibility. To define templates for
7247 RCS or SCCS, you should rather use the new variables
7248 vc-{rcs,sccs}-master-templates. (There is no such feature under CVS
7249 where it doesn't make sense.)
7250
7251 The variables `vc-ignore-vc-files' and `vc-handle-cvs' are also
7252 obsolete now, you must set `vc-handled-backends' to nil or exclude
7253 `CVS' from the list, respectively, to achieve their effect now.
7254
7255 *** General Changes
7256
7257 The variable `vc-checkout-carefully' is obsolete: the corresponding
7258 checks are always done now.
7259
7260 VC Dired buffers are now kept up-to-date during all version control
7261 operations.
7262
7263 `vc-diff' output is now displayed in `diff-mode'.
7264 `vc-print-log' uses `log-view-mode'.
7265 `vc-log-mode' (used for *VC-Log*) has been replaced by `log-edit-mode'.
7266
7267 The command C-x v m (vc-merge) now accepts an empty argument as the
7268 first revision number. This means that any recent changes on the
7269 current branch should be picked up from the repository and merged into
7270 the working file (``merge news'').
7271
7272 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7273 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) now ask for a directory name from which to work
7274 downwards.
7275
7276 *** Multiple Backends
7277
7278 VC now lets you register files in more than one backend. This is
7279 useful, for example, if you are working with a slow remote CVS
7280 repository. You can then use RCS for local editing, and occasionally
7281 commit your changes back to CVS, or pick up changes from CVS into your
7282 local RCS archives.
7283
7284 To make this work, the ``more local'' backend (RCS in our example)
7285 should come first in `vc-handled-backends', and the ``more remote''
7286 backend (CVS) should come later. (The default value of
7287 `vc-handled-backends' already has it that way.)
7288
7289 You can then commit changes to another backend (say, RCS), by typing
7290 C-u C-x v v RCS RET (i.e. vc-next-action now accepts a backend name as
7291 a revision number). VC registers the file in the more local backend
7292 if that hasn't already happened, and commits to a branch based on the
7293 current revision number from the more remote backend.
7294
7295 If a file is registered in multiple backends, you can switch to
7296 another one using C-x v b (vc-switch-backend). This does not change
7297 any files, it only changes VC's perspective on the file. Use this to
7298 pick up changes from CVS while working under RCS locally.
7299
7300 After you are done with your local RCS editing, you can commit your
7301 changes back to CVS using C-u C-x v v CVS RET. In this case, the
7302 local RCS archive is removed after the commit, and the log entry
7303 buffer is initialized to contain the entire RCS change log of the file.
7304
7305 *** Changes for CVS
7306
7307 There is a new user option, `vc-cvs-stay-local'. If it is `t' (the
7308 default), then VC avoids network queries for files registered in
7309 remote repositories. The state of such files is then only determined
7310 by heuristics and past information. `vc-cvs-stay-local' can also be a
7311 regexp to match against repository hostnames; only files from hosts
7312 that match it are treated locally. If the variable is nil, then VC
7313 queries the repository just as often as it does for local files.
7314
7315 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, then VC also makes local backups of
7316 repository versions. This means that ordinary diffs (C-x v =) and
7317 revert operations (C-x v u) can be done completely locally, without
7318 any repository interactions at all. The name of a local version
7319 backup of FILE is FILE.~REV.~, where REV is the repository version
7320 number. This format is similar to that used by C-x v ~
7321 (vc-version-other-window), except for the trailing dot. As a matter
7322 of fact, the two features can each use the files created by the other,
7323 the only difference being that files with a trailing `.' are deleted
7324 automatically after commit. (This feature doesn't work on MS-DOS,
7325 since DOS disallows more than a single dot in the trunk of a file
7326 name.)
7327
7328 If `vc-cvs-stay-local' is on, and there have been changes in the
7329 repository, VC notifies you about it when you actually try to commit.
7330 If you want to check for updates from the repository without trying to
7331 commit, you can either use C-x v m RET to perform an update on the
7332 current file, or you can use C-x v r RET to get an update for an
7333 entire directory tree.
7334
7335 The new user option `vc-cvs-use-edit' indicates whether VC should call
7336 "cvs edit" to make files writeable; it defaults to `t'. (This option
7337 is only meaningful if the CVSREAD variable is set, or if files are
7338 "watched" by other developers.)
7339
7340 The commands C-x v s (vc-create-snapshot) and C-x v r
7341 (vc-retrieve-snapshot) are now also implemented for CVS. If you give
7342 an empty snapshot name to the latter, that performs a `cvs update',
7343 starting at the given directory.
7344
7345 *** Lisp Changes in VC
7346
7347 VC has been restructured internally to make it modular. You can now
7348 add support for arbitrary version control backends by writing a
7349 library that provides a certain set of backend-specific functions, and
7350 then telling VC to use that library. For example, to add support for
7351 a version system named SYS, you write a library named vc-sys.el, which
7352 provides a number of functions vc-sys-... (see commentary at the top
7353 of vc.el for a detailed list of them). To make VC use that library,
7354 you need to put it somewhere into Emacs' load path and add the symbol
7355 `SYS' to the list `vc-handled-backends'.
7356
7357 ** The customizable EDT emulation package now supports the EDT
7358 SUBS command and EDT scroll margins. It also works with more
7359 terminal/keyboard configurations and it now works under XEmacs.
7360 See etc/edt-user.doc for more information.
7361
7362 ** New modes and packages
7363
7364 *** The new global minor mode `minibuffer-electric-default-mode'
7365 automatically hides the `(default ...)' part of minibuffer prompts when
7366 the default is not applicable.
7367
7368 *** Artist is an Emacs lisp package that allows you to draw lines,
7369 rectangles and ellipses by using your mouse and/or keyboard. The
7370 shapes are made up with the ascii characters |, -, / and \.
7371
7372 Features are:
7373
7374 - Intersecting: When a `|' intersects with a `-', a `+' is
7375 drawn, like this: | \ /
7376 --+-- X
7377 | / \
7378
7379 - Rubber-banding: When drawing lines you can interactively see the
7380 result while holding the mouse button down and moving the mouse. If
7381 your machine is not fast enough (a 386 is a bit too slow, but a
7382 pentium is well enough), you can turn this feature off. You will
7383 then see 1's and 2's which mark the 1st and 2nd endpoint of the line
7384 you are drawing.
7385
7386 - Arrows: After having drawn a (straight) line or a (straight)
7387 poly-line, you can set arrows on the line-ends by typing < or >.
7388
7389 - Flood-filling: You can fill any area with a certain character by
7390 flood-filling.
7391
7392 - Cut copy and paste: You can cut, copy and paste rectangular
7393 regions. Artist also interfaces with the rect package (this can be
7394 turned off if it causes you any trouble) so anything you cut in
7395 artist can be yanked with C-x r y and vice versa.
7396
7397 - Drawing with keys: Everything you can do with the mouse, you can
7398 also do without the mouse.
7399
7400 - Aspect-ratio: You can set the variable artist-aspect-ratio to
7401 reflect the height-width ratio for the font you are using. Squares
7402 and circles are then drawn square/round. Note, that once your
7403 ascii-file is shown with font with a different height-width ratio,
7404 the squares won't be square and the circles won't be round.
7405
7406 - Drawing operations: The following drawing operations are implemented:
7407
7408 lines straight-lines
7409 rectangles squares
7410 poly-lines straight poly-lines
7411 ellipses circles
7412 text (see-thru) text (overwrite)
7413 spray-can setting size for spraying
7414 vaporize line vaporize lines
7415 erase characters erase rectangles
7416
7417 Straight lines are lines that go horizontally, vertically or
7418 diagonally. Plain lines go in any direction. The operations in
7419 the right column are accessed by holding down the shift key while
7420 drawing.
7421
7422 It is possible to vaporize (erase) entire lines and connected lines
7423 (rectangles for example) as long as the lines being vaporized are
7424 straight and connected at their endpoints. Vaporizing is inspired
7425 by the drawrect package by Jari Aalto <jari.aalto@poboxes.com>.
7426
7427 - Picture mode compatibility: Artist is picture mode compatible (this
7428 can be turned off).
7429
7430 *** The new package Eshell is an operating system command shell
7431 implemented entirely in Emacs Lisp. Use `M-x eshell' to invoke it.
7432 It functions similarly to bash and zsh, and allows running of Lisp
7433 functions and external commands using the same syntax. It supports
7434 history lists, aliases, extended globbing, smart scrolling, etc. It
7435 will work on any platform Emacs has been ported to. And since most of
7436 the basic commands -- ls, rm, mv, cp, ln, du, cat, etc. -- have been
7437 rewritten in Lisp, it offers an operating-system independent shell,
7438 all within the scope of your Emacs process.
7439
7440 *** The new package timeclock.el is a mode is for keeping track of time
7441 intervals. You can use it for whatever purpose you like, but the
7442 typical scenario is to keep track of how much time you spend working
7443 on certain projects.
7444
7445 *** The new package hi-lock.el provides commands to highlight matches
7446 of interactively entered regexps. For example,
7447
7448 M-x highlight-regexp RET clearly RET RET
7449
7450 will highlight all occurrences of `clearly' using a yellow background
7451 face. New occurrences of `clearly' will be highlighted as they are
7452 typed. `M-x unhighlight-regexp RET' will remove the highlighting.
7453 Any existing face can be used for highlighting and a set of
7454 appropriate faces is provided. The regexps can be written into the
7455 current buffer in a form that will be recognized the next time the
7456 corresponding file is read. There are commands to highlight matches
7457 to phrases and to highlight entire lines containing a match.
7458
7459 *** The new package zone.el plays games with Emacs' display when
7460 Emacs is idle.
7461
7462 *** The new package tildify.el allows to add hard spaces or other text
7463 fragments in accordance with the current major mode.
7464
7465 *** The new package xml.el provides a simple but generic XML
7466 parser. It doesn't parse the DTDs however.
7467
7468 *** The comment operations are now provided by the newcomment.el
7469 package which allows different styles of comment-region and should
7470 be more robust while offering the same functionality.
7471 `comment-region' now doesn't always comment a-line-at-a-time, but only
7472 comments the region, breaking the line at point if necessary.
7473
7474 *** The Ebrowse package implements a C++ class browser and tags
7475 facilities tailored for use with C++. It is documented in a
7476 separate Texinfo file.
7477
7478 *** The PCL-CVS package available by either running M-x cvs-examine or
7479 by visiting a CVS administrative directory (with a prefix argument)
7480 provides an alternative interface to VC-dired for CVS. It comes with
7481 `log-view-mode' to view RCS and SCCS logs and `log-edit-mode' used to
7482 enter check-in log messages.
7483
7484 *** The new package called `woman' allows to browse Unix man pages
7485 without invoking external programs.
7486
7487 The command `M-x woman' formats manual pages entirely in Emacs Lisp
7488 and then displays them, like `M-x manual-entry' does. Unlike
7489 `manual-entry', `woman' does not invoke any external programs, so it
7490 is useful on systems such as MS-DOS/MS-Windows where the `man' and
7491 Groff or `troff' commands are not readily available.
7492
7493 The command `M-x woman-find-file' asks for the file name of a man
7494 page, then formats and displays it like `M-x woman' does.
7495
7496 *** The new command M-x re-builder offers a convenient interface for
7497 authoring regular expressions with immediate visual feedback.
7498
7499 The buffer from which the command was called becomes the target for
7500 the regexp editor popping up in a separate window. Matching text in
7501 the target buffer is immediately color marked during the editing.
7502 Each sub-expression of the regexp will show up in a different face so
7503 even complex regexps can be edited and verified on target data in a
7504 single step.
7505
7506 On displays not supporting faces the matches instead blink like
7507 matching parens to make them stand out. On such a setup you will
7508 probably also want to use the sub-expression mode when the regexp
7509 contains such to get feedback about their respective limits.
7510
7511 *** glasses-mode is a minor mode that makes
7512 unreadableIdentifiersLikeThis readable. It works as glasses, without
7513 actually modifying content of a buffer.
7514
7515 *** The package ebnf2ps translates an EBNF to a syntactic chart in
7516 PostScript.
7517
7518 Currently accepts ad-hoc EBNF, ISO EBNF and Bison/Yacc.
7519
7520 The ad-hoc default EBNF syntax has the following elements:
7521
7522 ; comment (until end of line)
7523 A non-terminal
7524 "C" terminal
7525 ?C? special
7526 $A default non-terminal
7527 $"C" default terminal
7528 $?C? default special
7529 A = B. production (A is the header and B the body)
7530 C D sequence (C occurs before D)
7531 C | D alternative (C or D occurs)
7532 A - B exception (A excluding B, B without any non-terminal)
7533 n * A repetition (A repeats n (integer) times)
7534 (C) group (expression C is grouped together)
7535 [C] optional (C may or not occurs)
7536 C+ one or more occurrences of C
7537 {C}+ one or more occurrences of C
7538 {C}* zero or more occurrences of C
7539 {C} zero or more occurrences of C
7540 C / D equivalent to: C {D C}*
7541 {C || D}+ equivalent to: C {D C}*
7542 {C || D}* equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7543 {C || D} equivalent to: [C {D C}*]
7544
7545 Please, see ebnf2ps documentation for EBNF syntax and how to use it.
7546
7547 *** The package align.el will align columns within a region, using M-x
7548 align. Its mode-specific rules, based on regular expressions,
7549 determine where the columns should be split. In C and C++, for
7550 example, it will align variable names in declaration lists, or the
7551 equal signs of assignments.
7552
7553 *** `paragraph-indent-minor-mode' is a new minor mode supporting
7554 paragraphs in the same style as `paragraph-indent-text-mode'.
7555
7556 *** bs.el is a new package for buffer selection similar to
7557 list-buffers or electric-buffer-list. Use M-x bs-show to display a
7558 buffer menu with this package. See the Custom group `bs'.
7559
7560 *** find-lisp.el is a package emulating the Unix find command in Lisp.
7561
7562 *** calculator.el is a small calculator package that is intended to
7563 replace desktop calculators such as xcalc and calc.exe. Actually, it
7564 is not too small - it has more features than most desktop calculators,
7565 and can be customized easily to get many more functions. It should
7566 not be confused with "calc" which is a much bigger mathematical tool
7567 which answers different needs.
7568
7569 *** The minor modes cwarn-mode and global-cwarn-mode highlights
7570 suspicious C and C++ constructions. Currently, assignments inside
7571 expressions, semicolon following `if', `for' and `while' (except, of
7572 course, after a `do .. while' statement), and C++ functions with
7573 reference parameters are recognized. The modes require font-lock mode
7574 to be enabled.
7575
7576 *** smerge-mode.el provides `smerge-mode', a simple minor-mode for files
7577 containing diff3-style conflict markers, such as generated by RCS.
7578
7579 *** 5x5.el is a simple puzzle game.
7580
7581 *** hl-line.el provides `hl-line-mode', a minor mode to highlight the
7582 current line in the current buffer. It also provides
7583 `global-hl-line-mode' to provide the same behavior in all buffers.
7584
7585 *** ansi-color.el translates ANSI terminal escapes into text-properties.
7586
7587 Please note: if `ansi-color-for-comint-mode' and
7588 `global-font-lock-mode' are non-nil, loading ansi-color.el will
7589 disable font-lock and add `ansi-color-apply' to
7590 `comint-preoutput-filter-functions' for all shell-mode buffers. This
7591 displays the output of "ls --color=yes" using the correct foreground
7592 and background colors.
7593
7594 *** delphi.el provides a major mode for editing the Delphi (Object
7595 Pascal) language.
7596
7597 *** quickurl.el provides a simple method of inserting a URL based on
7598 the text at point.
7599
7600 *** sql.el provides an interface to SQL data bases.
7601
7602 *** fortune.el uses the fortune program to create mail/news signatures.
7603
7604 *** whitespace.el is a package for warning about and cleaning bogus
7605 whitespace in a file.
7606
7607 *** PostScript mode (ps-mode) is a new major mode for editing PostScript
7608 files. It offers: interaction with a PostScript interpreter, including
7609 (very basic) error handling; fontification, easily customizable for
7610 interpreter messages; auto-indentation; insertion of EPSF templates and
7611 often used code snippets; viewing of BoundingBox; commenting out /
7612 uncommenting regions; conversion of 8bit characters to PostScript octal
7613 codes. All functionality is accessible through a menu.
7614
7615 *** delim-col helps to prettify columns in a text region or rectangle.
7616
7617 Here is an example of columns:
7618
7619 horse apple bus
7620 dog pineapple car EXTRA
7621 porcupine strawberry airplane
7622
7623 Doing the following settings:
7624
7625 (setq delimit-columns-str-before "[ ")
7626 (setq delimit-columns-str-after " ]")
7627 (setq delimit-columns-str-separator ", ")
7628 (setq delimit-columns-separator "\t")
7629
7630
7631 Selecting the lines above and typing:
7632
7633 M-x delimit-columns-region
7634
7635 It results:
7636
7637 [ horse , apple , bus , ]
7638 [ dog , pineapple , car , EXTRA ]
7639 [ porcupine, strawberry, airplane, ]
7640
7641 delim-col has the following options:
7642
7643 delimit-columns-str-before Specify a string to be inserted
7644 before all columns.
7645
7646 delimit-columns-str-separator Specify a string to be inserted
7647 between each column.
7648
7649 delimit-columns-str-after Specify a string to be inserted
7650 after all columns.
7651
7652 delimit-columns-separator Specify a regexp which separates
7653 each column.
7654
7655 delim-col has the following commands:
7656
7657 delimit-columns-region Prettify all columns in a text region.
7658 delimit-columns-rectangle Prettify all columns in a text rectangle.
7659
7660 *** Recentf mode maintains a menu for visiting files that were
7661 operated on recently. User option recentf-menu-filter specifies a
7662 menu filter function to change the menu appearance. For example, the
7663 recent file list can be displayed:
7664
7665 - organized by major modes, directories or user defined rules.
7666 - sorted by file paths, file names, ascending or descending.
7667 - showing paths relative to the current default-directory
7668
7669 The `recentf-filter-changer' menu filter function allows to
7670 dynamically change the menu appearance.
7671
7672 *** elide-head.el provides a mechanism for eliding boilerplate header
7673 text.
7674
7675 *** footnote.el provides `footnote-mode', a minor mode supporting use
7676 of footnotes. It is intended for use with Message mode, but isn't
7677 specific to Message mode.
7678
7679 *** diff-mode.el provides `diff-mode', a major mode for
7680 viewing/editing context diffs (patches). It is selected for files
7681 with extension `.diff', `.diffs', `.patch' and `.rej'.
7682
7683 *** EUDC, the Emacs Unified Directory Client, provides a common user
7684 interface to access directory servers using different directory
7685 protocols. It has a separate manual.
7686
7687 *** autoconf.el provides a major mode for editing configure.in files
7688 for Autoconf, selected automatically.
7689
7690 *** windmove.el provides moving between windows.
7691
7692 *** crm.el provides a facility to read multiple strings from the
7693 minibuffer with completion.
7694
7695 *** todo-mode.el provides management of TODO lists and integration
7696 with the diary features.
7697
7698 *** autoarg.el provides a feature reported from Twenex Emacs whereby
7699 numeric keys supply prefix args rather than self inserting.
7700
7701 *** The function `turn-off-auto-fill' unconditionally turns off Auto
7702 Fill mode.
7703
7704 *** pcomplete.el is a library that provides programmable completion
7705 facilities for Emacs, similar to what zsh and tcsh offer. The main
7706 difference is that completion functions are written in Lisp, meaning
7707 they can be profiled, debugged, etc.
7708
7709 *** antlr-mode is a new major mode for editing ANTLR grammar files.
7710 It is automatically turned on for files whose names have the extension
7711 `.g'.
7712
7713 ** Changes in sort.el
7714
7715 The function sort-numeric-fields interprets numbers starting with `0'
7716 as octal and numbers starting with `0x' or `0X' as hexadecimal. The
7717 new user-option sort-numeric-base can be used to specify a default
7718 numeric base.
7719
7720 ** Changes to Ange-ftp
7721
7722 *** Ange-ftp allows you to specify of a port number in remote file
7723 names cleanly. It is appended to the host name, separated by a hash
7724 sign, e.g. `/foo@bar.org#666:mumble'. (This syntax comes from EFS.)
7725
7726 *** If the new user-option `ange-ftp-try-passive-mode' is set, passive
7727 ftp mode will be used if the ftp client supports that.
7728
7729 *** Ange-ftp handles the output of the w32-style clients which
7730 output ^M at the end of lines.
7731
7732 ** The recommended way of using Iswitchb is via the new global minor
7733 mode `iswitchb-mode'.
7734
7735 ** Just loading the msb package doesn't switch on Msb mode anymore.
7736 If you have `(require 'msb)' in your .emacs, please replace it with
7737 `(msb-mode 1)'.
7738
7739 ** Flyspell mode has various new options. See the `flyspell' Custom
7740 group.
7741
7742 ** The user option `backward-delete-char-untabify-method' controls the
7743 behavior of `backward-delete-char-untabify'. The following values
7744 are recognized:
7745
7746 `untabify' -- turn a tab to many spaces, then delete one space;
7747 `hungry' -- delete all whitespace, both tabs and spaces;
7748 `all' -- delete all whitespace, including tabs, spaces and newlines;
7749 nil -- just delete one character.
7750
7751 Default value is `untabify'.
7752
7753 [This change was made in Emacs 20.3 but not mentioned then.]
7754
7755 ** In Cperl mode `cperl-invalid-face' should now be a normal face
7756 symbol, not double-quoted.
7757
7758 ** Some packages are declared obsolete, to be removed in a future
7759 version. They are: auto-show, c-mode, hilit19, hscroll, ooutline,
7760 profile, rnews, rnewspost, and sc. Their implementations have been
7761 moved to lisp/obsolete.
7762
7763 ** auto-compression mode is no longer enabled just by loading jka-compr.el.
7764 To control it, set `auto-compression-mode' via Custom or use the
7765 `auto-compression-mode' command.
7766
7767 ** `browse-url-gnome-moz' is a new option for
7768 `browse-url-browser-function', invoking Mozilla in GNOME, and
7769 `browse-url-kde' can be chosen for invoking the KDE browser.
7770
7771 ** The user-option `browse-url-new-window-p' has been renamed to
7772 `browse-url-new-window-flag'.
7773
7774 ** The functions `keep-lines', `flush-lines' and `how-many' now
7775 operate on the active region in Transient Mark mode.
7776
7777 ** `gnus-user-agent' is a new possibility for `mail-user-agent'. It
7778 is like `message-user-agent', but with all the Gnus paraphernalia.
7779
7780 ** The Strokes package has been updated. If your Emacs has XPM
7781 support, you can use it for pictographic editing. In Strokes mode,
7782 use C-mouse-2 to compose a complex stoke and insert it into the
7783 buffer. You can encode or decode a strokes buffer with new commands
7784 M-x strokes-encode-buffer and M-x strokes-decode-buffer. There is a
7785 new command M-x strokes-list-strokes.
7786
7787 ** Hexl contains a new command `hexl-insert-hex-string' which inserts
7788 a string of hexadecimal numbers read from the mini-buffer.
7789
7790 ** Hexl mode allows to insert non-ASCII characters.
7791
7792 The non-ASCII characters are encoded using the same encoding as the
7793 file you are visiting in Hexl mode.
7794
7795 ** Shell script mode changes.
7796
7797 Shell script mode (sh-script) can now indent scripts for shells
7798 derived from sh and rc. The indentation style is customizable, and
7799 sh-script can attempt to "learn" the current buffer's style.
7800
7801 ** Etags changes.
7802
7803 *** In DOS, etags looks for file.cgz if it cannot find file.c.
7804
7805 *** New option --ignore-case-regex is an alternative to --regex. It is now
7806 possible to bind a regexp to a language, by prepending the regexp with
7807 {lang}, where lang is one of the languages that `etags --help' prints out.
7808 This feature is useful especially for regex files, where each line contains
7809 a regular expression. The manual contains details.
7810
7811 *** In C and derived languages, etags creates tags for function
7812 declarations when given the --declarations option.
7813
7814 *** In C++, tags are created for "operator". The tags have the form
7815 "operator+", without spaces between the keyword and the operator.
7816
7817 *** You shouldn't generally need any more the -C or -c++ option: etags
7818 automatically switches to C++ parsing when it meets the `class' or
7819 `template' keywords.
7820
7821 *** Etags now is able to delve at arbitrary deeps into nested structures in
7822 C-like languages. Previously, it was limited to one or two brace levels.
7823
7824 *** New language Ada: tags are functions, procedures, packages, tasks, and
7825 types.
7826
7827 *** In Fortran, `procedure' is not tagged.
7828
7829 *** In Java, tags are created for "interface".
7830
7831 *** In Lisp, "(defstruct (foo", "(defun (operator" and similar constructs
7832 are now tagged.
7833
7834 *** In makefiles, tags the targets.
7835
7836 *** In Perl, the --globals option tags global variables. my and local
7837 variables are tagged.
7838
7839 *** New language Python: def and class at the beginning of a line are tags.
7840
7841 *** .ss files are Scheme files, .pdb is Postscript with C syntax, .psw is
7842 for PSWrap.
7843
7844 ** Changes in etags.el
7845
7846 *** The new user-option tags-case-fold-search can be used to make
7847 tags operations case-sensitive or case-insensitive. The default
7848 is to use the same setting as case-fold-search.
7849
7850 *** You can display additional output with M-x tags-apropos by setting
7851 the new variable tags-apropos-additional-actions.
7852
7853 If non-nil, the variable's value should be a list of triples (TITLE
7854 FUNCTION TO-SEARCH). For each triple, M-x tags-apropos processes
7855 TO-SEARCH and lists tags from it. TO-SEARCH should be an alist,
7856 obarray, or symbol. If it is a symbol, the symbol's value is used.
7857
7858 TITLE is a string to use to label the list of tags from TO-SEARCH.
7859
7860 FUNCTION is a function to call when an entry is selected in the Tags
7861 List buffer. It is called with one argument, the selected symbol.
7862
7863 A useful example value for this variable might be something like:
7864
7865 '(("Emacs Lisp" Info-goto-emacs-command-node obarray)
7866 ("Common Lisp" common-lisp-hyperspec common-lisp-hyperspec-obarray)
7867 ("SCWM" scwm-documentation scwm-obarray))
7868
7869 *** The face tags-tag-face can be used to customize the appearance
7870 of tags in the output of M-x tags-apropos.
7871
7872 *** Setting tags-apropos-verbose to a non-nil value displays the
7873 names of tags files in the *Tags List* buffer.
7874
7875 *** You can now search for tags that are part of the filename itself.
7876 If you have tagged the files topfile.c subdir/subfile.c
7877 /tmp/tempfile.c, you can now search for tags "topfile.c", "subfile.c",
7878 "dir/sub", "tempfile", "tempfile.c". If the tag matches the file name,
7879 point will go to the beginning of the file.
7880
7881 *** Compressed files are now transparently supported if
7882 auto-compression-mode is active. You can tag (with Etags) and search
7883 (with find-tag) both compressed and uncompressed files.
7884
7885 *** Tags commands like M-x tags-search no longer change point
7886 in buffers where no match is found. In buffers where a match is
7887 found, the original value of point is pushed on the marker ring.
7888
7889 ** Fortran mode has a new command `fortran-strip-sequence-nos' to
7890 remove text past column 72. The syntax class of `\' in Fortran is now
7891 appropriate for C-style escape sequences in strings.
7892
7893 ** SGML mode's default `sgml-validate-command' is now `nsgmls'.
7894
7895 ** A new command `view-emacs-problems' (C-h P) displays the PROBLEMS file.
7896
7897 ** The Dabbrev package has a new user-option `dabbrev-ignored-regexps'
7898 containing a list of regular expressions. Buffers matching a regular
7899 expression from that list, are not checked.
7900
7901 ** Emacs can now figure out modification times of remote files.
7902 When you do C-x C-f /user@host:/path/file RET and edit the file,
7903 and someone else modifies the file, you will be prompted to revert
7904 the buffer, just like for the local files.
7905
7906 ** The buffer menu (C-x C-b) no longer lists the *Buffer List* buffer.
7907
7908 ** When invoked with a prefix argument, the command `list-abbrevs' now
7909 displays local abbrevs, only.
7910
7911 ** Refill minor mode provides preliminary support for keeping
7912 paragraphs filled as you modify them.
7913
7914 ** The variable `double-click-fuzz' specifies how much the mouse
7915 may be moved between clicks that are recognized as a pair. Its value
7916 is measured in pixels.
7917
7918 ** The new global minor mode `auto-image-file-mode' allows image files
7919 to be visited as images.
7920
7921 ** Two new user-options `grep-command' and `grep-find-command'
7922 were added to compile.el.
7923
7924 ** Withdrawn packages
7925
7926 *** mldrag.el has been removed. mouse.el provides the same
7927 functionality with aliases for the mldrag functions.
7928
7929 *** eval-reg.el has been obsoleted by changes to edebug.el and removed.
7930
7931 *** ph.el has been obsoleted by EUDC and removed.
7932
7933
7934 * Incompatible Lisp changes
7935
7936 There are a few Lisp changes which are not backwards-compatible and
7937 may require changes to existing code. Here is a list for reference.
7938 See the sections below for details.
7939
7940 ** Since `format' preserves text properties, the idiom
7941 `(format "%s" foo)' no longer works to copy and remove properties.
7942 Use `copy-sequence' to copy the string, then use `set-text-properties'
7943 to remove the properties of the copy.
7944
7945 ** Since the `keymap' text property now has significance, some code
7946 which uses both `local-map' and `keymap' properties (for portability)
7947 may, for instance, give rise to duplicate menus when the keymaps from
7948 these properties are active.
7949
7950 ** The change in the treatment of non-ASCII characters in search
7951 ranges may affect some code.
7952
7953 ** A non-nil value for the LOCAL arg of add-hook makes the hook
7954 buffer-local even if `make-local-hook' hasn't been called, which might
7955 make a difference to some code.
7956
7957 ** The new treatment of the minibuffer prompt might affect code which
7958 operates on the minibuffer.
7959
7960 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
7961 cause `no-conversion' and `emacs-mule-unix' coding systems to produce
7962 different results when reading files with non-ASCII characters
7963 (previously, both coding systems would produce the same results).
7964 Specifically, `no-conversion' interprets each 8-bit byte as a separate
7965 character. This makes `no-conversion' inappropriate for reading
7966 multibyte text, e.g. buffers written to disk in their internal MULE
7967 encoding (auto-saving does that, for example). If a Lisp program
7968 reads such files with `no-conversion', each byte of the multibyte
7969 sequence, including the MULE leading codes such as \201, is treated as
7970 a separate character, which prevents them from being interpreted in
7971 the buffer as multibyte characters.
7972
7973 Therefore, Lisp programs that read files which contain the internal
7974 MULE encoding should use `emacs-mule-unix'. `no-conversion' is only
7975 appropriate for reading truly binary files.
7976
7977 ** Code that relies on the obsolete `before-change-function' and
7978 `after-change-function' to detect buffer changes will now fail. Use
7979 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions' instead.
7980
7981 ** Code that uses `concat' with integer args now gets an error, as
7982 long promised. So does any code that uses derivatives of `concat',
7983 such as `mapconcat'.
7984
7985 ** The function base64-decode-string now always returns a unibyte
7986 string.
7987
7988 ** Not a Lisp incompatibility as such but, with the introduction of
7989 extra private charsets, there is now only one slot free for a new
7990 dimension-2 private charset. User code which tries to add more than
7991 one extra will fail unless you rebuild Emacs with some standard
7992 charset(s) removed; that is probably inadvisable because it changes
7993 the emacs-mule encoding. Also, files stored in the emacs-mule
7994 encoding using Emacs 20 with additional private charsets defined will
7995 probably not be read correctly by Emacs 21.
7996
7997 ** The variable `directory-sep-char' is slated for removal.
7998 Not really a change (yet), but a projected one that you should be
7999 aware of: The variable `directory-sep-char' is deprecated, and should
8000 not be used. It was always ignored on GNU/Linux and Unix systems and
8001 on MS-DOS, but the MS-Windows port tried to support it by adapting the
8002 behavior of certain primitives to the value of this variable. It
8003 turned out that such support cannot be reliable, so it was decided to
8004 remove this variable in the near future. Lisp programs are well
8005 advised not to set it to anything but '/', because any different value
8006 will not have any effect when support for this variable is removed.
8007
8008
8009 * Lisp changes made after edition 2.6 of the Emacs Lisp Manual,
8010 (Display-related features are described in a page of their own below.)
8011
8012 ** Function assq-delete-all replaces function assoc-delete-all.
8013
8014 ** The new function animate-string, from lisp/play/animate.el
8015 allows the animated display of strings.
8016
8017 ** The new function `interactive-form' can be used to obtain the
8018 interactive form of a function.
8019
8020 ** The keyword :set-after in defcustom allows to specify dependencies
8021 between custom options. Example:
8022
8023 (defcustom default-input-method nil
8024 "*Default input method for multilingual text (a string).
8025 This is the input method activated automatically by the command
8026 `toggle-input-method' (\\[toggle-input-method])."
8027 :group 'mule
8028 :type '(choice (const nil) string)
8029 :set-after '(current-language-environment))
8030
8031 This specifies that default-input-method should be set after
8032 current-language-environment even if default-input-method appears
8033 first in a custom-set-variables statement.
8034
8035 ** The new hook `kbd-macro-termination-hook' is run at the end of
8036 function execute-kbd-macro. Functions on this hook are called with no
8037 args. The hook is run independent of how the macro was terminated
8038 (signal or normal termination).
8039
8040 ** Functions `butlast' and `nbutlast' for removing trailing elements
8041 from a list are now available without requiring the CL package.
8042
8043 ** The new user-option `even-window-heights' can be set to nil
8044 to prevent `display-buffer' from evening out window heights.
8045
8046 ** The user-option `face-font-registry-alternatives' specifies
8047 alternative font registry names to try when looking for a font.
8048
8049 ** Function `md5' calculates the MD5 "message digest"/"checksum".
8050
8051 ** Function `delete-frame' runs `delete-frame-hook' before actually
8052 deleting the frame. The hook is called with one arg, the frame
8053 being deleted.
8054
8055 ** `add-hook' now makes the hook local if called with a non-nil LOCAL arg.
8056
8057 ** The treatment of non-ASCII characters in search ranges has changed.
8058 If a range in a regular expression or the arg of
8059 skip-chars-forward/backward starts with a unibyte character C and ends
8060 with a multibyte character C2, the range is divided into two: one is
8061 C..?\377, the other is C1..C2, where C1 is the first character of C2's
8062 charset.
8063
8064 ** The new function `display-message-or-buffer' displays a message in
8065 the echo area or pops up a buffer, depending on the length of the
8066 message.
8067
8068 ** The new macro `with-auto-compression-mode' allows evaluating an
8069 expression with auto-compression-mode enabled.
8070
8071 ** In image specifications, `:heuristic-mask' has been replaced
8072 with the more general `:mask' property.
8073
8074 ** Image specifications accept more `:conversion's.
8075
8076 ** A `?' can be used in a symbol name without escaping it with a
8077 backslash.
8078
8079 ** Reading from the mini-buffer now reads from standard input if Emacs
8080 is running in batch mode. For example,
8081
8082 (message "%s" (read t))
8083
8084 will read a Lisp expression from standard input and print the result
8085 to standard output.
8086
8087 ** The argument of `down-list', `backward-up-list', `up-list',
8088 `kill-sexp', `backward-kill-sexp' and `mark-sexp' is now optional.
8089
8090 ** If `display-buffer-reuse-frames' is set, function `display-buffer'
8091 will raise frames displaying a buffer, instead of creating a new
8092 frame or window.
8093
8094 ** Two new functions for removing elements from lists/sequences
8095 were added
8096
8097 - Function: remove ELT SEQ
8098
8099 Return a copy of SEQ with all occurrences of ELT removed. SEQ must be
8100 a list, vector, or string. The comparison is done with `equal'.
8101
8102 - Function: remq ELT LIST
8103
8104 Return a copy of LIST with all occurrences of ELT removed. The
8105 comparison is done with `eq'.
8106
8107 ** The function `delete' now also works with vectors and strings.
8108
8109 ** The meaning of the `:weakness WEAK' argument of make-hash-table
8110 has been changed: WEAK can now have new values `key-or-value' and
8111 `key-and-value', in addition to `nil', `key', `value', and `t'.
8112
8113 ** Function `aset' stores any multibyte character in any string
8114 without signaling "Attempt to change char length of a string". It may
8115 convert a unibyte string to multibyte if necessary.
8116
8117 ** The value of the `help-echo' text property is called as a function
8118 or evaluated, if it is not a string already, to obtain a help string.
8119
8120 ** Function `make-obsolete' now has an optional arg to say when the
8121 function was declared obsolete.
8122
8123 ** Function `plist-member' is renamed from `widget-plist-member' (which is
8124 retained as an alias).
8125
8126 ** Easy-menu's :filter now takes the unconverted form of the menu and
8127 the result is automatically converted to Emacs' form.
8128
8129 ** The new function `window-list' has been defined
8130
8131 - Function: window-list &optional FRAME WINDOW MINIBUF
8132
8133 Return a list of windows on FRAME, starting with WINDOW. FRAME nil or
8134 omitted means use the selected frame. WINDOW nil or omitted means use
8135 the selected window. MINIBUF t means include the minibuffer window,
8136 even if it isn't active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means include the
8137 minibuffer window only if it's active. MINIBUF neither nil nor t
8138 means never include the minibuffer window.
8139
8140 ** There's a new function `get-window-with-predicate' defined as follows
8141
8142 - Function: get-window-with-predicate PREDICATE &optional MINIBUF ALL-FRAMES DEFAULT
8143
8144 Return a window satisfying PREDICATE.
8145
8146 This function cycles through all visible windows using `walk-windows',
8147 calling PREDICATE on each one. PREDICATE is called with a window as
8148 argument. The first window for which PREDICATE returns a non-nil
8149 value is returned. If no window satisfies PREDICATE, DEFAULT is
8150 returned.
8151
8152 Optional second arg MINIBUF t means count the minibuffer window even
8153 if not active. MINIBUF nil or omitted means count the minibuffer iff
8154 it is active. MINIBUF neither t nor nil means not to count the
8155 minibuffer even if it is active.
8156
8157 Several frames may share a single minibuffer; if the minibuffer
8158 counts, all windows on all frames that share that minibuffer count
8159 too. Therefore, if you are using a separate minibuffer frame
8160 and the minibuffer is active and MINIBUF says it counts,
8161 `walk-windows' includes the windows in the frame from which you
8162 entered the minibuffer, as well as the minibuffer window.
8163
8164 ALL-FRAMES is the optional third argument.
8165 ALL-FRAMES nil or omitted means cycle within the frames as specified above.
8166 ALL-FRAMES = `visible' means include windows on all visible frames.
8167 ALL-FRAMES = 0 means include windows on all visible and iconified frames.
8168 ALL-FRAMES = t means include windows on all frames including invisible frames.
8169 If ALL-FRAMES is a frame, it means include windows on that frame.
8170 Anything else means restrict to the selected frame.
8171
8172 ** The function `single-key-description' now encloses function key and
8173 event names in angle brackets. When called with a second optional
8174 argument non-nil, angle brackets won't be printed.
8175
8176 ** If the variable `message-truncate-lines' is bound to t around a
8177 call to `message', the echo area will not be resized to display that
8178 message; it will be truncated instead, as it was done in 20.x.
8179 Default value is nil.
8180
8181 ** The user option `line-number-display-limit' can now be set to nil,
8182 meaning no limit.
8183
8184 ** The new user option `line-number-display-limit-width' controls
8185 the maximum width of lines in a buffer for which Emacs displays line
8186 numbers in the mode line. The default is 200.
8187
8188 ** `select-safe-coding-system' now also checks the most preferred
8189 coding-system if buffer-file-coding-system is `undecided' and
8190 DEFAULT-CODING-SYSTEM is not specified,
8191
8192 ** The function `subr-arity' provides information about the argument
8193 list of a primitive.
8194
8195 ** `where-is-internal' now also accepts a list of keymaps.
8196
8197 ** The text property `keymap' specifies a key map which overrides the
8198 buffer's local map and the map specified by the `local-map' property.
8199 This is probably what most current uses of `local-map' want, rather
8200 than replacing the local map.
8201
8202 ** The obsolete variables `before-change-function' and
8203 `after-change-function' are no longer acted upon and have been
8204 removed. Use `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions'
8205 instead.
8206
8207 ** The function `apropos-mode' runs the hook `apropos-mode-hook'.
8208
8209 ** `concat' no longer accepts individual integer arguments,
8210 as promised long ago.
8211
8212 ** The new function `float-time' returns the current time as a float.
8213
8214 ** The new variable auto-coding-regexp-alist specifies coding systems
8215 for reading specific files, analogous to auto-coding-alist, but
8216 patterns are checked against file contents instead of file names.
8217
8218
8219 * Lisp changes in Emacs 21.1 (see following page for display-related features)
8220
8221 ** The new package rx.el provides an alternative sexp notation for
8222 regular expressions.
8223
8224 - Function: rx-to-string SEXP
8225
8226 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8227
8228 - Macro: rx SEXP
8229
8230 Translate SEXP into a regular expression in string notation.
8231
8232 The following are valid subforms of regular expressions in sexp
8233 notation.
8234
8235 STRING
8236 matches string STRING literally.
8237
8238 CHAR
8239 matches character CHAR literally.
8240
8241 `not-newline'
8242 matches any character except a newline.
8243 .
8244 `anything'
8245 matches any character
8246
8247 `(any SET)'
8248 matches any character in SET. SET may be a character or string.
8249 Ranges of characters can be specified as `A-Z' in strings.
8250
8251 '(in SET)'
8252 like `any'.
8253
8254 `(not (any SET))'
8255 matches any character not in SET
8256
8257 `line-start'
8258 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of a line
8259 in the text being matched
8260
8261 `line-end'
8262 is similar to `line-start' but matches only at the end of a line
8263
8264 `string-start'
8265 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8266 string being matched against.
8267
8268 `string-end'
8269 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8270 string being matched against.
8271
8272 `buffer-start'
8273 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning of the
8274 buffer being matched against.
8275
8276 `buffer-end'
8277 matches the empty string, but only at the end of the
8278 buffer being matched against.
8279
8280 `point'
8281 matches the empty string, but only at point.
8282
8283 `word-start'
8284 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8285 word.
8286
8287 `word-end'
8288 matches the empty string, but only at the end of a word.
8289
8290 `word-boundary'
8291 matches the empty string, but only at the beginning or end of a
8292 word.
8293
8294 `(not word-boundary)'
8295 matches the empty string, but not at the beginning or end of a
8296 word.
8297
8298 `digit'
8299 matches 0 through 9.
8300
8301 `control'
8302 matches ASCII control characters.
8303
8304 `hex-digit'
8305 matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8306
8307 `blank'
8308 matches space and tab only.
8309
8310 `graphic'
8311 matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8312 space, and DEL.
8313
8314 `printing'
8315 matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8316 and DEL.
8317
8318 `alphanumeric'
8319 matches letters and digits. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8320 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8321
8322 `letter'
8323 matches letters. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8324 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8325
8326 `ascii'
8327 matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8328
8329 `nonascii'
8330 matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8331
8332 `lower'
8333 matches anything lower-case.
8334
8335 `upper'
8336 matches anything upper-case.
8337
8338 `punctuation'
8339 matches punctuation. (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8340 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8341
8342 `space'
8343 matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8344
8345 `word'
8346 matches anything that has word syntax.
8347
8348 `(syntax SYNTAX)'
8349 matches a character with syntax SYNTAX. SYNTAX must be one
8350 of the following symbols.
8351
8352 `whitespace' (\\s- in string notation)
8353 `punctuation' (\\s.)
8354 `word' (\\sw)
8355 `symbol' (\\s_)
8356 `open-parenthesis' (\\s()
8357 `close-parenthesis' (\\s))
8358 `expression-prefix' (\\s')
8359 `string-quote' (\\s\")
8360 `paired-delimiter' (\\s$)
8361 `escape' (\\s\\)
8362 `character-quote' (\\s/)
8363 `comment-start' (\\s<)
8364 `comment-end' (\\s>)
8365
8366 `(not (syntax SYNTAX))'
8367 matches a character that has not syntax SYNTAX.
8368
8369 `(category CATEGORY)'
8370 matches a character with category CATEGORY. CATEGORY must be
8371 either a character to use for C, or one of the following symbols.
8372
8373 `consonant' (\\c0 in string notation)
8374 `base-vowel' (\\c1)
8375 `upper-diacritical-mark' (\\c2)
8376 `lower-diacritical-mark' (\\c3)
8377 `tone-mark' (\\c4)
8378 `symbol' (\\c5)
8379 `digit' (\\c6)
8380 `vowel-modifying-diacritical-mark' (\\c7)
8381 `vowel-sign' (\\c8)
8382 `semivowel-lower' (\\c9)
8383 `not-at-end-of-line' (\\c<)
8384 `not-at-beginning-of-line' (\\c>)
8385 `alpha-numeric-two-byte' (\\cA)
8386 `chinse-two-byte' (\\cC)
8387 `greek-two-byte' (\\cG)
8388 `japanese-hiragana-two-byte' (\\cH)
8389 `indian-two-byte' (\\cI)
8390 `japanese-katakana-two-byte' (\\cK)
8391 `korean-hangul-two-byte' (\\cN)
8392 `cyrillic-two-byte' (\\cY)
8393 `ascii' (\\ca)
8394 `arabic' (\\cb)
8395 `chinese' (\\cc)
8396 `ethiopic' (\\ce)
8397 `greek' (\\cg)
8398 `korean' (\\ch)
8399 `indian' (\\ci)
8400 `japanese' (\\cj)
8401 `japanese-katakana' (\\ck)
8402 `latin' (\\cl)
8403 `lao' (\\co)
8404 `tibetan' (\\cq)
8405 `japanese-roman' (\\cr)
8406 `thai' (\\ct)
8407 `vietnamese' (\\cv)
8408 `hebrew' (\\cw)
8409 `cyrillic' (\\cy)
8410 `can-break' (\\c|)
8411
8412 `(not (category CATEGORY))'
8413 matches a character that has not category CATEGORY.
8414
8415 `(and SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8416 matches what SEXP1 matches, followed by what SEXP2 matches, etc.
8417
8418 `(submatch SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8419 like `and', but makes the match accessible with `match-end',
8420 `match-beginning', and `match-string'.
8421
8422 `(group SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8423 another name for `submatch'.
8424
8425 `(or SEXP1 SEXP2 ...)'
8426 matches anything that matches SEXP1 or SEXP2, etc. If all
8427 args are strings, use `regexp-opt' to optimize the resulting
8428 regular expression.
8429
8430 `(minimal-match SEXP)'
8431 produce a non-greedy regexp for SEXP. Normally, regexps matching
8432 zero or more occurrences of something are \"greedy\" in that they
8433 match as much as they can, as long as the overall regexp can
8434 still match. A non-greedy regexp matches as little as possible.
8435
8436 `(maximal-match SEXP)'
8437 produce a greedy regexp for SEXP. This is the default.
8438
8439 `(zero-or-more SEXP)'
8440 matches zero or more occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8441
8442 `(0+ SEXP)'
8443 like `zero-or-more'.
8444
8445 `(* SEXP)'
8446 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8447
8448 `(*? SEXP)'
8449 like `zero-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8450
8451 `(one-or-more SEXP)'
8452 matches one or more occurrences of A.
8453
8454 `(1+ SEXP)'
8455 like `one-or-more'.
8456
8457 `(+ SEXP)'
8458 like `one-or-more', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8459
8460 `(+? SEXP)'
8461 like `one-or-more', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8462
8463 `(zero-or-one SEXP)'
8464 matches zero or one occurrences of A.
8465
8466 `(optional SEXP)'
8467 like `zero-or-one'.
8468
8469 `(? SEXP)'
8470 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a greedy regexp.
8471
8472 `(?? SEXP)'
8473 like `zero-or-one', but always produces a non-greedy regexp.
8474
8475 `(repeat N SEXP)'
8476 matches N occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8477
8478 `(repeat N M SEXP)'
8479 matches N to M occurrences of what SEXP matches.
8480
8481 `(eval FORM)'
8482 evaluate FORM and insert result. If result is a string,
8483 `regexp-quote' it.
8484
8485 `(regexp REGEXP)'
8486 include REGEXP in string notation in the result.
8487
8488 *** The features `md5' and `overlay' are now provided by default.
8489
8490 *** The special form `save-restriction' now works correctly even if the
8491 buffer is widened inside the save-restriction and changes made outside
8492 the original restriction. Previously, doing this would cause the saved
8493 restriction to be restored incorrectly.
8494
8495 *** The functions `find-charset-region' and `find-charset-string' include
8496 `eight-bit-control' and/or `eight-bit-graphic' in the returned list
8497 when they find 8-bit characters. Previously, they included `ascii' in a
8498 multibyte buffer and `unknown' in a unibyte buffer.
8499
8500 *** The functions `set-buffer-multibyte', `string-as-multibyte' and
8501 `string-as-unibyte' change the byte sequence of a buffer or a string
8502 if it contains a character from the `eight-bit-control' character set.
8503
8504 *** The handling of multibyte sequences in a multibyte buffer is
8505 changed. Previously, a byte sequence matching the pattern
8506 [\200-\237][\240-\377]+ was interpreted as a single character
8507 regardless of the length of the trailing bytes [\240-\377]+. Thus, if
8508 the sequence was longer than what the leading byte indicated, the
8509 extra trailing bytes were ignored by Lisp functions. Now such extra
8510 bytes are independent 8-bit characters belonging to the charset
8511 eight-bit-graphic.
8512
8513 ** Fontsets are now implemented using char-tables.
8514
8515 A fontset can now be specified for each independent character, for
8516 a group of characters or for a character set rather than just for a
8517 character set as previously.
8518
8519 *** The arguments of the function `set-fontset-font' are changed.
8520 They are NAME, CHARACTER, FONTNAME, and optional FRAME. The function
8521 modifies fontset NAME to use FONTNAME for CHARACTER.
8522
8523 CHARACTER may be a cons (FROM . TO), where FROM and TO are non-generic
8524 characters. In that case FONTNAME is used for all characters in the
8525 range FROM and TO (inclusive). CHARACTER may be a charset. In that
8526 case FONTNAME is used for all character in the charset.
8527
8528 FONTNAME may be a cons (FAMILY . REGISTRY), where FAMILY is the family
8529 name of a font and REGISTRY is a registry name of a font.
8530
8531 *** Variable x-charset-registry has been deleted. The default charset
8532 registries of character sets are set in the default fontset
8533 "fontset-default".
8534
8535 *** The function `create-fontset-from-fontset-spec' ignores the second
8536 argument STYLE-VARIANT. It never creates style-variant fontsets.
8537
8538 ** The method of composing characters is changed. Now character
8539 composition is done by a special text property `composition' in
8540 buffers and strings.
8541
8542 *** Charset composition is deleted. Emacs never creates a `composite
8543 character' which is an independent character with a unique character
8544 code. Thus the following functions handling `composite characters'
8545 have been deleted: composite-char-component,
8546 composite-char-component-count, composite-char-composition-rule,
8547 composite-char-composition-rule and decompose-composite-char delete.
8548 The variables leading-code-composition and min-composite-char have
8549 also been deleted.
8550
8551 *** Three more glyph reference points are added. They can be used to
8552 specify a composition rule. See the documentation of the variable
8553 `reference-point-alist' for more detail.
8554
8555 *** The function `compose-region' takes new arguments COMPONENTS and
8556 MODIFICATION-FUNC. With COMPONENTS, you can specify not only a
8557 composition rule but also characters to be composed. Such characters
8558 may differ between buffer and string text.
8559
8560 *** The function `compose-string' takes new arguments START, END,
8561 COMPONENTS, and MODIFICATION-FUNC.
8562
8563 *** The function `compose-string' puts text property `composition'
8564 directly on the argument STRING instead of returning a new string.
8565 Likewise, the function `decompose-string' just removes text property
8566 `composition' from STRING.
8567
8568 *** The new function `find-composition' returns information about
8569 a composition at a specified position in a buffer or a string.
8570
8571 *** The function `decompose-composite-char' is now labeled as
8572 obsolete.
8573
8574 ** The new coding system `mac-roman' is primarily intended for use on
8575 the Macintosh but may be used generally for Macintosh-encoded text.
8576
8577 ** The new character sets `mule-unicode-0100-24ff',
8578 `mule-unicode-2500-33ff', and `mule-unicode-e000-ffff' have been
8579 introduced for Unicode characters in the range U+0100..U+24FF,
8580 U+2500..U+33FF, U+E000..U+FFFF respectively.
8581
8582 Note that the character sets are not yet unified in Emacs, so
8583 characters which belong to charsets such as Latin-2, Greek, Hebrew,
8584 etc. and the same characters in the `mule-unicode-*' charsets are
8585 different characters, as far as Emacs is concerned. For example, text
8586 which includes Unicode characters from the Latin-2 locale cannot be
8587 encoded by Emacs with ISO 8859-2 coding system.
8588
8589 ** The new coding system `mule-utf-8' has been added.
8590 It provides limited support for decoding/encoding UTF-8 text. For
8591 details, please see the documentation string of this coding system.
8592
8593 ** The new character sets `japanese-jisx0213-1' and
8594 `japanese-jisx0213-2' have been introduced for the new Japanese
8595 standard JIS X 0213 Plane 1 and Plane 2.
8596
8597 ** The new character sets `latin-iso8859-14' and `latin-iso8859-15'
8598 have been introduced.
8599
8600 ** The new character sets `eight-bit-control' and `eight-bit-graphic'
8601 have been introduced for 8-bit characters in the ranges 0x80..0x9F and
8602 0xA0..0xFF respectively. Note that the multibyte representation of
8603 eight-bit-control is never exposed; this leads to an exception in the
8604 emacs-mule coding system, which encodes everything else to the
8605 buffer/string internal representation. Note that to search for
8606 eight-bit-graphic characters in a multibyte buffer, the search string
8607 must be multibyte, otherwise such characters will be converted to
8608 their multibyte equivalent.
8609
8610 ** If the APPEND argument of `write-region' is an integer, it seeks to
8611 that offset in the file before writing.
8612
8613 ** The function `add-minor-mode' has been added for convenience and
8614 compatibility with XEmacs (and is used internally by define-minor-mode).
8615
8616 ** The function `shell-command' now sets the default directory of the
8617 `*Shell Command Output*' buffer to the default directory of the buffer
8618 from which the command was issued.
8619
8620 ** The functions `query-replace', `query-replace-regexp',
8621 `query-replace-regexp-eval' `map-query-replace-regexp',
8622 `replace-string', `replace-regexp', and `perform-replace' take two
8623 additional optional arguments START and END that specify the region to
8624 operate on.
8625
8626 ** The new function `count-screen-lines' is a more flexible alternative
8627 to `window-buffer-height'.
8628
8629 - Function: count-screen-lines &optional BEG END COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE WINDOW
8630
8631 Return the number of screen lines in the region between BEG and END.
8632 The number of screen lines may be different from the number of actual
8633 lines, due to line breaking, display table, etc.
8634
8635 Optional arguments BEG and END default to `point-min' and `point-max'
8636 respectively.
8637
8638 If region ends with a newline, ignore it unless optional third argument
8639 COUNT-FINAL-NEWLINE is non-nil.
8640
8641 The optional fourth argument WINDOW specifies the window used for
8642 obtaining parameters such as width, horizontal scrolling, and so
8643 on. The default is to use the selected window's parameters.
8644
8645 Like `vertical-motion', `count-screen-lines' always uses the current
8646 buffer, regardless of which buffer is displayed in WINDOW. This makes
8647 possible to use `count-screen-lines' in any buffer, whether or not it
8648 is currently displayed in some window.
8649
8650 ** The new function `mapc' is like `mapcar' but doesn't collect the
8651 argument function's results.
8652
8653 ** The functions base64-decode-region and base64-decode-string now
8654 signal an error instead of returning nil if decoding fails. Also,
8655 `base64-decode-string' now always returns a unibyte string (in Emacs
8656 20, it returned a multibyte string when the result was a valid multibyte
8657 sequence).
8658
8659 ** The function sendmail-user-agent-compose now recognizes a `body'
8660 header in the list of headers passed to it.
8661
8662 ** The new function member-ignore-case works like `member', but
8663 ignores differences in case and text representation.
8664
8665 ** The buffer-local variable cursor-type can be used to specify the
8666 cursor to use in windows displaying a buffer. Values are interpreted
8667 as follows:
8668
8669 t use the cursor specified for the frame (default)
8670 nil don't display a cursor
8671 `bar' display a bar cursor with default width
8672 (bar . WIDTH) display a bar cursor with width WIDTH
8673 others display a box cursor.
8674
8675 ** The variable open-paren-in-column-0-is-defun-start controls whether
8676 an open parenthesis in column 0 is considered to be the start of a
8677 defun. If set, the default, it is considered a defun start. If not
8678 set, an open parenthesis in column 0 has no special meaning.
8679
8680 ** The new function `string-to-syntax' can be used to translate syntax
8681 specifications in string form as accepted by `modify-syntax-entry' to
8682 the cons-cell form that is used for the values of the `syntax-table'
8683 text property, and in `font-lock-syntactic-keywords'.
8684
8685 Example:
8686
8687 (string-to-syntax "()")
8688 => (4 . 41)
8689
8690 ** Emacs' reader supports CL read syntax for integers in bases
8691 other than 10.
8692
8693 *** `#BINTEGER' or `#bINTEGER' reads INTEGER in binary (radix 2).
8694 INTEGER optionally contains a sign.
8695
8696 #b1111
8697 => 15
8698 #b-1111
8699 => -15
8700
8701 *** `#OINTEGER' or `#oINTEGER' reads INTEGER in octal (radix 8).
8702
8703 #o666
8704 => 438
8705
8706 *** `#XINTEGER' or `#xINTEGER' reads INTEGER in hexadecimal (radix 16).
8707
8708 #xbeef
8709 => 48815
8710
8711 *** `#RADIXrINTEGER' reads INTEGER in radix RADIX, 2 <= RADIX <= 36.
8712
8713 #2R-111
8714 => -7
8715 #25rah
8716 => 267
8717
8718 ** The function `documentation-property' now evaluates the value of
8719 the given property to obtain a string if it doesn't refer to etc/DOC
8720 and isn't a string.
8721
8722 ** If called for a symbol, the function `documentation' now looks for
8723 a `function-documentation' property of that symbol. If it has a non-nil
8724 value, the documentation is taken from that value. If the value is
8725 not a string, it is evaluated to obtain a string.
8726
8727 ** The last argument of `define-key-after' defaults to t for convenience.
8728
8729 ** The new function `replace-regexp-in-string' replaces all matches
8730 for a regexp in a string.
8731
8732 ** `mouse-position' now runs the abnormal hook
8733 `mouse-position-function'.
8734
8735 ** The function string-to-number now returns a float for numbers
8736 that don't fit into a Lisp integer.
8737
8738 ** The variable keyword-symbols-constants-flag has been removed.
8739 Keywords are now always considered constants.
8740
8741 ** The new function `delete-and-extract-region' deletes text and
8742 returns it.
8743
8744 ** The function `clear-this-command-keys' now also clears the vector
8745 returned by function `recent-keys'.
8746
8747 ** Variables `beginning-of-defun-function' and `end-of-defun-function'
8748 can be used to define handlers for the functions that find defuns.
8749 Major modes can define these locally instead of rebinding C-M-a
8750 etc. if the normal conventions for defuns are not appropriate for the
8751 mode.
8752
8753 ** easy-mmode-define-minor-mode now takes an additional BODY argument
8754 and is renamed `define-minor-mode'.
8755
8756 ** If an abbrev has a hook function which is a symbol, and that symbol
8757 has a non-nil `no-self-insert' property, the return value of the hook
8758 function specifies whether an expansion has been done or not. If it
8759 returns nil, abbrev-expand also returns nil, meaning "no expansion has
8760 been performed."
8761
8762 When abbrev expansion is done by typing a self-inserting character,
8763 and the abbrev has a hook with the `no-self-insert' property, and the
8764 hook function returns non-nil meaning expansion has been done,
8765 then the self-inserting character is not inserted.
8766
8767 ** The function `intern-soft' now accepts a symbol as first argument.
8768 In this case, that exact symbol is looked up in the specified obarray,
8769 and the function's value is nil if it is not found.
8770
8771 ** The new macro `with-syntax-table' can be used to evaluate forms
8772 with the syntax table of the current buffer temporarily set to a
8773 specified table.
8774
8775 (with-syntax-table TABLE &rest BODY)
8776
8777 Evaluate BODY with syntax table of current buffer set to a copy of
8778 TABLE. The current syntax table is saved, BODY is evaluated, and the
8779 saved table is restored, even in case of an abnormal exit. Value is
8780 what BODY returns.
8781
8782 ** Regular expressions now support intervals \{n,m\} as well as
8783 Perl's shy-groups \(?:...\) and non-greedy *? +? and ?? operators.
8784 Also back-references like \2 are now considered as an error if the
8785 corresponding subgroup does not exist (or is not closed yet).
8786 Previously it would have been silently turned into `2' (ignoring the `\').
8787
8788 ** The optional argument BUFFER of function file-local-copy has been
8789 removed since it wasn't used by anything.
8790
8791 ** The file name argument of function `file-locked-p' is now required
8792 instead of being optional.
8793
8794 ** The new built-in error `text-read-only' is signaled when trying to
8795 modify read-only text.
8796
8797 ** New functions and variables for locales.
8798
8799 The new variable `locale-coding-system' specifies how to encode and
8800 decode strings passed to low-level message functions like strerror and
8801 time functions like strftime. The new variables
8802 `system-messages-locale' and `system-time-locale' give the system
8803 locales to be used when invoking these two types of functions.
8804
8805 The new function `set-locale-environment' sets the language
8806 environment, preferred coding system, and locale coding system from
8807 the system locale as specified by the LC_ALL, LC_CTYPE, and LANG
8808 environment variables. Normally, it is invoked during startup and need
8809 not be invoked thereafter. It uses the new variables
8810 `locale-language-names', `locale-charset-language-names', and
8811 `locale-preferred-coding-systems' to make its decisions.
8812
8813 ** syntax tables now understand nested comments.
8814 To declare a comment syntax as allowing nesting, just add an `n'
8815 modifier to either of the characters of the comment end and the comment
8816 start sequences.
8817
8818 ** The function `pixmap-spec-p' has been renamed `bitmap-spec-p'
8819 because `bitmap' is more in line with the usual X terminology.
8820
8821 ** New function `propertize'
8822
8823 The new function `propertize' can be used to conveniently construct
8824 strings with text properties.
8825
8826 - Function: propertize STRING &rest PROPERTIES
8827
8828 Value is a copy of STRING with text properties assigned as specified
8829 by PROPERTIES. PROPERTIES is a sequence of pairs PROPERTY VALUE, with
8830 PROPERTY being the name of a text property and VALUE being the
8831 specified value of that property. Example:
8832
8833 (propertize "foo" 'face 'bold 'read-only t)
8834
8835 ** push and pop macros.
8836
8837 Simple versions of the push and pop macros of Common Lisp
8838 are now defined in Emacs Lisp. These macros allow only symbols
8839 as the place that holds the list to be changed.
8840
8841 (push NEWELT LISTNAME) add NEWELT to the front of LISTNAME's value.
8842 (pop LISTNAME) return first elt of LISTNAME, and remove it
8843 (thus altering the value of LISTNAME).
8844
8845 ** New dolist and dotimes macros.
8846
8847 Simple versions of the dolist and dotimes macros of Common Lisp
8848 are now defined in Emacs Lisp.
8849
8850 (dolist (VAR LIST [RESULT]) BODY...)
8851 Execute body once for each element of LIST,
8852 using the variable VAR to hold the current element.
8853 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8854
8855 (dotimes (VAR COUNT [RESULT]) BODY...)
8856 Execute BODY with VAR bound to successive integers running from 0,
8857 inclusive, to COUNT, exclusive.
8858 Then return the value of RESULT, or nil if RESULT is omitted.
8859
8860 ** Regular expressions now support Posix character classes such as
8861 [:alpha:], [:space:] and so on. These must be used within a character
8862 class--for instance, [-[:digit:].+] matches digits or a period
8863 or a sign.
8864
8865 [:digit:] matches 0 through 9
8866 [:cntrl:] matches ASCII control characters
8867 [:xdigit:] matches 0 through 9, a through f and A through F.
8868 [:blank:] matches space and tab only
8869 [:graph:] matches graphic characters--everything except ASCII control chars,
8870 space, and DEL.
8871 [:print:] matches printing characters--everything except ASCII control chars
8872 and DEL.
8873 [:alnum:] matches letters and digits.
8874 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8875 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8876 [:alpha:] matches letters.
8877 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8878 it matches anything that has word syntax.)
8879 [:ascii:] matches ASCII (unibyte) characters.
8880 [:nonascii:] matches non-ASCII (multibyte) characters.
8881 [:lower:] matches anything lower-case.
8882 [:punct:] matches punctuation.
8883 (But at present, for multibyte characters,
8884 it matches anything that has non-word syntax.)
8885 [:space:] matches anything that has whitespace syntax.
8886 [:upper:] matches anything upper-case.
8887 [:word:] matches anything that has word syntax.
8888
8889 ** Emacs now has built-in hash tables.
8890
8891 The following functions are defined for hash tables:
8892
8893 - Function: make-hash-table ARGS
8894
8895 The argument list ARGS consists of keyword/argument pairs. All arguments
8896 are optional. The following arguments are defined:
8897
8898 :test TEST
8899
8900 TEST must be a symbol specifying how to compare keys. Default is `eql'.
8901 Predefined are `eq', `eql' and `equal'. If TEST is not predefined,
8902 it must have been defined with `define-hash-table-test'.
8903
8904 :size SIZE
8905
8906 SIZE must be an integer > 0 giving a hint to the implementation how
8907 many elements will be put in the hash table. Default size is 65.
8908
8909 :rehash-size REHASH-SIZE
8910
8911 REHASH-SIZE specifies by how much to grow a hash table once it becomes
8912 full. If REHASH-SIZE is an integer, add that to the hash table's old
8913 size to get the new size. Otherwise, REHASH-SIZE must be a float >
8914 1.0, and the new size is computed by multiplying REHASH-SIZE with the
8915 old size. Default rehash size is 1.5.
8916
8917 :rehash-threshold THRESHOLD
8918
8919 THRESHOLD must be a float > 0 and <= 1.0 specifying when to resize the
8920 hash table. It is resized when the ratio of (number of entries) /
8921 (size of hash table) is >= THRESHOLD. Default threshold is 0.8.
8922
8923 :weakness WEAK
8924
8925 WEAK must be either nil, one of the symbols `key, `value',
8926 `key-or-value', `key-and-value', or t, meaning the same as
8927 `key-and-value'. Entries are removed from weak tables during garbage
8928 collection if their key and/or value are not referenced elsewhere
8929 outside of the hash table. Default are non-weak hash tables.
8930
8931 - Function: makehash &optional TEST
8932
8933 Similar to make-hash-table, but only TEST can be specified.
8934
8935 - Function: hash-table-p TABLE
8936
8937 Returns non-nil if TABLE is a hash table object.
8938
8939 - Function: copy-hash-table TABLE
8940
8941 Returns a copy of TABLE. Only the table itself is copied, keys and
8942 values are shared.
8943
8944 - Function: hash-table-count TABLE
8945
8946 Returns the number of entries in TABLE.
8947
8948 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8949
8950 Returns the rehash size of TABLE.
8951
8952 - Function: hash-table-rehash-threshold TABLE
8953
8954 Returns the rehash threshold of TABLE.
8955
8956 - Function: hash-table-rehash-size TABLE
8957
8958 Returns the size of TABLE.
8959
8960 - Function: hash-table-test TABLE
8961
8962 Returns the test TABLE uses to compare keys.
8963
8964 - Function: hash-table-weakness TABLE
8965
8966 Returns the weakness specified for TABLE.
8967
8968 - Function: clrhash TABLE
8969
8970 Clear TABLE.
8971
8972 - Function: gethash KEY TABLE &optional DEFAULT
8973
8974 Look up KEY in TABLE and return its associated VALUE or DEFAULT if
8975 not found.
8976
8977 - Function: puthash KEY VALUE TABLE
8978
8979 Associate KEY with VALUE in TABLE. If KEY is already associated with
8980 another value, replace the old value with VALUE.
8981
8982 - Function: remhash KEY TABLE
8983
8984 Remove KEY from TABLE if it is there.
8985
8986 - Function: maphash FUNCTION TABLE
8987
8988 Call FUNCTION for all elements in TABLE. FUNCTION must take two
8989 arguments KEY and VALUE.
8990
8991 - Function: sxhash OBJ
8992
8993 Return a hash code for Lisp object OBJ.
8994
8995 - Function: define-hash-table-test NAME TEST-FN HASH-FN
8996
8997 Define a new hash table test named NAME. If NAME is specified as
8998 a test in `make-hash-table', the table created will use TEST-FN for
8999 comparing keys, and HASH-FN to compute hash codes for keys. Test
9000 and hash function are stored as symbol property `hash-table-test'
9001 of NAME with a value of (TEST-FN HASH-FN).
9002
9003 TEST-FN must take two arguments and return non-nil if they are the same.
9004
9005 HASH-FN must take one argument and return an integer that is the hash
9006 code of the argument. The function should use the whole range of
9007 integer values for hash code computation, including negative integers.
9008
9009 Example: The following creates a hash table whose keys are supposed to
9010 be strings that are compared case-insensitively.
9011
9012 (defun case-fold-string= (a b)
9013 (compare-strings a nil nil b nil nil t))
9014
9015 (defun case-fold-string-hash (a)
9016 (sxhash (upcase a)))
9017
9018 (define-hash-table-test 'case-fold 'case-fold-string=
9019 'case-fold-string-hash))
9020
9021 (make-hash-table :test 'case-fold)
9022
9023 ** The Lisp reader handles circular structure.
9024
9025 It now works to use the #N= and #N# constructs to represent
9026 circular structures. For example, #1=(a . #1#) represents
9027 a cons cell which is its own cdr.
9028
9029 ** The Lisp printer handles circular structure.
9030
9031 If you bind print-circle to a non-nil value, the Lisp printer outputs
9032 #N= and #N# constructs to represent circular and shared structure.
9033
9034 ** If the second argument to `move-to-column' is anything but nil or
9035 t, that means replace a tab with spaces if necessary to reach the
9036 specified column, but do not add spaces at the end of the line if it
9037 is too short to reach that column.
9038
9039 ** perform-replace has a new feature: the REPLACEMENTS argument may
9040 now be a cons cell (FUNCTION . DATA). This means to call FUNCTION
9041 after each match to get the replacement text. FUNCTION is called with
9042 two arguments: DATA, and the number of replacements already made.
9043
9044 If the FROM-STRING contains any upper-case letters,
9045 perform-replace also turns off `case-fold-search' temporarily
9046 and inserts the replacement text without altering case in it.
9047
9048 ** The function buffer-size now accepts an optional argument
9049 to specify which buffer to return the size of.
9050
9051 ** The calendar motion commands now run the normal hook
9052 calendar-move-hook after moving point.
9053
9054 ** The new variable small-temporary-file-directory specifies a
9055 directory to use for creating temporary files that are likely to be
9056 small. (Certain Emacs features use this directory.) If
9057 small-temporary-file-directory is nil, they use
9058 temporary-file-directory instead.
9059
9060 ** The variable `inhibit-modification-hooks', if non-nil, inhibits all
9061 the hooks that track changes in the buffer. This affects
9062 `before-change-functions' and `after-change-functions', as well as
9063 hooks attached to text properties and overlay properties.
9064
9065 ** assq-delete-all is a new function that deletes all the
9066 elements of an alist which have a car `eq' to a particular value.
9067
9068 ** make-temp-file provides a more reliable way to create a temporary file.
9069
9070 make-temp-file is used like make-temp-name, except that it actually
9071 creates the file before it returns. This prevents a timing error,
9072 ensuring that no other job can use the same name for a temporary file.
9073
9074 ** New exclusive-open feature in `write-region'
9075
9076 The optional seventh arg is now called MUSTBENEW. If non-nil, it insists
9077 on a check for an existing file with the same name. If MUSTBENEW
9078 is `excl', that means to get an error if the file already exists;
9079 never overwrite. If MUSTBENEW is neither nil nor `excl', that means
9080 ask for confirmation before overwriting, but do go ahead and
9081 overwrite the file if the user gives confirmation.
9082
9083 If the MUSTBENEW argument in `write-region' is `excl',
9084 that means to use a special feature in the `open' system call
9085 to get an error if the file exists at that time.
9086 The error reported is `file-already-exists'.
9087
9088 ** Function `format' now handles text properties.
9089
9090 Text properties of the format string are applied to the result string.
9091 If the result string is longer than the format string, text properties
9092 ending at the end of the format string are extended to the end of the
9093 result string.
9094
9095 Text properties from string arguments are applied to the result
9096 string where arguments appear in the result string.
9097
9098 Example:
9099
9100 (let ((s1 "hello, %s")
9101 (s2 "world"))
9102 (put-text-property 0 (length s1) 'face 'bold s1)
9103 (put-text-property 0 (length s2) 'face 'italic s2)
9104 (format s1 s2))
9105
9106 results in a bold-face string with an italic `world' at the end.
9107
9108 ** Messages can now be displayed with text properties.
9109
9110 Text properties are handled as described above for function `format'.
9111 The following example displays a bold-face message with an italic
9112 argument in it.
9113
9114 (let ((msg "hello, %s!")
9115 (arg "world"))
9116 (put-text-property 0 (length msg) 'face 'bold msg)
9117 (put-text-property 0 (length arg) 'face 'italic arg)
9118 (message msg arg))
9119
9120 ** Sound support
9121
9122 Emacs supports playing sound files on GNU/Linux and the free BSDs
9123 (Voxware driver and native BSD driver, aka as Luigi's driver).
9124
9125 Currently supported file formats are RIFF-WAVE (*.wav) and Sun Audio
9126 (*.au). You must configure Emacs with the option `--with-sound=yes'
9127 to enable sound support.
9128
9129 Sound files can be played by calling (play-sound SOUND). SOUND is a
9130 list of the form `(sound PROPERTY...)'. The function is only defined
9131 when sound support is present for the system on which Emacs runs. The
9132 functions runs `play-sound-functions' with one argument which is the
9133 sound to play, before playing the sound.
9134
9135 The following sound properties are supported:
9136
9137 - `:file FILE'
9138
9139 FILE is a file name. If FILE isn't an absolute name, it will be
9140 searched relative to `data-directory'.
9141
9142 - `:data DATA'
9143
9144 DATA is a string containing sound data. Either :file or :data
9145 may be present, but not both.
9146
9147 - `:volume VOLUME'
9148
9149 VOLUME must be an integer in the range 0..100 or a float in the range
9150 0..1. This property is optional.
9151
9152 - `:device DEVICE'
9153
9154 DEVICE is a string specifying the system device on which to play the
9155 sound. The default device is system-dependent.
9156
9157 Other properties are ignored.
9158
9159 An alternative interface is called as
9160 (play-sound-file FILE &optional VOLUME DEVICE).
9161
9162 ** `multimedia' is a new Finder keyword and Custom group.
9163
9164 ** keywordp is a new predicate to test efficiently for an object being
9165 a keyword symbol.
9166
9167 ** Changes to garbage collection
9168
9169 *** The function garbage-collect now additionally returns the number
9170 of live and free strings.
9171
9172 *** There is a new variable `strings-consed' holding the number of
9173 strings that have been consed so far.
9174
9175
9176 * Lisp-level Display features added after release 2.6 of the Emacs
9177 Lisp Manual
9178
9179 ** The user-option `resize-mini-windows' controls how Emacs resizes
9180 mini-windows.
9181
9182 ** The function `pos-visible-in-window-p' now has a third optional
9183 argument, PARTIALLY. If a character is only partially visible, nil is
9184 returned, unless PARTIALLY is non-nil.
9185
9186 ** On window systems, `glyph-table' is no longer used.
9187
9188 ** Help strings in menu items are now used to provide `help-echo' text.
9189
9190 ** The function `image-size' can be used to determine the size of an
9191 image.
9192
9193 - Function: image-size SPEC &optional PIXELS FRAME
9194
9195 Return the size of an image as a pair (WIDTH . HEIGHT).
9196
9197 SPEC is an image specification. PIXELS non-nil means return sizes
9198 measured in pixels, otherwise return sizes measured in canonical
9199 character units (fractions of the width/height of the frame's default
9200 font). FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed.
9201 FRAME nil or omitted means use the selected frame.
9202
9203 ** The function `image-mask-p' can be used to determine if an image
9204 has a mask bitmap.
9205
9206 - Function: image-mask-p SPEC &optional FRAME
9207
9208 Return t if image SPEC has a mask bitmap.
9209 FRAME is the frame on which the image will be displayed. FRAME nil
9210 or omitted means use the selected frame.
9211
9212 ** The function `find-image' can be used to find a usable image
9213 satisfying one of a list of specifications.
9214
9215 ** The STRING argument of `put-image' and `insert-image' is now
9216 optional.
9217
9218 ** Image specifications may contain the property `:ascent center' (see
9219 below).
9220
9221
9222 * New Lisp-level Display features in Emacs 21.1
9223
9224 ** The function tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors can be used
9225 to make Emacs avoid displaying text with bold black foreground on TTYs.
9226
9227 Some terminals, notably PC consoles, emulate bold text by displaying
9228 text in brighter colors. On such a console, a bold black foreground
9229 is displayed in a gray color. If this turns out to be hard to read on
9230 your monitor---the problem occurred with the mode line on
9231 laptops---you can instruct Emacs to ignore the text's boldness, and to
9232 just display it black instead.
9233
9234 This situation can't be detected automatically. You will have to put
9235 a line like
9236
9237 (tty-suppress-bold-inverse-default-colors t)
9238
9239 in your `.emacs'.
9240
9241 ** New face implementation.
9242
9243 Emacs faces have been reimplemented from scratch. They don't use XLFD
9244 font names anymore and face merging now works as expected.
9245
9246 *** New faces.
9247
9248 Each face can specify the following display attributes:
9249
9250 1. Font family or fontset alias name.
9251
9252 2. Relative proportionate width, aka character set width or set
9253 width (swidth), e.g. `semi-compressed'.
9254
9255 3. Font height in 1/10pt
9256
9257 4. Font weight, e.g. `bold'.
9258
9259 5. Font slant, e.g. `italic'.
9260
9261 6. Foreground color.
9262
9263 7. Background color.
9264
9265 8. Whether or not characters should be underlined, and in what color.
9266
9267 9. Whether or not characters should be displayed in inverse video.
9268
9269 10. A background stipple, a bitmap.
9270
9271 11. Whether or not characters should be overlined, and in what color.
9272
9273 12. Whether or not characters should be strike-through, and in what
9274 color.
9275
9276 13. Whether or not a box should be drawn around characters, its
9277 color, the width of the box lines, and 3D appearance.
9278
9279 Faces are frame-local by nature because Emacs allows to define the
9280 same named face (face names are symbols) differently for different
9281 frames. Each frame has an alist of face definitions for all named
9282 faces. The value of a named face in such an alist is a Lisp vector
9283 with the symbol `face' in slot 0, and a slot for each of the face
9284 attributes mentioned above.
9285
9286 There is also a global face alist `face-new-frame-defaults'. Face
9287 definitions from this list are used to initialize faces of newly
9288 created frames.
9289
9290 A face doesn't have to specify all attributes. Those not specified
9291 have a nil value. Faces specifying all attributes are called
9292 `fully-specified'.
9293
9294 *** Face merging.
9295
9296 The display style of a given character in the text is determined by
9297 combining several faces. This process is called `face merging'. Any
9298 aspect of the display style that isn't specified by overlays or text
9299 properties is taken from the `default' face. Since it is made sure
9300 that the default face is always fully-specified, face merging always
9301 results in a fully-specified face.
9302
9303 *** Face realization.
9304
9305 After all face attributes for a character have been determined by
9306 merging faces of that character, that face is `realized'. The
9307 realization process maps face attributes to what is physically
9308 available on the system where Emacs runs. The result is a `realized
9309 face' in form of an internal structure which is stored in the face
9310 cache of the frame on which it was realized.
9311
9312 Face realization is done in the context of the charset of the
9313 character to display because different fonts and encodings are used
9314 for different charsets. In other words, for characters of different
9315 charsets, different realized faces are needed to display them.
9316
9317 Except for composite characters, faces are always realized for a
9318 specific character set and contain a specific font, even if the face
9319 being realized specifies a fontset. The reason is that the result of
9320 the new font selection stage is better than what can be done with
9321 statically defined font name patterns in fontsets.
9322
9323 In unibyte text, Emacs' charsets aren't applicable; function
9324 `char-charset' reports ASCII for all characters, including those >
9325 0x7f. The X registry and encoding of fonts to use is determined from
9326 the variable `face-default-registry' in this case. The variable is
9327 initialized at Emacs startup time from the font the user specified for
9328 Emacs.
9329
9330 Currently all unibyte text, i.e. all buffers with
9331 `enable-multibyte-characters' nil are displayed with fonts of the same
9332 registry and encoding `face-default-registry'. This is consistent
9333 with the fact that languages can also be set globally, only.
9334
9335 **** Clearing face caches.
9336
9337 The Lisp function `clear-face-cache' can be called to clear face caches
9338 on all frames. If called with a non-nil argument, it will also unload
9339 unused fonts.
9340
9341 *** Font selection.
9342
9343 Font selection tries to find the best available matching font for a
9344 given (charset, face) combination. This is done slightly differently
9345 for faces specifying a fontset, or a font family name.
9346
9347 If the face specifies a fontset name, that fontset determines a
9348 pattern for fonts of the given charset. If the face specifies a font
9349 family, a font pattern is constructed. Charset symbols have a
9350 property `x-charset-registry' for that purpose that maps a charset to
9351 an XLFD registry and encoding in the font pattern constructed.
9352
9353 Available fonts on the system on which Emacs runs are then matched
9354 against the font pattern. The result of font selection is the best
9355 match for the given face attributes in this font list.
9356
9357 Font selection can be influenced by the user.
9358
9359 The user can specify the relative importance he gives the face
9360 attributes width, height, weight, and slant by setting
9361 face-font-selection-order (faces.el) to a list of face attribute
9362 names. The default is (:width :height :weight :slant), and means
9363 that font selection first tries to find a good match for the font
9364 width specified by a face, then---within fonts with that width---tries
9365 to find a best match for the specified font height, etc.
9366
9367 Setting `face-font-family-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9368 alternative font families to try if a family specified by a face
9369 doesn't exist.
9370
9371 Setting `face-font-registry-alternatives' allows the user to specify
9372 all alternative font registry names to try for a face specifying a
9373 registry.
9374
9375 Please note that the interpretations of the above two variables are
9376 slightly different.
9377
9378 Setting face-ignored-fonts allows the user to ignore specific fonts.
9379
9380
9381 **** Scalable fonts
9382
9383 Emacs can make use of scalable fonts but doesn't do so by default,
9384 since the use of too many or too big scalable fonts may crash XFree86
9385 servers.
9386
9387 To enable scalable font use, set the variable
9388 `scalable-fonts-allowed'. A value of nil, the default, means never use
9389 scalable fonts. A value of t means any scalable font may be used.
9390 Otherwise, the value must be a list of regular expressions. A
9391 scalable font may then be used if it matches a regular expression from
9392 that list. Example:
9393
9394 (setq scalable-fonts-allowed '("muleindian-2$"))
9395
9396 allows the use of scalable fonts with registry `muleindian-2'.
9397
9398 *** Functions and variables related to font selection.
9399
9400 - Function: x-family-fonts &optional FAMILY FRAME
9401
9402 Return a list of available fonts of family FAMILY on FRAME. If FAMILY
9403 is omitted or nil, list all families. Otherwise, FAMILY must be a
9404 string, possibly containing wildcards `?' and `*'.
9405
9406 If FRAME is omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Each element of
9407 the result is a vector [FAMILY WIDTH POINT-SIZE WEIGHT SLANT FIXED-P
9408 FULL REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING]. FAMILY is the font family name.
9409 POINT-SIZE is the size of the font in 1/10 pt. WIDTH, WEIGHT, and
9410 SLANT are symbols describing the width, weight and slant of the font.
9411 These symbols are the same as for face attributes. FIXED-P is non-nil
9412 if the font is fixed-pitch. FULL is the full name of the font, and
9413 REGISTRY-AND-ENCODING is a string giving the registry and encoding of
9414 the font. The result list is sorted according to the current setting
9415 of the face font sort order.
9416
9417 - Function: x-font-family-list
9418
9419 Return a list of available font families on FRAME. If FRAME is
9420 omitted or nil, use the selected frame. Value is a list of conses
9421 (FAMILY . FIXED-P) where FAMILY is a font family, and FIXED-P is
9422 non-nil if fonts of that family are fixed-pitch.
9423
9424 - Variable: font-list-limit
9425
9426 Limit for font matching. If an integer > 0, font matching functions
9427 won't load more than that number of fonts when searching for a
9428 matching font. The default is currently 100.
9429
9430 *** Setting face attributes.
9431
9432 For the most part, the new face implementation is interface-compatible
9433 with the old one. Old face attribute related functions are now
9434 implemented in terms of the new functions `set-face-attribute' and
9435 `face-attribute'.
9436
9437 Face attributes are identified by their names which are keyword
9438 symbols. All attributes can be set to `unspecified'.
9439
9440 The following attributes are recognized:
9441
9442 `:family'
9443
9444 VALUE must be a string specifying the font family, e.g. ``courier'',
9445 or a fontset alias name. If a font family is specified, wild-cards `*'
9446 and `?' are allowed.
9447
9448 `:width'
9449
9450 VALUE specifies the relative proportionate width of the font to use.
9451 It must be one of the symbols `ultra-condensed', `extra-condensed',
9452 `condensed', `semi-condensed', `normal', `semi-expanded', `expanded',
9453 `extra-expanded', or `ultra-expanded'.
9454
9455 `:height'
9456
9457 VALUE must be either an integer specifying the height of the font to use
9458 in 1/10 pt, a floating point number specifying the amount by which to
9459 scale any underlying face, or a function, which is called with the old
9460 height (from the underlying face), and should return the new height.
9461
9462 `:weight'
9463
9464 VALUE specifies the weight of the font to use. It must be one of the
9465 symbols `ultra-bold', `extra-bold', `bold', `semi-bold', `normal',
9466 `semi-light', `light', `extra-light', `ultra-light'.
9467
9468 `:slant'
9469
9470 VALUE specifies the slant of the font to use. It must be one of the
9471 symbols `italic', `oblique', `normal', `reverse-italic', or
9472 `reverse-oblique'.
9473
9474 `:foreground', `:background'
9475
9476 VALUE must be a color name, a string.
9477
9478 `:underline'
9479
9480 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be underlined. If
9481 VALUE is t, underline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is
9482 a string, underline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly
9483 don't underline.
9484
9485 `:overline'
9486
9487 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be overlined. If
9488 VALUE is t, overline with foreground color of the face. If VALUE is a
9489 string, overline with that color. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't
9490 overline.
9491
9492 `:strike-through'
9493
9494 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be drawn with a line
9495 striking through them. If VALUE is t, use the foreground color of the
9496 face. If VALUE is a string, strike-through with that color. If VALUE
9497 is nil, explicitly don't strike through.
9498
9499 `:box'
9500
9501 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should have a box drawn
9502 around them. If VALUE is nil, explicitly don't draw boxes. If
9503 VALUE is t, draw a box with lines of width 1 in the foreground color
9504 of the face. If VALUE is a string, the string must be a color name,
9505 and the box is drawn in that color with a line width of 1. Otherwise,
9506 VALUE must be a property list of the form `(:line-width WIDTH
9507 :color COLOR :style STYLE)'. If a keyword/value pair is missing from
9508 the property list, a default value will be used for the value, as
9509 specified below. WIDTH specifies the width of the lines to draw; it
9510 defaults to 1. COLOR is the name of the color to draw in, default is
9511 the foreground color of the face for simple boxes, and the background
9512 color of the face for 3D boxes. STYLE specifies whether a 3D box
9513 should be draw. If STYLE is `released-button', draw a box looking
9514 like a released 3D button. If STYLE is `pressed-button' draw a box
9515 that appears like a pressed button. If STYLE is nil, the default if
9516 the property list doesn't contain a style specification, draw a 2D
9517 box.
9518
9519 `:inverse-video'
9520
9521 VALUE specifies whether characters in FACE should be displayed in
9522 inverse video. VALUE must be one of t or nil.
9523
9524 `:stipple'
9525
9526 If VALUE is a string, it must be the name of a file of pixmap data.
9527 The directories listed in the `x-bitmap-file-path' variable are
9528 searched. Alternatively, VALUE may be a list of the form (WIDTH
9529 HEIGHT DATA) where WIDTH and HEIGHT are the size in pixels, and DATA
9530 is a string containing the raw bits of the bitmap. VALUE nil means
9531 explicitly don't use a stipple pattern.
9532
9533 For convenience, attributes `:family', `:width', `:height', `:weight',
9534 and `:slant' may also be set in one step from an X font name:
9535
9536 `:font'
9537
9538 Set font-related face attributes from VALUE. VALUE must be a valid
9539 XLFD font name. If it is a font name pattern, the first matching font
9540 is used--this is for compatibility with the behavior of previous
9541 versions of Emacs.
9542
9543 For compatibility with Emacs 20, keywords `:bold' and `:italic' can
9544 be used to specify that a bold or italic font should be used. VALUE
9545 must be t or nil in that case. A value of `unspecified' is not allowed."
9546
9547 Please see also the documentation of `set-face-attribute' and
9548 `defface'.
9549
9550 `:inherit'
9551
9552 VALUE is the name of a face from which to inherit attributes, or a list
9553 of face names. Attributes from inherited faces are merged into the face
9554 like an underlying face would be, with higher priority than underlying faces.
9555
9556 *** Face attributes and X resources
9557
9558 The following X resource names can be used to set face attributes
9559 from X resources:
9560
9561 Face attribute X resource class
9562 -----------------------------------------------------------------------
9563 :family attributeFamily . Face.AttributeFamily
9564 :width attributeWidth Face.AttributeWidth
9565 :height attributeHeight Face.AttributeHeight
9566 :weight attributeWeight Face.AttributeWeight
9567 :slant attributeSlant Face.AttributeSlant
9568 foreground attributeForeground Face.AttributeForeground
9569 :background attributeBackground . Face.AttributeBackground
9570 :overline attributeOverline Face.AttributeOverline
9571 :strike-through attributeStrikeThrough Face.AttributeStrikeThrough
9572 :box attributeBox Face.AttributeBox
9573 :underline attributeUnderline Face.AttributeUnderline
9574 :inverse-video attributeInverse Face.AttributeInverse
9575 :stipple attributeStipple Face.AttributeStipple
9576 or attributeBackgroundPixmap
9577 Face.AttributeBackgroundPixmap
9578 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9579 :bold attributeBold Face.AttributeBold
9580 :italic attributeItalic . Face.AttributeItalic
9581 :font attributeFont Face.AttributeFont
9582
9583 *** Text property `face'.
9584
9585 The value of the `face' text property can now be a single face
9586 specification or a list of such specifications. Each face
9587 specification can be
9588
9589 1. A symbol or string naming a Lisp face.
9590
9591 2. A property list of the form (KEYWORD VALUE ...) where each
9592 KEYWORD is a face attribute name, and VALUE is an appropriate value
9593 for that attribute. Please see the doc string of `set-face-attribute'
9594 for face attribute names.
9595
9596 3. Conses of the form (FOREGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) or
9597 (BACKGROUND-COLOR . COLOR) where COLOR is a color name. This is
9598 for compatibility with previous Emacs versions.
9599
9600 ** Support functions for colors on text-only terminals.
9601
9602 The function `tty-color-define' can be used to define colors for use
9603 on TTY and MSDOS frames. It maps a color name to a color number on
9604 the terminal. Emacs defines a couple of common color mappings by
9605 default. You can get defined colors with a call to
9606 `defined-colors'. The function `tty-color-clear' can be
9607 used to clear the mapping table.
9608
9609 ** Unified support for colors independent of frame type.
9610
9611 The new functions `defined-colors', `color-defined-p', `color-values',
9612 and `display-color-p' work for any type of frame. On frames whose
9613 type is neither x nor w32, these functions transparently map X-style
9614 color specifications to the closest colors supported by the frame
9615 display. Lisp programs should use these new functions instead of the
9616 old `x-defined-colors', `x-color-defined-p', `x-color-values', and
9617 `x-display-color-p'. (The old function names are still available for
9618 compatibility; they are now aliases of the new names.) Lisp programs
9619 should no more look at the value of the variable window-system to
9620 modify their color-related behavior.
9621
9622 The primitives `color-gray-p' and `color-supported-p' also work for
9623 any frame type.
9624
9625 ** Platform-independent functions to describe display capabilities.
9626
9627 The new functions `display-mouse-p', `display-popup-menus-p',
9628 `display-graphic-p', `display-selections-p', `display-screens',
9629 `display-pixel-width', `display-pixel-height', `display-mm-width',
9630 `display-mm-height', `display-backing-store', `display-save-under',
9631 `display-planes', `display-color-cells', `display-visual-class', and
9632 `display-grayscale-p' describe the basic capabilities of a particular
9633 display. Lisp programs should call these functions instead of testing
9634 the value of the variables `window-system' or `system-type', or calling
9635 platform-specific functions such as `x-display-pixel-width'.
9636
9637 The new function `display-images-p' returns non-nil if a particular
9638 display can display image files.
9639
9640 ** The minibuffer prompt is now actually inserted in the minibuffer.
9641
9642 This makes it possible to scroll through the prompt, if you want to.
9643 To disallow this completely (like previous versions of emacs), customize
9644 the variable `minibuffer-prompt-properties', and turn on the
9645 `Inviolable' option.
9646
9647 The function `minibuffer-prompt-end' returns the current position of the
9648 end of the minibuffer prompt, if the minibuffer is current.
9649 Otherwise, it returns `(point-min)'.
9650
9651 ** New `field' abstraction in buffers.
9652
9653 There is now code to support an abstraction called `fields' in emacs
9654 buffers. A field is a contiguous region of text with the same `field'
9655 property (which can be a text property or an overlay).
9656
9657 Many emacs functions, such as forward-word, forward-sentence,
9658 forward-paragraph, beginning-of-line, etc., stop moving when they come
9659 to the boundary between fields; beginning-of-line and end-of-line will
9660 not let the point move past the field boundary, but other movement
9661 commands continue into the next field if repeated. Stopping at field
9662 boundaries can be suppressed programmatically by binding
9663 `inhibit-field-text-motion' to a non-nil value around calls to these
9664 functions.
9665
9666 Now that the minibuffer prompt is inserted into the minibuffer, it is in
9667 a separate field from the user-input part of the buffer, so that common
9668 editing commands treat the user's text separately from the prompt.
9669
9670 The following functions are defined for operating on fields:
9671
9672 - Function: constrain-to-field NEW-POS OLD-POS &optional ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE ONLY-IN-LINE INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY
9673
9674 Return the position closest to NEW-POS that is in the same field as OLD-POS.
9675
9676 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9677 If NEW-POS is nil, then the current point is used instead, and set to the
9678 constrained position if that is different.
9679
9680 If OLD-POS is at the boundary of two fields, then the allowable
9681 positions for NEW-POS depends on the value of the optional argument
9682 ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE: If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is nil, then NEW-POS is
9683 constrained to the field that has the same `field' char-property
9684 as any new characters inserted at OLD-POS, whereas if ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9685 is non-nil, NEW-POS is constrained to the union of the two adjacent
9686 fields. Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with
9687 the special value `boundary', then any point within this special field is
9688 also considered to be `on the boundary'.
9689
9690 If the optional argument ONLY-IN-LINE is non-nil and constraining
9691 NEW-POS would move it to a different line, NEW-POS is returned
9692 unconstrained. This useful for commands that move by line, like
9693 C-n or C-a, which should generally respect field boundaries
9694 only in the case where they can still move to the right line.
9695
9696 If the optional argument INHIBIT-CAPTURE-PROPERTY is non-nil, and OLD-POS has
9697 a non-nil property of that name, then any field boundaries are ignored.
9698
9699 Field boundaries are not noticed if `inhibit-field-text-motion' is non-nil.
9700
9701 - Function: delete-field &optional POS
9702
9703 Delete the field surrounding POS.
9704 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9705 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9706
9707 - Function: field-beginning &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9708
9709 Return the beginning of the field surrounding POS.
9710 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9711 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9712 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the beginning of its
9713 field, then the beginning of the *previous* field is returned.
9714
9715 - Function: field-end &optional POS ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE
9716
9717 Return the end of the field surrounding POS.
9718 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9719 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9720 If ESCAPE-FROM-EDGE is non-nil and POS is at the end of its field,
9721 then the end of the *following* field is returned.
9722
9723 - Function: field-string &optional POS
9724
9725 Return the contents of the field surrounding POS as a string.
9726 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9727 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9728
9729 - Function: field-string-no-properties &optional POS
9730
9731 Return the contents of the field around POS, without text-properties.
9732 A field is a region of text with the same `field' property.
9733 If POS is nil, the value of point is used for POS.
9734
9735 ** Image support.
9736
9737 Emacs can now display images. Images are inserted into text by giving
9738 strings or buffer text a `display' text property containing one of
9739 (AREA IMAGE) or IMAGE. The display of the `display' property value
9740 replaces the display of the characters having that property.
9741
9742 If the property value has the form (AREA IMAGE), AREA must be one of
9743 `(margin left-margin)', `(margin right-margin)' or `(margin nil)'. If
9744 AREA is `(margin nil)', IMAGE will be displayed in the text area of a
9745 window, otherwise it will be displayed in the left or right marginal
9746 area.
9747
9748 IMAGE is an image specification.
9749
9750 *** Image specifications
9751
9752 Image specifications are lists of the form `(image PROPS)' where PROPS
9753 is a property list whose keys are keyword symbols. Each
9754 specifications must contain a property `:type TYPE' with TYPE being a
9755 symbol specifying the image type, e.g. `xbm'. Properties not
9756 described below are ignored.
9757
9758 The following is a list of properties all image types share.
9759
9760 `:ascent ASCENT'
9761
9762 ASCENT must be a number in the range 0..100, or the symbol `center'.
9763 If it is a number, it specifies the percentage of the image's height
9764 to use for its ascent.
9765
9766 If not specified, ASCENT defaults to the value 50 which means that the
9767 image will be centered with the base line of the row it appears in.
9768
9769 If ASCENT is `center' the image is vertically centered around a
9770 centerline which is the vertical center of text drawn at the position
9771 of the image, in the manner specified by the text properties and
9772 overlays that apply to the image.
9773
9774 `:margin MARGIN'
9775
9776 MARGIN must be either a number >= 0 specifying how many pixels to put
9777 as margin around the image, or a pair (X . Y) with X specifying the
9778 horizontal margin and Y specifying the vertical margin. Default is 0.
9779
9780 `:relief RELIEF'
9781
9782 RELIEF is analogous to the `:relief' attribute of faces. Puts a relief
9783 around an image.
9784
9785 `:conversion ALGO'
9786
9787 Apply an image algorithm to the image before displaying it.
9788
9789 ALGO `laplace' or `emboss' means apply a Laplace or ``emboss''
9790 edge-detection algorithm to the image.
9791
9792 ALGO `(edge-detection :matrix MATRIX :color-adjust ADJUST)' means
9793 apply a general edge-detection algorithm. MATRIX must be either a
9794 nine-element list or a nine-element vector of numbers. A pixel at
9795 position x/y in the transformed image is computed from original pixels
9796 around that position. MATRIX specifies, for each pixel in the
9797 neighborhood of x/y, a factor with which that pixel will influence the
9798 transformed pixel; element 0 specifies the factor for the pixel at
9799 x-1/y-1, element 1 the factor for the pixel at x/y-1 etc. as shown
9800 below.
9801
9802 (x-1/y-1 x/y-1 x+1/y-1
9803 x-1/y x/y x+1/y
9804 x-1/y+1 x/y+1 x+1/y+1)
9805
9806 The resulting pixel is computed from the color intensity of the color
9807 resulting from summing up the RGB values of surrounding pixels,
9808 multiplied by the specified factors, and dividing that sum by the sum
9809 of the factors' absolute values.
9810
9811 Laplace edge-detection currently uses a matrix of
9812
9813 (1 0 0
9814 0 0 0
9815 9 9 -1)
9816
9817 Emboss edge-detection uses a matrix of
9818
9819 ( 2 -1 0
9820 -1 0 1
9821 0 1 -2)
9822
9823 ALGO `disabled' means transform the image so that it looks
9824 ``disabled''.
9825
9826 `:mask MASK'
9827
9828 If MASK is `heuristic' or `(heuristic BG)', build a clipping mask for
9829 the image, so that the background of a frame is visible behind the
9830 image. If BG is not specified, or if BG is t, determine the
9831 background color of the image by looking at the 4 corners of the
9832 image, assuming the most frequently occurring color from the corners is
9833 the background color of the image. Otherwise, BG must be a list `(RED
9834 GREEN BLUE)' specifying the color to assume for the background of the
9835 image.
9836
9837 If MASK is nil, remove a mask from the image, if it has one. Images
9838 in some formats include a mask which can be removed by specifying
9839 `:mask nil'.
9840
9841 `:file FILE'
9842
9843 Load image from FILE. If FILE is not absolute after expanding it,
9844 search for the image in `data-directory'. Some image types support
9845 building images from data. When this is done, no `:file' property
9846 may be present in the image specification.
9847
9848 `:data DATA'
9849
9850 Get image data from DATA. (As of this writing, this is not yet
9851 supported for image type `postscript'). Either :file or :data may be
9852 present in an image specification, but not both. All image types
9853 support strings as DATA, some types allow additional types of DATA.
9854
9855 *** Supported image types
9856
9857 **** XBM, image type `xbm'.
9858
9859 XBM images don't require an external library. Additional image
9860 properties supported are:
9861
9862 `:foreground FG'
9863
9864 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9865 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9866
9867 `:background BG'
9868
9869 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9870 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9871
9872 XBM images can be constructed from data instead of file. In this
9873 case, the image specification must contain the following properties
9874 instead of a `:file' property.
9875
9876 `:width WIDTH'
9877
9878 WIDTH specifies the width of the image in pixels.
9879
9880 `:height HEIGHT'
9881
9882 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pixels.
9883
9884 `:data DATA'
9885
9886 DATA must be either
9887
9888 1. a string large enough to hold the bitmap data, i.e. it must
9889 have a size >= (WIDTH + 7) / 8 * HEIGHT
9890
9891 2. a bool-vector of size >= WIDTH * HEIGHT
9892
9893 3. a vector of strings or bool-vectors, one for each line of the
9894 bitmap.
9895
9896 4. a string that's an in-memory XBM file. Neither width nor
9897 height may be specified in this case because these are defined
9898 in the file.
9899
9900 **** XPM, image type `xpm'
9901
9902 XPM images require the external library `libXpm', package
9903 `xpm-3.4k.tar.gz', version 3.4k or later. Make sure the library is
9904 found when Emacs is configured by supplying appropriate paths via
9905 `--x-includes' and `--x-libraries'.
9906
9907 Additional image properties supported are:
9908
9909 `:color-symbols SYMBOLS'
9910
9911 SYMBOLS must be a list of pairs (NAME . COLOR), with NAME being the
9912 name of color as it appears in an XPM file, and COLOR being an X color
9913 name.
9914
9915 XPM images can be built from memory instead of files. In that case,
9916 add a `:data' property instead of a `:file' property.
9917
9918 The XPM library uses libz in its implementation so that it is able
9919 to display compressed images.
9920
9921 **** PBM, image type `pbm'
9922
9923 PBM images don't require an external library. Color, gray-scale and
9924 mono images are supported. Additional image properties supported for
9925 mono images are:
9926
9927 `:foreground FG'
9928
9929 FG must be a string specifying the image foreground color, or nil
9930 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's foreground color.
9931
9932 `:background FG'
9933
9934 BG must be a string specifying the image background color, or nil
9935 meaning to use the default. Default is the frame's background color.
9936
9937 **** JPEG, image type `jpeg'
9938
9939 Support for JPEG images requires the external library `libjpeg',
9940 package `jpegsrc.v6a.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9941 properties defined.
9942
9943 **** TIFF, image type `tiff'
9944
9945 Support for TIFF images requires the external library `libtiff',
9946 package `tiff-v3.4-tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9947 properties defined.
9948
9949 **** GIF, image type `gif'
9950
9951 Support for GIF images requires the external library `libungif', package
9952 `libungif-4.1.0', or later.
9953
9954 Additional image properties supported are:
9955
9956 `:index INDEX'
9957
9958 INDEX must be an integer >= 0. Load image number INDEX from a
9959 multi-image GIF file. If INDEX is too large, the image displays
9960 as a hollow box.
9961
9962 This could be used to implement limited support for animated GIFs.
9963 For example, the following function displays a multi-image GIF file
9964 at point-min in the current buffer, switching between sub-images
9965 every 0.1 seconds.
9966
9967 (defun show-anim (file max)
9968 "Display multi-image GIF file FILE which contains MAX subimages."
9969 (display-anim (current-buffer) file 0 max t))
9970
9971 (defun display-anim (buffer file idx max first-time)
9972 (when (= idx max)
9973 (setq idx 0))
9974 (let ((img (create-image file nil nil :index idx)))
9975 (save-excursion
9976 (set-buffer buffer)
9977 (goto-char (point-min))
9978 (unless first-time (delete-char 1))
9979 (insert-image img "x"))
9980 (run-with-timer 0.1 nil 'display-anim buffer file (1+ idx) max nil)))
9981
9982 **** PNG, image type `png'
9983
9984 Support for PNG images requires the external library `libpng',
9985 package `libpng-1.0.2.tar.gz', or later. There are no additional image
9986 properties defined.
9987
9988 **** Ghostscript, image type `postscript'.
9989
9990 Additional image properties supported are:
9991
9992 `:pt-width WIDTH'
9993
9994 WIDTH is width of the image in pt (1/72 inch). WIDTH must be an
9995 integer. This is a required property.
9996
9997 `:pt-height HEIGHT'
9998
9999 HEIGHT specifies the height of the image in pt (1/72 inch). HEIGHT
10000 must be a integer. This is an required property.
10001
10002 `:bounding-box BOX'
10003
10004 BOX must be a list or vector of 4 integers giving the bounding box of
10005 the PS image, analogous to the `BoundingBox' comment found in PS
10006 files. This is an required property.
10007
10008 Part of the Ghostscript interface is implemented in Lisp. See
10009 lisp/gs.el.
10010
10011 *** Lisp interface.
10012
10013 The variable `image-types' contains a list of those image types
10014 which are supported in the current configuration.
10015
10016 Images are stored in an image cache and removed from the cache when
10017 they haven't been displayed for `image-cache-eviction-delay seconds.
10018 The function `clear-image-cache' can be used to clear the image cache
10019 manually. Images in the cache are compared with `equal', i.e. all
10020 images with `equal' specifications share the same image.
10021
10022 *** Simplified image API, image.el
10023
10024 The new Lisp package image.el contains functions that simplify image
10025 creation and putting images into text. The function `create-image'
10026 can be used to create images. The macro `defimage' can be used to
10027 define an image based on available image types. The functions
10028 `put-image' and `insert-image' can be used to insert an image into a
10029 buffer.
10030
10031 ** Display margins.
10032
10033 Windows can now have margins which are used for special text
10034 and images.
10035
10036 To give a window margins, either set the buffer-local variables
10037 `left-margin-width' and `right-margin-width', or call
10038 `set-window-margins'. The function `window-margins' can be used to
10039 obtain the current settings. To make `left-margin-width' and
10040 `right-margin-width' take effect, you must set them before displaying
10041 the buffer in a window, or use `set-window-buffer' to force an update
10042 of the display margins.
10043
10044 You can put text in margins by giving it a `display' text property
10045 containing a pair of the form `(LOCATION . VALUE)', where LOCATION is
10046 one of `left-margin' or `right-margin' or nil. VALUE can be either a
10047 string, an image specification or a stretch specification (see later
10048 in this file).
10049
10050 ** Help display
10051
10052 Emacs displays short help messages in the echo area, when the mouse
10053 moves over a tool-bar item or a piece of text that has a text property
10054 `help-echo'. This feature also applies to strings in the mode line
10055 that have a `help-echo' property.
10056
10057 If the value of the `help-echo' property is a function, that function
10058 is called with three arguments WINDOW, OBJECT and POSITION. WINDOW is
10059 the window in which the help was found.
10060
10061 If OBJECT is a buffer, POS is the position in the buffer where the
10062 `help-echo' text property was found.
10063
10064 If OBJECT is an overlay, that overlay has a `help-echo' property, and
10065 POS is the position in the overlay's buffer under the mouse.
10066
10067 If OBJECT is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed with
10068 the `display' property), POS is the position in that string under the
10069 mouse.
10070
10071 If the value of the `help-echo' property is neither a function nor a
10072 string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string.
10073
10074 For tool-bar and menu-bar items, their key definition is used to
10075 determine the help to display. If their definition contains a
10076 property `:help FORM', FORM is evaluated to determine the help string.
10077 For tool-bar items without a help form, the caption of the item is
10078 used as help string.
10079
10080 The hook `show-help-function' can be set to a function that displays
10081 the help string differently. For example, enabling a tooltip window
10082 causes the help display to appear there instead of in the echo area.
10083
10084 ** Vertical fractional scrolling.
10085
10086 The display of text in windows can be scrolled smoothly in pixels.
10087 This is useful, for example, for making parts of large images visible.
10088
10089 The function `window-vscroll' returns the current value of vertical
10090 scrolling, a non-negative fraction of the canonical character height.
10091 The function `set-window-vscroll' can be used to set the vertical
10092 scrolling value. Here is an example of how these function might be
10093 used.
10094
10095 (global-set-key [A-down]
10096 #'(lambda ()
10097 (interactive)
10098 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
10099 (+ 0.5 (window-vscroll)))))
10100 (global-set-key [A-up]
10101 #'(lambda ()
10102 (interactive)
10103 (set-window-vscroll (selected-window)
10104 (- (window-vscroll) 0.5)))))
10105
10106 ** New hook `fontification-functions'.
10107
10108 Functions from `fontification-functions' are called from redisplay
10109 when it encounters a region of text that is not yet fontified. This
10110 variable automatically becomes buffer-local when set. Each function
10111 is called with one argument, POS.
10112
10113 At least one of the hook functions should fontify one or more
10114 characters starting at POS in the current buffer. It should mark them
10115 as fontified by giving them a non-nil value of the `fontified' text
10116 property. It may be reasonable for these functions to check for the
10117 `fontified' property and not put it back on, but they do not have to.
10118
10119 ** Tool bar support.
10120
10121 Emacs supports a tool bar at the top of a frame under X. The frame
10122 parameter `tool-bar-lines' (X resource "toolBar", class "ToolBar")
10123 controls how may lines to reserve for the tool bar. A zero value
10124 suppresses the tool bar. If the value is non-zero and
10125 `auto-resize-tool-bars' is non-nil the tool bar's size will be changed
10126 automatically so that all tool bar items are visible.
10127
10128 *** Tool bar item definitions
10129
10130 Tool bar items are defined using `define-key' with a prefix-key
10131 `tool-bar'. For example `(define-key global-map [tool-bar item1] ITEM)'
10132 where ITEM is a list `(menu-item CAPTION BINDING PROPS...)'.
10133
10134 CAPTION is the caption of the item, If it's not a string, it is
10135 evaluated to get a string. The caption is currently not displayed in
10136 the tool bar, but it is displayed if the item doesn't have a `:help'
10137 property (see below).
10138
10139 BINDING is the tool bar item's binding. Tool bar items with keymaps as
10140 binding are currently ignored.
10141
10142 The following properties are recognized:
10143
10144 `:enable FORM'.
10145
10146 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is enabled
10147 or disabled.
10148
10149 `:visible FORM'
10150
10151 FORM is evaluated and specifies whether the tool bar item is displayed.
10152
10153 `:filter FUNCTION'
10154
10155 FUNCTION is called with one parameter, the same list BINDING in which
10156 FUNCTION is specified as the filter. The value FUNCTION returns is
10157 used instead of BINDING to display this item.
10158
10159 `:button (TYPE SELECTED)'
10160
10161 TYPE must be one of `:radio' or `:toggle'. SELECTED is evaluated
10162 and specifies whether the button is selected (pressed) or not.
10163
10164 `:image IMAGES'
10165
10166 IMAGES is either a single image specification or a vector of four
10167 image specifications. If it is a vector, this table lists the
10168 meaning of each of the four elements:
10169
10170 Index Use when item is
10171 ----------------------------------------
10172 0 enabled and selected
10173 1 enabled and deselected
10174 2 disabled and selected
10175 3 disabled and deselected
10176
10177 If IMAGE is a single image specification, a Laplace edge-detection
10178 algorithm is used on that image to draw the image in disabled state.
10179
10180 `:help HELP-STRING'.
10181
10182 Gives a help string to display for the tool bar item. This help
10183 is displayed when the mouse is moved over the item.
10184
10185 The function `toolbar-add-item' is a convenience function for adding
10186 toolbar items generally, and `tool-bar-add-item-from-menu' can be used
10187 to define a toolbar item with a binding copied from an item on the
10188 menu bar.
10189
10190 The default bindings use a menu-item :filter to derive the tool-bar
10191 dynamically from variable `tool-bar-map' which may be set
10192 buffer-locally to override the global map.
10193
10194 *** Tool-bar-related variables.
10195
10196 If `auto-resize-tool-bar' is non-nil, the tool bar will automatically
10197 resize to show all defined tool bar items. It will never grow larger
10198 than 1/4 of the frame's size.
10199
10200 If `auto-raise-tool-bar-buttons' is non-nil, tool bar buttons will be
10201 raised when the mouse moves over them.
10202
10203 You can add extra space between tool bar items by setting
10204 `tool-bar-button-margin' to a positive integer specifying a number of
10205 pixels, or a pair of integers (X . Y) specifying horizontal and
10206 vertical margins . Default is 1.
10207
10208 You can change the shadow thickness of tool bar buttons by setting
10209 `tool-bar-button-relief' to an integer. Default is 3.
10210
10211 *** Tool-bar clicks with modifiers.
10212
10213 You can bind commands to clicks with control, shift, meta etc. on
10214 a tool bar item. If
10215
10216 (define-key global-map [tool-bar shell]
10217 '(menu-item "Shell" shell
10218 :image (image :type xpm :file "shell.xpm")))
10219
10220 is the original tool bar item definition, then
10221
10222 (define-key global-map [tool-bar S-shell] 'some-command)
10223
10224 makes a binding to run `some-command' for a shifted click on the same
10225 item.
10226
10227 ** Mode line changes.
10228
10229 *** Mouse-sensitive mode line.
10230
10231 The mode line can be made mouse-sensitive by displaying strings there
10232 that have a `local-map' text property. There are three ways to display
10233 a string with a `local-map' property in the mode line.
10234
10235 1. The mode line spec contains a variable whose string value has
10236 a `local-map' text property.
10237
10238 2. The mode line spec contains a format specifier (e.g. `%12b'), and
10239 that format specifier has a `local-map' property.
10240
10241 3. The mode line spec contains a list containing `:eval FORM'. FORM
10242 is evaluated. If the result is a string, and that string has a
10243 `local-map' property.
10244
10245 The same mechanism is used to determine the `face' and `help-echo'
10246 properties of strings in the mode line. See `bindings.el' for an
10247 example.
10248
10249 *** If a mode line element has the form `(:eval FORM)', FORM is
10250 evaluated and the result is used as mode line element.
10251
10252 *** You can suppress mode-line display by setting the buffer-local
10253 variable mode-line-format to nil.
10254
10255 *** A headerline can now be displayed at the top of a window.
10256
10257 This mode line's contents are controlled by the new variable
10258 `header-line-format' and `default-header-line-format' which are
10259 completely analogous to `mode-line-format' and
10260 `default-mode-line-format'. A value of nil means don't display a top
10261 line.
10262
10263 The appearance of top mode lines is controlled by the face
10264 `header-line'.
10265
10266 The function `coordinates-in-window-p' returns `header-line' for a
10267 position in the header-line.
10268
10269 ** Text property `display'
10270
10271 The `display' text property is used to insert images into text,
10272 replace text with other text, display text in marginal area, and it is
10273 also used to control other aspects of how text displays. The value of
10274 the `display' property should be a display specification, as described
10275 below, or a list or vector containing display specifications.
10276
10277 *** Replacing text, displaying text in marginal areas
10278
10279 To replace the text having the `display' property with some other
10280 text, use a display specification of the form `(LOCATION STRING)'.
10281
10282 If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)', STRING is displayed in the left
10283 marginal area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in
10284 the right marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' STRING
10285 is displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10286 simpler form STRING as property value.
10287
10288 *** Variable width and height spaces
10289
10290 To display a space of fractional width or height, use a display
10291 specification of the form `(LOCATION STRECH)'. If LOCATION is
10292 `(margin left-margin)', the space is displayed in the left marginal
10293 area, if it is `(margin right-margin)', it is displayed in the right
10294 marginal area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the space is
10295 displayed in the text. In the latter case you can also use the
10296 simpler form STRETCH as property value.
10297
10298 The stretch specification STRETCH itself is a list of the form `(space
10299 PROPS)', where PROPS is a property list which can contain the
10300 properties described below.
10301
10302 The display of the fractional space replaces the display of the
10303 characters having the `display' property.
10304
10305 - :width WIDTH
10306
10307 Specifies that the space width should be WIDTH times the normal
10308 character width. WIDTH can be an integer or floating point number.
10309
10310 - :relative-width FACTOR
10311
10312 Specifies that the width of the stretch should be computed from the
10313 first character in a group of consecutive characters that have the
10314 same `display' property. The computation is done by multiplying the
10315 width of that character by FACTOR.
10316
10317 - :align-to HPOS
10318
10319 Specifies that the space should be wide enough to reach HPOS. The
10320 value HPOS is measured in units of the normal character width.
10321
10322 Exactly one of the above properties should be used.
10323
10324 - :height HEIGHT
10325
10326 Specifies the height of the space, as HEIGHT, measured in terms of the
10327 normal line height.
10328
10329 - :relative-height FACTOR
10330
10331 The height of the space is computed as the product of the height
10332 of the text having the `display' property and FACTOR.
10333
10334 - :ascent ASCENT
10335
10336 Specifies that ASCENT percent of the height of the stretch should be
10337 used for the ascent of the stretch, i.e. for the part above the
10338 baseline. The value of ASCENT must be a non-negative number less or
10339 equal to 100.
10340
10341 You should not use both `:height' and `:relative-height' together.
10342
10343 *** Images
10344
10345 A display specification for an image has the form `(LOCATION
10346 . IMAGE)', where IMAGE is an image specification. The image replaces,
10347 in the display, the characters having this display specification in
10348 their `display' text property. If LOCATION is `(margin left-margin)',
10349 the image will be displayed in the left marginal area, if it is
10350 `(margin right-margin)' it will be displayed in the right marginal
10351 area, and if LOCATION is `(margin nil)' the image will be displayed in
10352 the text. In the latter case you can also use the simpler form IMAGE
10353 as display specification.
10354
10355 *** Other display properties
10356
10357 - (space-width FACTOR)
10358
10359 Specifies that space characters in the text having that property
10360 should be displayed FACTOR times as wide as normal; FACTOR must be an
10361 integer or float.
10362
10363 - (height HEIGHT)
10364
10365 Display text having this property in a font that is smaller or larger.
10366
10367 If HEIGHT is a list of the form `(+ N)', where N is an integer, that
10368 means to use a font that is N steps larger. If HEIGHT is a list of
10369 the form `(- N)', that means to use a font that is N steps smaller. A
10370 ``step'' is defined by the set of available fonts; each size for which
10371 a font is available counts as a step.
10372
10373 If HEIGHT is a number, that means to use a font that is HEIGHT times
10374 as tall as the frame's default font.
10375
10376 If HEIGHT is a symbol, it is called as a function with the current
10377 height as argument. The function should return the new height to use.
10378
10379 Otherwise, HEIGHT is evaluated to get the new height, with the symbol
10380 `height' bound to the current specified font height.
10381
10382 - (raise FACTOR)
10383
10384 FACTOR must be a number, specifying a multiple of the current
10385 font's height. If it is positive, that means to display the characters
10386 raised. If it is negative, that means to display them lower down. The
10387 amount of raising or lowering is computed without taking account of the
10388 `height' subproperty.
10389
10390 *** Conditional display properties
10391
10392 All display specifications can be conditionalized. If a specification
10393 has the form `(when CONDITION . SPEC)', the specification SPEC applies
10394 only when CONDITION yields a non-nil value when evaluated. During the
10395 evaluation, `object' is bound to the string or buffer having the
10396 conditional display property; `position' and `buffer-position' are
10397 bound to the position within `object' and the buffer position where
10398 the display property was found, respectively. Both positions can be
10399 different when object is a string.
10400
10401 The normal specification consisting of SPEC only is equivalent to
10402 `(when t . SPEC)'.
10403
10404 ** New menu separator types.
10405
10406 Emacs now supports more than one menu separator type. Menu items with
10407 item names consisting of dashes only (including zero dashes) are
10408 treated like before. In addition, the following item names are used
10409 to specify other menu separator types.
10410
10411 - `--no-line' or `--space', or `--:space', or `--:noLine'
10412
10413 No separator lines are drawn, but a small space is inserted where the
10414 separator occurs.
10415
10416 - `--single-line' or `--:singleLine'
10417
10418 A single line in the menu's foreground color.
10419
10420 - `--double-line' or `--:doubleLine'
10421
10422 A double line in the menu's foreground color.
10423
10424 - `--single-dashed-line' or `--:singleDashedLine'
10425
10426 A single dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10427
10428 - `--double-dashed-line' or `--:doubleDashedLine'
10429
10430 A double dashed line in the menu's foreground color.
10431
10432 - `--shadow-etched-in' or `--:shadowEtchedIn'
10433
10434 A single line with 3D sunken appearance. This is the form
10435 displayed for item names consisting of dashes only.
10436
10437 - `--shadow-etched-out' or `--:shadowEtchedOut'
10438
10439 A single line with 3D raised appearance.
10440
10441 - `--shadow-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedInDash'
10442
10443 A single dashed line with 3D sunken appearance.
10444
10445 - `--shadow-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowEtchedOutDash'
10446
10447 A single dashed line with 3D raise appearance.
10448
10449 - `--shadow-double-etched-in' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedIn'
10450
10451 Two lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10452
10453 - `--shadow-double-etched-out' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOut'
10454
10455 Two lines with 3D raised appearance.
10456
10457 - `--shadow-double-etched-in-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedInDash'
10458
10459 Two dashed lines with 3D sunken appearance.
10460
10461 - `--shadow-double-etched-out-dash' or `--:shadowDoubleEtchedOutDash'
10462
10463 Two dashed lines with 3D raised appearance.
10464
10465 Under LessTif/Motif, the last four separator types are displayed like
10466 the corresponding single-line separators.
10467
10468 ** New frame parameters for scroll bar colors.
10469
10470 The new frame parameters `scroll-bar-foreground' and
10471 `scroll-bar-background' can be used to change scroll bar colors.
10472 Their value must be either a color name, a string, or nil to specify
10473 that scroll bars should use a default color. For toolkit scroll bars,
10474 default colors are toolkit specific. For non-toolkit scroll bars, the
10475 default background is the background color of the frame, and the
10476 default foreground is black.
10477
10478 The X resource name of these parameters are `scrollBarForeground'
10479 (class ScrollBarForeground) and `scrollBarBackground' (class
10480 `ScrollBarBackground').
10481
10482 Setting these parameters overrides toolkit specific X resource
10483 settings for scroll bar colors.
10484
10485 ** You can set `redisplay-dont-pause' to a non-nil value to prevent
10486 display updates from being interrupted when input is pending.
10487
10488 ** Changing a window's width may now change its window start if it
10489 starts on a continuation line. The new window start is computed based
10490 on the window's new width, starting from the start of the continued
10491 line as the start of the screen line with the minimum distance from
10492 the original window start.
10493
10494 ** The variable `hscroll-step' and the functions
10495 `hscroll-point-visible' and `hscroll-window-column' have been removed
10496 now that proper horizontal scrolling is implemented.
10497
10498 ** Windows can now be made fixed-width and/or fixed-height.
10499
10500 A window is fixed-size if its buffer has a buffer-local variable
10501 `window-size-fixed' whose value is not nil. A value of `height' makes
10502 windows fixed-height, a value of `width' makes them fixed-width, any
10503 other non-nil value makes them both fixed-width and fixed-height.
10504
10505 The following code makes all windows displaying the current buffer
10506 fixed-width and fixed-height.
10507
10508 (set (make-local-variable 'window-size-fixed) t)
10509
10510 A call to enlarge-window on a window gives an error if that window is
10511 fixed-width and it is tried to change the window's width, or if the
10512 window is fixed-height, and it is tried to change its height. To
10513 change the size of a fixed-size window, bind `window-size-fixed'
10514 temporarily to nil, for example
10515
10516 (let ((window-size-fixed nil))
10517 (enlarge-window 10))
10518
10519 Likewise, an attempt to split a fixed-height window vertically,
10520 or a fixed-width window horizontally results in a error.
10521
10522 ** The cursor-type frame parameter is now supported on MS-DOS
10523 terminals. When Emacs starts, it by default changes the cursor shape
10524 to a solid box, as it does on Unix. The `cursor-type' frame parameter
10525 overrides this as it does on Unix, except that the bar cursor is
10526 horizontal rather than vertical (since the MS-DOS display doesn't
10527 support a vertical-bar cursor).
10528
10529
10530
10531 * Emacs 20.7 is a bug-fix release with few user-visible changes
10532
10533 ** It is now possible to use CCL-based coding systems for keyboard
10534 input.
10535
10536 ** ange-ftp now handles FTP security extensions, like Kerberos.
10537
10538 ** Rmail has been extended to recognize more forms of digest messages.
10539
10540 ** Now, most coding systems set in keyboard coding system work not
10541 only for character input, but also in incremental search. The
10542 exceptions are such coding systems that handle 2-byte character sets
10543 (e.g euc-kr, euc-jp) and that use ISO's escape sequence
10544 (e.g. iso-2022-jp). They are ignored in incremental search.
10545
10546 ** Support for Macintosh PowerPC-based machines running GNU/Linux has
10547 been added.
10548
10549
10550 * Emacs 20.6 is a bug-fix release with one user-visible change
10551
10552 ** Support for ARM-based non-RISCiX machines has been added.
10553
10554
10555
10556 * Emacs 20.5 is a bug-fix release with no user-visible changes.
10557
10558 ** Not new, but not mentioned before:
10559 M-w when Transient Mark mode is enabled disables the mark.
10560
10561 * Changes in Emacs 20.4
10562
10563 ** Init file may be called .emacs.el.
10564
10565 You can now call the Emacs init file `.emacs.el'.
10566 Formerly the name had to be `.emacs'. If you use the name
10567 `.emacs.el', you can byte-compile the file in the usual way.
10568
10569 If both `.emacs' and `.emacs.el' exist, the latter file
10570 is the one that is used.
10571
10572 ** shell-command, and shell-command-on-region, now return
10573 the exit code of the command (unless it is asynchronous).
10574 Also, you can specify a place to put the error output,
10575 separate from the command's regular output.
10576 Interactively, the variable shell-command-default-error-buffer
10577 says where to put error output; set it to a buffer name.
10578 In calls from Lisp, an optional argument ERROR-BUFFER specifies
10579 the buffer name.
10580
10581 When you specify a non-nil error buffer (or buffer name), any error
10582 output is inserted before point in that buffer, with \f\n to separate
10583 it from the previous batch of error output. The error buffer is not
10584 cleared, so error output from successive commands accumulates there.
10585
10586 ** Setting the default value of enable-multibyte-characters to nil in
10587 the .emacs file, either explicitly using setq-default, or via Custom,
10588 is now essentially equivalent to using --unibyte: all buffers
10589 created during startup will be made unibyte after loading .emacs.
10590
10591 ** C-x C-f now handles the wildcards * and ? in file names. For
10592 example, typing C-x C-f c*.c RET visits all the files whose names
10593 match c*.c. To visit a file whose name contains * or ?, add the
10594 quoting sequence /: to the beginning of the file name.
10595
10596 ** The M-x commands keep-lines, flush-lines and count-matches
10597 now have the same feature as occur and query-replace:
10598 if the pattern contains any upper case letters, then
10599 they never ignore case.
10600
10601 ** The end-of-line format conversion feature previously mentioned
10602 under `* Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows' actually
10603 applies to all operating systems. Emacs recognizes from the contents
10604 of a file what convention it uses to separate lines--newline, CRLF, or
10605 just CR--and automatically converts the contents to the normal Emacs
10606 convention (using newline to separate lines) for editing. This is a
10607 part of the general feature of coding system conversion.
10608
10609 If you subsequently save the buffer, Emacs converts the text back to
10610 the same format that was used in the file before.
10611
10612 You can turn off end-of-line conversion by setting the variable
10613 `inhibit-eol-conversion' to non-nil, e.g. with Custom in the MULE group.
10614
10615 ** The character set property `prefered-coding-system' has been
10616 renamed to `preferred-coding-system', for the sake of correct spelling.
10617 This is a fairly internal feature, so few programs should be affected.
10618
10619 ** Mode-line display of end-of-line format is changed.
10620 The indication of the end-of-line format of the file visited by a
10621 buffer is now more explicit when that format is not the usual one for
10622 your operating system. For example, the DOS-style end-of-line format
10623 is displayed as "(DOS)" on Unix and GNU/Linux systems. The usual
10624 end-of-line format is still displayed as a single character (colon for
10625 Unix, backslash for DOS and Windows, and forward slash for the Mac).
10626
10627 The values of the variables eol-mnemonic-unix, eol-mnemonic-dos,
10628 eol-mnemonic-mac, and eol-mnemonic-undecided, which are strings,
10629 control what is displayed in the mode line for each end-of-line
10630 format. You can now customize these variables.
10631
10632 ** In the previous version of Emacs, tar-mode didn't work well if a
10633 filename contained non-ASCII characters. Now this is fixed. Such a
10634 filename is decoded by file-name-coding-system if the default value of
10635 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil.
10636
10637 ** The command temp-buffer-resize-mode toggles a minor mode
10638 in which temporary buffers (such as help buffers) are given
10639 windows just big enough to hold the whole contents.
10640
10641 ** If you use completion.el, you must now run the function
10642 dynamic-completion-mode to enable it. Just loading the file
10643 doesn't have any effect.
10644
10645 ** In Flyspell mode, the default is now to make just one Ispell process,
10646 not one per buffer.
10647
10648 ** If you use iswitchb but do not call (iswitchb-default-keybindings) to
10649 use the default keybindings, you will need to add the following line:
10650 (add-hook 'minibuffer-setup-hook 'iswitchb-minibuffer-setup)
10651
10652 ** Auto-show mode is no longer enabled just by loading auto-show.el.
10653 To control it, set `auto-show-mode' via Custom or use the
10654 `auto-show-mode' command.
10655
10656 ** Handling of X fonts' ascent/descent parameters has been changed to
10657 avoid redisplay problems. As a consequence, compared with previous
10658 versions the line spacing and frame size now differ with some font
10659 choices, typically increasing by a pixel per line. This change
10660 occurred in version 20.3 but was not documented then.
10661
10662 ** If you select the bar cursor style, it uses the frame's
10663 cursor-color, rather than the cursor foreground pixel.
10664
10665 ** In multibyte mode, Rmail decodes incoming MIME messages using the
10666 character set specified in the message. If you want to disable this
10667 feature, set the variable rmail-decode-mime-charset to nil.
10668
10669 ** Not new, but not mentioned previously in NEWS: when you use #! at
10670 the beginning of a file to make it executable and specify an
10671 interpreter program, Emacs looks on the second line for the -*- mode
10672 and variable specification, as well as on the first line.
10673
10674 ** Support for IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters.
10675
10676 The new command M-x codepage-setup creates a special coding system
10677 that can be used to convert text between a specific IBM codepage and
10678 one of the character sets built into Emacs which matches that
10679 codepage. For example, codepage 850 corresponds to Latin-1 character
10680 set, codepage 855 corresponds to Cyrillic-ISO character set, etc.
10681
10682 Windows codepages 1250, 1251 and some others, where Windows deviates
10683 from the corresponding ISO character set, are also supported.
10684
10685 IBM box-drawing characters and other glyphs which don't have
10686 equivalents in the corresponding ISO character set, are converted to
10687 a character defined by dos-unsupported-char-glyph on MS-DOS, and to
10688 `?' on other systems.
10689
10690 IBM codepages are widely used on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, so this
10691 feature is most useful on those platforms, but it can also be used on
10692 Unix.
10693
10694 Emacs compiled for MS-DOS automatically loads the support for the
10695 current codepage when it starts.
10696
10697 ** Mail changes
10698
10699 *** When mail is sent using compose-mail (C-x m), and if
10700 `mail-send-nonascii' is set to the new default value `mime',
10701 appropriate MIME headers are added. The headers are added only if
10702 non-ASCII characters are present in the body of the mail, and no other
10703 MIME headers are already present. For example, the following three
10704 headers are added if the coding system used in the *mail* buffer is
10705 latin-1:
10706
10707 MIME-version: 1.0
10708 Content-type: text/plain; charset=iso-8859-1
10709 Content-Transfer-Encoding: 8bit
10710
10711 *** The new variable default-sendmail-coding-system specifies the
10712 default way to encode outgoing mail. This has higher priority than
10713 default-buffer-file-coding-system but has lower priority than
10714 sendmail-coding-system and the local value of
10715 buffer-file-coding-system.
10716
10717 You should not set this variable manually. Instead, set
10718 sendmail-coding-system to specify a fixed encoding for all outgoing
10719 mail.
10720
10721 *** When you try to send a message that contains non-ASCII characters,
10722 if the coding system specified by those variables doesn't handle them,
10723 Emacs will ask you to select a suitable coding system while showing a
10724 list of possible coding systems.
10725
10726 ** CC Mode changes
10727
10728 *** c-default-style can now take an association list that maps major
10729 modes to style names. When this variable is an alist, Java mode no
10730 longer hardcodes a setting to "java" style. See the variable's
10731 docstring for details.
10732
10733 *** It's now possible to put a list as the offset on a syntactic
10734 symbol. The list is evaluated recursively until a non-nil offset is
10735 found. This is useful to combine several lineup functions to act in a
10736 prioritized order on a single line. However, none of the supplied
10737 lineup functions use this feature currently.
10738
10739 *** New syntactic symbol catch-clause, which is used on the "catch" and
10740 "finally" lines in try-catch constructs in C++ and Java.
10741
10742 *** New cleanup brace-catch-brace on c-cleanup-list, which does for
10743 "catch" lines what brace-elseif-brace does for "else if" lines.
10744
10745 *** The braces of Java anonymous inner classes are treated separately
10746 from the braces of other classes in auto-newline mode. Two new
10747 symbols inexpr-class-open and inexpr-class-close may be used on
10748 c-hanging-braces-alist to control the automatic newlines used for
10749 anonymous classes.
10750
10751 *** Support for the Pike language added, along with new Pike specific
10752 syntactic symbols: inlambda, lambda-intro-cont
10753
10754 *** Support for Java anonymous classes via new syntactic symbol
10755 inexpr-class. New syntactic symbol inexpr-statement for Pike
10756 support and gcc-style statements inside expressions. New lineup
10757 function c-lineup-inexpr-block.
10758
10759 *** New syntactic symbol brace-entry-open which is used in brace lists
10760 (i.e. static initializers) when a list entry starts with an open
10761 brace. These used to be recognized as brace-list-entry's.
10762 c-electric-brace also recognizes brace-entry-open braces
10763 (brace-list-entry's can no longer be electrified).
10764
10765 *** New command c-indent-line-or-region, not bound by default.
10766
10767 *** `#' is only electric when typed in the indentation of a line.
10768
10769 *** Parentheses are now electric (via the new command c-electric-paren)
10770 for auto-reindenting lines when parens are typed.
10771
10772 *** In "gnu" style, inline-open offset is now set to zero.
10773
10774 *** Uniform handling of the inclass syntactic symbol. The indentation
10775 associated with it is now always relative to the class opening brace.
10776 This means that the indentation behavior has changed in some
10777 circumstances, but only if you've put anything besides 0 on the
10778 class-open syntactic symbol (none of the default styles do that).
10779
10780 ** Gnus changes.
10781
10782 *** New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
10783 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added. See the
10784 Gnus manual for the full story.
10785
10786 *** The nndraft backend has returned, but works differently than
10787 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the nndraft
10788 group, which is created automatically.
10789
10790 *** `gnus-alter-header-function' can now be used to alter header
10791 values.
10792
10793 *** `gnus-summary-goto-article' now accept Message-ID's.
10794
10795 *** A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
10796 outside the region: `C-c C-v'.
10797
10798 *** You can now post to component group in nnvirtual groups with
10799 `C-u C-c C-c'.
10800
10801 *** `nntp-rlogin-program' -- new variable to ease customization.
10802
10803 *** `C-u C-c C-c' in `gnus-article-edit-mode' will now inhibit
10804 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
10805
10806 *** New element in `gnus-boring-article-headers' -- `long-to'.
10807
10808 *** `M-i' symbolic prefix command. See the section "Symbolic
10809 Prefixes" in the Gnus manual for details.
10810
10811 *** `L' and `I' in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
10812 `a' to add the score rule to the "all.SCORE" file.
10813
10814 *** `gnus-simplify-subject-functions' variable to allow greater
10815 control over simplification.
10816
10817 *** `A T' -- new command for fetching the current thread.
10818
10819 *** `/ T' -- new command for including the current thread in the
10820 limit.
10821
10822 *** `M-RET' is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
10823
10824 *** \\1-expressions are now valid in `nnmail-split-methods'.
10825
10826 *** The `custom-face-lookup' function has been removed.
10827 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
10828 rewrite them to use `face-spec-set' instead.
10829
10830 *** Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
10831 `a' forces normal posting method.
10832
10833 *** New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper text
10834 -- `W d'.
10835
10836 *** For easier debugging of nntp, you can set `nntp-record-commands'
10837 to a non-nil value.
10838
10839 *** nntp now uses ~/.authinfo, a .netrc-like file, for controlling
10840 where and how to send AUTHINFO to NNTP servers.
10841
10842 *** A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
10843 has been added.
10844
10845 *** A history of where mails have been split is available.
10846
10847 *** A new article date command has been added -- `article-date-iso8601'.
10848
10849 *** Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
10850 `gnus-score-thread-simplify'.
10851
10852 *** A new function for citing in Message has been added --
10853 `message-cite-original-without-signature'.
10854
10855 *** `article-strip-all-blank-lines' -- new article command.
10856
10857 *** A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
10858 been added.
10859
10860 *** A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
10861 `gnus-adaptive-word-minimum' variable.
10862
10863 *** The "lapsed date" article header can be kept continually
10864 updated by the `gnus-start-date-timer' command.
10865
10866 *** Web listserv archives can be read with the nnlistserv backend.
10867
10868 *** Old dejanews archives can now be read by nnweb.
10869
10870 *** `gnus-posting-styles' has been re-activated.
10871
10872 ** Changes to TeX and LaTeX mode
10873
10874 *** The new variable `tex-start-options-string' can be used to give
10875 options for the TeX run. The default value causes TeX to run in
10876 nonstopmode. For an interactive TeX run set it to nil or "".
10877
10878 *** The command `tex-feed-input' sends input to the Tex Shell. In a
10879 TeX buffer it is bound to the keys C-RET, C-c RET, and C-c C-m (some
10880 of these keys may not work on all systems). For instance, if you run
10881 TeX interactively and if the TeX run stops because of an error, you
10882 can continue it without leaving the TeX buffer by typing C-RET.
10883
10884 *** The Tex Shell Buffer is now in `compilation-shell-minor-mode'.
10885 All error-parsing commands of the Compilation major mode are available
10886 but bound to keys that don't collide with the shell. Thus you can use
10887 the Tex Shell for command line executions like a usual shell.
10888
10889 *** The commands `tex-validate-region' and `tex-validate-buffer' check
10890 the matching of braces and $'s. The errors are listed in a *Occur*
10891 buffer and you can use C-c C-c or mouse-2 to go to a particular
10892 mismatch.
10893
10894 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
10895
10896 *** The table of contents buffer can now also display labels and
10897 file boundaries in addition to sections. Use `l', `i', and `c' keys.
10898
10899 *** Labels derived from context (the section heading) are now
10900 lowercase by default. To make the label legal in LaTeX, latin-1
10901 characters will lose their accent. All Mule characters will be
10902 removed from the label.
10903
10904 *** The automatic display of cross reference information can also use
10905 a window instead of the echo area. See variable `reftex-auto-view-crossref'.
10906
10907 *** kpsewhich can be used by RefTeX to find TeX and BibTeX files. See the
10908 customization group `reftex-finding-files'.
10909
10910 *** The option `reftex-bibfile-ignore-list' has been renamed to
10911 `reftex-bibfile-ignore-regexps' and indeed can be fed with regular
10912 expressions.
10913
10914 *** Multiple Selection buffers are now hidden buffers.
10915
10916 ** New/deleted modes and packages
10917
10918 *** The package snmp-mode.el provides major modes for editing SNMP and
10919 SNMPv2 MIBs. It has entries on `auto-mode-alist'.
10920
10921 *** The package sql.el provides a major mode, M-x sql-mode, for
10922 editing SQL files, and M-x sql-interactive-mode for interacting with
10923 SQL interpreters. It has an entry on `auto-mode-alist'.
10924
10925 *** ispell4.el has been deleted. It got in the way of ispell.el and
10926 this was hard to fix reliably. It has long been obsolete -- use
10927 Ispell 3.1 and ispell.el.
10928
10929 * MS-DOS changes in Emacs 20.4
10930
10931 ** Emacs compiled for MS-DOS now supports MULE features better.
10932 This includes support for display of all ISO 8859-N character sets,
10933 conversion to and from IBM codepage encoding of non-ASCII characters,
10934 and automatic setup of the MULE environment at startup. For details,
10935 check out the section `MS-DOS and MULE' in the manual.
10936
10937 The MS-DOS installation procedure automatically configures and builds
10938 Emacs with input method support if it finds an unpacked Leim
10939 distribution when the config.bat script is run.
10940
10941 ** Formerly, the value of lpr-command did not affect printing on
10942 MS-DOS unless print-region-function was set to nil, but now it
10943 controls whether an external program is invoked or output is written
10944 directly to a printer port. Similarly, in the previous version of
10945 Emacs, the value of ps-lpr-command did not affect PostScript printing
10946 on MS-DOS unless ps-printer-name was set to something other than a
10947 string (eg. t or `pipe'), but now it controls whether an external
10948 program is used. (These changes were made so that configuration of
10949 printing variables would be almost identical across all platforms.)
10950
10951 ** In the previous version of Emacs, PostScript and non-PostScript
10952 output was piped to external programs, but because most print programs
10953 available for MS-DOS and MS-Windows cannot read data from their standard
10954 input, on those systems the data to be output is now written to a
10955 temporary file whose name is passed as the last argument to the external
10956 program.
10957
10958 An exception is made for `print', a standard program on Windows NT,
10959 and `nprint', a standard program on Novell Netware. For both of these
10960 programs, the command line is constructed in the appropriate syntax
10961 automatically, using only the value of printer-name or ps-printer-name
10962 as appropriate--the value of the relevant `-switches' variable is
10963 ignored, as both programs have no useful switches.
10964
10965 ** The value of the variable dos-printer (cf. dos-ps-printer), if it has
10966 a value, overrides the value of printer-name (cf. ps-printer-name), on
10967 MS-DOS and MS-Windows only. This has been true since version 20.3, but
10968 was not documented clearly before.
10969
10970 ** All the Emacs games now work on MS-DOS terminals.
10971 This includes Tetris and Snake.
10972
10973 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.4
10974
10975 ** New functions line-beginning-position and line-end-position
10976 return the position of the beginning or end of the current line.
10977 They both accept an optional argument, which has the same
10978 meaning as the argument to beginning-of-line or end-of-line.
10979
10980 ** find-file and allied functions now have an optional argument
10981 WILDCARD. If this is non-nil, they do wildcard processing,
10982 and visit all files that match the wildcard pattern.
10983
10984 ** Changes in the file-attributes function.
10985
10986 *** The file size returned by file-attributes may be an integer or a float.
10987 It is an integer if the size fits in a Lisp integer, float otherwise.
10988
10989 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
10990 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a cons cell containing two
10991 integers.
10992
10993 ** The new function directory-files-and-attributes returns a list of
10994 files in a directory and their attributes. It accepts the same
10995 arguments as directory-files and has similar semantics, except that
10996 file names and attributes are returned.
10997
10998 ** The new function file-attributes-lessp is a helper function for
10999 sorting the list generated by directory-files-and-attributes. It
11000 accepts two arguments, each a list of a file name and its attributes.
11001 It compares the file names of each according to string-lessp and
11002 returns the result.
11003
11004 ** The new function file-expand-wildcards expands a wildcard-pattern
11005 to produce a list of existing files that match the pattern.
11006
11007 ** New functions for base64 conversion:
11008
11009 The function base64-encode-region converts a part of the buffer
11010 into the base64 code used in MIME. base64-decode-region
11011 performs the opposite conversion. Line-breaking is supported
11012 optionally.
11013
11014 Functions base64-encode-string and base64-decode-string do a similar
11015 job on the text in a string. They return the value as a new string.
11016
11017 **
11018 The new function process-running-child-p
11019 will tell you if a subprocess has given control of its
11020 terminal to its own child process.
11021
11022 ** interrupt-process and such functions have a new feature:
11023 when the second argument is `lambda', they send a signal
11024 to the running child of the subshell, if any, but if the shell
11025 itself owns its terminal, no signal is sent.
11026
11027 ** There are new widget types `plist' and `alist' which can
11028 be used for customizing variables whose values are plists or alists.
11029
11030 ** easymenu.el now understands `:key-sequence' and `:style button'.
11031 :included is an alias for :visible.
11032
11033 easy-menu-add-item now understands the values returned by
11034 easy-menu-remove-item and easy-menu-item-present-p. This can be used
11035 to move or copy menu entries.
11036
11037 ** Multibyte editing changes
11038
11039 *** The definitions of sref and char-bytes are changed. Now, sref is
11040 an alias of aref and char-bytes always returns 1. This change is to
11041 make some Emacs Lisp code which works on 20.2 and earlier also
11042 work on the latest Emacs. Such code uses a combination of sref and
11043 char-bytes in a loop typically as below:
11044 (setq char (sref str idx)
11045 idx (+ idx (char-bytes idx)))
11046 The byte-compiler now warns that this is obsolete.
11047
11048 If you want to know how many bytes a specific multibyte character
11049 (say, CH) occupies in a multibyte buffer, use this code:
11050 (charset-bytes (char-charset ch))
11051
11052 *** In multibyte mode, when you narrow a buffer to some region, and the
11053 region is preceded or followed by non-ASCII codes, inserting or
11054 deleting at the head or the end of the region may signal this error:
11055
11056 Byte combining across boundary of accessible buffer text inhibited
11057
11058 This is to avoid some bytes being combined together into a character
11059 across the boundary.
11060
11061 *** The functions find-charset-region and find-charset-string include
11062 `unknown' in the returned list in the following cases:
11063 o The current buffer or the target string is unibyte and
11064 contains 8-bit characters.
11065 o The current buffer or the target string is multibyte and
11066 contains invalid characters.
11067
11068 *** The functions decode-coding-region and encode-coding-region remove
11069 text properties of the target region. Ideally, they should correctly
11070 preserve text properties, but for the moment, it's hard. Removing
11071 text properties is better than preserving them in a less-than-correct
11072 way.
11073
11074 *** prefer-coding-system sets EOL conversion of default coding systems.
11075 If the argument to prefer-coding-system specifies a certain type of
11076 end of line conversion, the default coding systems set by
11077 prefer-coding-system will specify that conversion type for end of line.
11078
11079 *** The new function thai-compose-string can be used to properly
11080 compose Thai characters in a string.
11081
11082 ** The primitive `define-prefix-command' now takes an optional third
11083 argument NAME, which should be a string. It supplies the menu name
11084 for the created keymap. Keymaps created in order to be displayed as
11085 menus should always use the third argument.
11086
11087 ** The meanings of optional second arguments for read-char,
11088 read-event, and read-char-exclusive are flipped. Now the second
11089 arguments are INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. These functions use the current
11090 input method (if any) if and only if INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD is non-nil.
11091
11092 ** The new function clear-this-command-keys empties out the contents
11093 of the vector that (this-command-keys) returns. This is useful in
11094 programs that read passwords, to prevent the passwords from echoing
11095 inadvertently as part of the next command in certain cases.
11096
11097 ** The new macro `with-temp-message' displays a temporary message in
11098 the echo area, while executing some Lisp code. Like `progn', it
11099 returns the value of the last form, but it also restores the previous
11100 echo area contents.
11101
11102 (with-temp-message MESSAGE &rest BODY)
11103
11104 ** The function `require' now takes an optional third argument
11105 NOERROR. If it is non-nil, then there is no error if the
11106 requested feature cannot be loaded.
11107
11108 ** In the function modify-face, an argument of (nil) for the
11109 foreground color, background color or stipple pattern
11110 means to clear out that attribute.
11111
11112 ** The `outer-window-id' frame property of an X frame
11113 gives the window number of the outermost X window for the frame.
11114
11115 ** Temporary buffers made with with-output-to-temp-buffer are now
11116 read-only by default, and normally use the major mode Help mode
11117 unless you put them in some other non-Fundamental mode before the
11118 end of with-output-to-temp-buffer.
11119
11120 ** The new functions gap-position and gap-size return information on
11121 the gap of the current buffer.
11122
11123 ** The new functions position-bytes and byte-to-position provide a way
11124 to convert between character positions and byte positions in the
11125 current buffer.
11126
11127 ** vc.el defines two new macros, `edit-vc-file' and `with-vc-file', to
11128 facilitate working with version-controlled files from Lisp programs.
11129 These macros check out a given file automatically if needed, and check
11130 it back in after any modifications have been made.
11131
11132 * Installation Changes in Emacs 20.3
11133
11134 ** The default value of load-path now includes most subdirectories of
11135 the site-specific directories /usr/local/share/emacs/site-lisp and
11136 /usr/local/share/emacs/VERSION/site-lisp, in addition to those
11137 directories themselves. Both immediate subdirectories and
11138 subdirectories multiple levels down are added to load-path.
11139
11140 Not all subdirectories are included, though. Subdirectories whose
11141 names do not start with a letter or digit are excluded.
11142 Subdirectories named RCS or CVS are excluded. Also, a subdirectory
11143 which contains a file named `.nosearch' is excluded. You can use
11144 these methods to prevent certain subdirectories from being searched.
11145
11146 Emacs finds these subdirectories and adds them to load-path when it
11147 starts up. While it would be cleaner to find the subdirectories each
11148 time Emacs loads a file, that would be much slower.
11149
11150 This feature is an incompatible change. If you have stored some Emacs
11151 Lisp files in a subdirectory of the site-lisp directory specifically
11152 to prevent them from being used, you will need to rename the
11153 subdirectory to start with a non-alphanumeric character, or create a
11154 `.nosearch' file in it, in order to continue to achieve the desired
11155 results.
11156
11157 ** Emacs no longer includes an old version of the C preprocessor from
11158 GCC. This was formerly used to help compile Emacs with C compilers
11159 that had limits on the significant length of an identifier, but in
11160 fact we stopped supporting such compilers some time ago.
11161
11162 * Changes in Emacs 20.3
11163
11164 ** The new command C-x z (repeat) repeats the previous command
11165 including its argument. If you repeat the z afterward,
11166 it repeats the command additional times; thus, you can
11167 perform many repetitions with one keystroke per repetition.
11168
11169 ** Emacs now supports "selective undo" which undoes only within a
11170 specified region. To do this, set point and mark around the desired
11171 region and type C-u C-x u (or C-u C-_). You can then continue undoing
11172 further, within the same region, by repeating the ordinary undo
11173 command C-x u or C-_. This will keep undoing changes that were made
11174 within the region you originally specified, until either all of them
11175 are undone, or it encounters a change which crosses the edge of that
11176 region.
11177
11178 In Transient Mark mode, undoing when a region is active requests
11179 selective undo.
11180
11181 ** If you specify --unibyte when starting Emacs, then all buffers are
11182 unibyte, except when a Lisp program specifically creates a multibyte
11183 buffer. Setting the environment variable EMACS_UNIBYTE has the same
11184 effect. The --no-unibyte option overrides EMACS_UNIBYTE and directs
11185 Emacs to run normally in multibyte mode.
11186
11187 The option --unibyte does not affect the reading of Emacs Lisp files,
11188 though. If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode, use
11189 -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line. That will force Emacs to
11190 load that file in unibyte mode, regardless of how Emacs was started.
11191
11192 ** toggle-enable-multibyte-characters no longer has a key binding and
11193 no longer appears in the menu bar. We've realized that changing the
11194 enable-multibyte-characters variable in an existing buffer is
11195 something that most users not do.
11196
11197 ** You can specify a coding system to use for the next cut or paste
11198 operations through the window system with the command C-x RET X.
11199 The coding system can make a difference for communication with other
11200 applications.
11201
11202 C-x RET x specifies a coding system for all subsequent cutting and
11203 pasting operations.
11204
11205 ** You can specify the printer to use for commands that do printing by
11206 setting the variable `printer-name'. Just what a printer name looks
11207 like depends on your operating system. You can specify a different
11208 printer for the Postscript printing commands by setting
11209 `ps-printer-name'.
11210
11211 ** Emacs now supports on-the-fly spell checking by the means of a
11212 minor mode. It is called M-x flyspell-mode. You don't have to remember
11213 any other special commands to use it, and you will hardly notice it
11214 except when you make a spelling error. Flyspell works by highlighting
11215 incorrect words as soon as they are completed or as soon as the cursor
11216 hits a new word.
11217
11218 Flyspell mode works with whichever dictionary you have selected for
11219 Ispell in Emacs. In TeX mode, it understands TeX syntax so as not
11220 to be confused by TeX commands.
11221
11222 You can correct a misspelled word by editing it into something
11223 correct. You can also correct it, or accept it as correct, by
11224 clicking on the word with Mouse-2; that gives you a pop-up menu
11225 of various alternative replacements and actions.
11226
11227 Flyspell mode also proposes "automatic" corrections. M-TAB replaces
11228 the current misspelled word with a possible correction. If several
11229 corrections are made possible, M-TAB cycles through them in
11230 alphabetical order, or in order of decreasing likelihood if
11231 flyspell-sort-corrections is nil.
11232
11233 Flyspell mode also flags an error when a word is repeated, if
11234 flyspell-mark-duplications-flag is non-nil.
11235
11236 ** Changes in input method usage.
11237
11238 Now you can use arrow keys (right, left, down, up) for selecting among
11239 the alternatives just the same way as you do by C-f, C-b, C-n, and C-p
11240 respectively.
11241
11242 You can use the ENTER key to accept the current conversion.
11243
11244 If you type TAB to display a list of alternatives, you can select one
11245 of the alternatives with Mouse-2.
11246
11247 The meaning of the variable `input-method-verbose-flag' is changed so
11248 that you can set it to t, nil, `default', or `complex-only'.
11249
11250 If the value is nil, extra guidance is never given.
11251
11252 If the value is t, extra guidance is always given.
11253
11254 If the value is `complex-only', extra guidance is always given only
11255 when you are using complex input methods such as chinese-py.
11256
11257 If the value is `default' (this is the default), extra guidance is
11258 given in the following case:
11259 o When you are using a complex input method.
11260 o When you are using a simple input method but not in the minibuffer.
11261
11262 If you are using Emacs through a very slow line, setting
11263 input-method-verbose-flag to nil or to complex-only is a good choice,
11264 and if you are using an input method you are not familiar with,
11265 setting it to t is helpful.
11266
11267 The old command select-input-method is now called set-input-method.
11268
11269 In the language environment "Korean", you can use the following
11270 keys:
11271 Shift-SPC toggle-korean-input-method
11272 C-F9 quail-hangul-switch-symbol-ksc
11273 F9 quail-hangul-switch-hanja
11274 These key bindings are canceled when you switch to another language
11275 environment.
11276
11277 ** The minibuffer history of file names now records the specified file
11278 names, not the entire minibuffer input. For example, if the
11279 minibuffer starts out with /usr/foo/, you might type in /etc/passwd to
11280 get
11281
11282 /usr/foo//etc/passwd
11283
11284 which stands for the file /etc/passwd.
11285
11286 Formerly, this used to put /usr/foo//etc/passwd in the history list.
11287 Now this puts just /etc/passwd in the history list.
11288
11289 ** If you are root, Emacs sets backup-by-copying-when-mismatch to t
11290 at startup, so that saving a file will be sure to preserve
11291 its owner and group.
11292
11293 ** find-func.el can now also find the place of definition of Emacs
11294 Lisp variables in user-loaded libraries.
11295
11296 ** C-x r t (string-rectangle) now deletes the existing rectangle
11297 contents before inserting the specified string on each line.
11298
11299 ** There is a new command delete-whitespace-rectangle
11300 which deletes whitespace starting from a particular column
11301 in all the lines on a rectangle. The column is specified
11302 by the left edge of the rectangle.
11303
11304 ** You can now store a number into a register with C-u NUMBER C-x r n REG,
11305 increment it by INC with C-u INC C-x r + REG (to increment by one, omit
11306 C-u INC), and insert it in the buffer with C-x r g REG. This is useful
11307 for writing keyboard macros.
11308
11309 ** The new command M-x speedbar displays a frame in which directories,
11310 files, and tags can be displayed, manipulated, and jumped to. The
11311 frame defaults to 20 characters in width, and is the same height as
11312 the frame that it was started from. Some major modes define
11313 additional commands for the speedbar, including Rmail, GUD/GDB, and
11314 info.
11315
11316 ** query-replace-regexp is now bound to C-M-%.
11317
11318 ** In Transient Mark mode, when the region is active, M-x
11319 query-replace and the other replace commands now operate on the region
11320 contents only.
11321
11322 ** M-x write-region, when used interactively, now asks for
11323 confirmation before overwriting an existing file. When you call
11324 the function from a Lisp program, a new optional argument CONFIRM
11325 says whether to ask for confirmation in this case.
11326
11327 ** If you use find-file-literally and the file is already visited
11328 non-literally, the command asks you whether to revisit the file
11329 literally. If you say no, it signals an error.
11330
11331 ** Major modes defined with the "derived mode" feature
11332 now use the proper name for the mode hook: WHATEVER-mode-hook.
11333 Formerly they used the name WHATEVER-mode-hooks, but that is
11334 inconsistent with Emacs conventions.
11335
11336 ** shell-command-on-region (and shell-command) reports success or
11337 failure if the command produces no output.
11338
11339 ** Set focus-follows-mouse to nil if your window system or window
11340 manager does not transfer focus to another window when you just move
11341 the mouse.
11342
11343 ** mouse-menu-buffer-maxlen has been renamed to
11344 mouse-buffer-menu-maxlen to be consistent with the other related
11345 function and variable names.
11346
11347 ** The new variable auto-coding-alist specifies coding systems for
11348 reading specific files. This has higher priority than
11349 file-coding-system-alist.
11350
11351 ** If you set the variable unibyte-display-via-language-environment to
11352 t, then Emacs displays non-ASCII characters are displayed by
11353 converting them to the equivalent multibyte characters according to
11354 the current language environment. As a result, they are displayed
11355 according to the current fontset.
11356
11357 ** C-q's handling of codes in the range 0200 through 0377 is changed.
11358
11359 The codes in the range 0200 through 0237 are inserted as one byte of
11360 that code regardless of the values of nonascii-translation-table and
11361 nonascii-insert-offset.
11362
11363 For the codes in the range 0240 through 0377, if
11364 enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil and nonascii-translation-table
11365 nor nonascii-insert-offset can't convert them to valid multibyte
11366 characters, they are converted to Latin-1 characters.
11367
11368 ** If you try to find a file that is not read-accessible, you now get
11369 an error, rather than an empty buffer and a warning.
11370
11371 ** In the minibuffer history commands M-r and M-s, an upper case
11372 letter in the regular expression forces case-sensitive search.
11373
11374 ** In the *Help* buffer, cross-references to commands and variables
11375 are inferred and hyperlinked. Use C-h m in Help mode for the relevant
11376 command keys.
11377
11378 ** M-x apropos-command, with a prefix argument, no longer looks for
11379 user option variables--instead it looks for noninteractive functions.
11380
11381 Meanwhile, the command apropos-variable normally searches for
11382 user option variables; with a prefix argument, it looks at
11383 all variables that have documentation.
11384
11385 ** When you type a long line in the minibuffer, and the minibuffer
11386 shows just one line, automatically scrolling works in a special way
11387 that shows you overlap with the previous line of text. The variable
11388 minibuffer-scroll-overlap controls how many characters of overlap
11389 it should show; the default is 20.
11390
11391 Meanwhile, Resize Minibuffer mode is still available; in that mode,
11392 the minibuffer grows taller (up to a point) as needed to show the whole
11393 of your input.
11394
11395 ** The new command M-x customize-changed-options lets you customize
11396 all the options whose meanings or default values have changed in
11397 recent Emacs versions. You specify a previous Emacs version number as
11398 argument, and the command creates a customization buffer showing all
11399 the customizable options which were changed since that version.
11400 Newly added options are included as well.
11401
11402 If you don't specify a particular version number argument,
11403 then the customization buffer shows all the customizable options
11404 for which Emacs versions of changes are recorded.
11405
11406 This function is also bound to the Changed Options entry in the
11407 Customize menu.
11408
11409 ** When you run M-x grep with a prefix argument, it figures out
11410 the tag around point and puts that into the default grep command.
11411
11412 ** The new command M-* (pop-tag-mark) pops back through a history of
11413 buffer positions from which M-. or other tag-finding commands were
11414 invoked.
11415
11416 ** The new variable comment-padding specifies the number of spaces
11417 that `comment-region' will insert before the actual text of the comment.
11418 The default is 1.
11419
11420 ** In Fortran mode the characters `.', `_' and `$' now have symbol
11421 syntax, not word syntax. Fortran mode now supports `imenu' and has
11422 new commands fortran-join-line (M-^) and fortran-narrow-to-subprogram
11423 (C-x n d). M-q can be used to fill a statement or comment block
11424 sensibly.
11425
11426 ** GUD now supports jdb, the Java debugger, and pdb, the Python debugger.
11427
11428 ** If you set the variable add-log-keep-changes-together to a non-nil
11429 value, the command `C-x 4 a' will automatically notice when you make
11430 two entries in one day for one file, and combine them.
11431
11432 ** You can use the command M-x diary-mail-entries to mail yourself a
11433 reminder about upcoming diary entries. See the documentation string
11434 for a sample shell script for calling this function automatically
11435 every night.
11436
11437 ** Desktop changes
11438
11439 *** All you need to do to enable use of the Desktop package, is to set
11440 the variable desktop-enable to t with Custom.
11441
11442 *** Minor modes are now restored. Which minor modes are restored
11443 and how modes are restored is controlled by `desktop-minor-mode-table'.
11444
11445 ** There is no need to do anything special, now, to enable Gnus to
11446 read and post multi-lingual articles.
11447
11448 ** Outline mode has now support for showing hidden outlines when
11449 doing an isearch. In order for this to happen search-invisible should
11450 be set to open (the default). If an isearch match is inside a hidden
11451 outline the outline is made visible. If you continue pressing C-s and
11452 the match moves outside the formerly invisible outline, the outline is
11453 made invisible again.
11454
11455 ** Mail reading and sending changes
11456
11457 *** The Rmail e command now switches to displaying the whole header of
11458 the message before it lets you edit the message. This is so that any
11459 changes you make in the header will not be lost if you subsequently
11460 toggle.
11461
11462 *** The w command in Rmail, which writes the message body into a file,
11463 now works in the summary buffer as well. (The command to delete the
11464 summary buffer is now Q.) The default file name for the w command, if
11465 the message has no subject, is stored in the variable
11466 rmail-default-body-file.
11467
11468 *** Most of the commands and modes that operate on mail and netnews no
11469 longer depend on the value of mail-header-separator. Instead, they
11470 handle whatever separator the buffer happens to use.
11471
11472 *** If you set mail-signature to a value which is not t, nil, or a string,
11473 it should be an expression. When you send a message, this expression
11474 is evaluated to insert the signature.
11475
11476 *** The new Lisp library feedmail.el (version 8) enhances processing of
11477 outbound email messages. It works in coordination with other email
11478 handling packages (e.g., rmail, VM, gnus) and is responsible for
11479 putting final touches on messages and actually submitting them for
11480 transmission. Users of the emacs program "fakemail" might be
11481 especially interested in trying feedmail.
11482
11483 feedmail is not enabled by default. See comments at the top of
11484 feedmail.el for set-up instructions. Among the bigger features
11485 provided by feedmail are:
11486
11487 **** you can park outgoing messages into a disk-based queue and
11488 stimulate sending some or all of them later (handy for laptop users);
11489 there is also a queue for draft messages
11490
11491 **** you can get one last look at the prepped outbound message and
11492 be prompted for confirmation
11493
11494 **** does smart filling of address headers
11495
11496 **** can generate a MESSAGE-ID: line and a DATE: line; the date can be
11497 the time the message was written or the time it is being sent; this
11498 can make FCC copies more closely resemble copies that recipients get
11499
11500 **** you can specify an arbitrary function for actually transmitting
11501 the message; included in feedmail are interfaces for /bin/[r]mail,
11502 /usr/lib/sendmail, and Emacs Lisp smtpmail; it's easy to write a new
11503 function for something else (10-20 lines of Lisp code).
11504
11505 ** Dired changes
11506
11507 *** The Dired function dired-do-toggle, which toggles marked and unmarked
11508 files, is now bound to "t" instead of "T".
11509
11510 *** dired-at-point has been added to ffap.el. It allows one to easily
11511 run Dired on the directory name at point.
11512
11513 *** Dired has a new command: %g. It searches the contents of
11514 files in the directory and marks each file that contains a match
11515 for a specified regexp.
11516
11517 ** VC Changes
11518
11519 *** New option vc-ignore-vc-files lets you turn off version control
11520 conveniently.
11521
11522 *** VC Dired has been completely rewritten. It is now much
11523 faster, especially for CVS, and works very similar to ordinary
11524 Dired.
11525
11526 VC Dired is invoked by typing C-x v d and entering the name of the
11527 directory to display. By default, VC Dired gives you a recursive
11528 listing of all files at or below the given directory which are
11529 currently locked (for CVS, all files not up-to-date are shown).
11530
11531 You can change the listing format by setting vc-dired-recurse to nil,
11532 then it shows only the given directory, and you may also set
11533 vc-dired-terse-display to nil, then it shows all files under version
11534 control plus the names of any subdirectories, so that you can type `i'
11535 on such lines to insert them manually, as in ordinary Dired.
11536
11537 All Dired commands operate normally in VC Dired, except for `v', which
11538 is redefined as the version control prefix. That means you may type
11539 `v l', `v =' etc. to invoke `vc-print-log', `vc-diff' and the like on
11540 the file named in the current Dired buffer line. `v v' invokes
11541 `vc-next-action' on this file, or on all files currently marked.
11542
11543 The new command `v t' (vc-dired-toggle-terse-mode) allows you to
11544 toggle between terse display (only locked files) and full display (all
11545 VC files plus subdirectories). There is also a special command,
11546 `* l', to mark all files currently locked.
11547
11548 Giving a prefix argument to C-x v d now does the same thing as in
11549 ordinary Dired: it allows you to supply additional options for the ls
11550 command in the minibuffer, to fine-tune VC Dired's output.
11551
11552 *** Under CVS, if you merge changes from the repository into a working
11553 file, and CVS detects conflicts, VC now offers to start an ediff
11554 session to resolve them.
11555
11556 Alternatively, you can use the new command `vc-resolve-conflicts' to
11557 resolve conflicts in a file at any time. It works in any buffer that
11558 contains conflict markers as generated by rcsmerge (which is what CVS
11559 uses as well).
11560
11561 *** You can now transfer changes between branches, using the new
11562 command vc-merge (C-x v m). It is implemented for RCS and CVS. When
11563 you invoke it in a buffer under version-control, you can specify
11564 either an entire branch or a pair of versions, and the changes on that
11565 branch or between the two versions are merged into the working file.
11566 If this results in any conflicts, they may be resolved interactively,
11567 using ediff.
11568
11569 ** Changes in Font Lock
11570
11571 *** The face and variable previously known as font-lock-reference-face
11572 are now called font-lock-constant-face to better reflect their typical
11573 use for highlighting constants and labels. (Its face properties are
11574 unchanged.) The variable font-lock-reference-face remains for now for
11575 compatibility reasons, but its value is font-lock-constant-face.
11576
11577 ** Frame name display changes
11578
11579 *** The command set-frame-name lets you set the name of the current
11580 frame. You can use the new command select-frame-by-name to select and
11581 raise a frame; this is mostly useful on character-only terminals, or
11582 when many frames are invisible or iconified.
11583
11584 *** On character-only terminal (not a window system), changing the
11585 frame name is now reflected on the mode line and in the Buffers/Frames
11586 menu.
11587
11588 ** Comint (subshell) changes
11589
11590 *** In Comint modes, the commands to kill, stop or interrupt a
11591 subjob now also kill pending input. This is for compatibility
11592 with ordinary shells, where the signal characters do this.
11593
11594 *** There are new commands in Comint mode.
11595
11596 C-c C-x fetches the "next" line from the input history;
11597 that is, the line after the last line you got.
11598 You can use this command to fetch successive lines, one by one.
11599
11600 C-c SPC accumulates lines of input. More precisely, it arranges to
11601 send the current line together with the following line, when you send
11602 the following line.
11603
11604 C-c C-a if repeated twice consecutively now moves to the process mark,
11605 which separates the pending input from the subprocess output and the
11606 previously sent input.
11607
11608 C-c M-r now runs comint-previous-matching-input-from-input;
11609 it searches for a previous command, using the current pending input
11610 as the search string.
11611
11612 *** New option compilation-scroll-output can be set to scroll
11613 automatically in compilation-mode windows.
11614
11615 ** C mode changes
11616
11617 *** Multiline macros are now handled, both as they affect indentation,
11618 and as recognized syntax. New syntactic symbol cpp-macro-cont is
11619 assigned to second and subsequent lines of a multiline macro
11620 definition.
11621
11622 *** A new style "user" which captures all non-hook-ified
11623 (i.e. top-level) .emacs file variable settings and customizations.
11624 Style "cc-mode" is an alias for "user" and is deprecated. "gnu"
11625 style is still the default however.
11626
11627 *** "java" style now conforms to Sun's JDK coding style.
11628
11629 *** There are new commands c-beginning-of-defun, c-end-of-defun which
11630 are alternatives which you could bind to C-M-a and C-M-e if you prefer
11631 them. They do not have key bindings by default.
11632
11633 *** New and improved implementations of M-a (c-beginning-of-statement)
11634 and M-e (c-end-of-statement).
11635
11636 *** C++ namespace blocks are supported, with new syntactic symbols
11637 namespace-open, namespace-close, and innamespace.
11638
11639 *** File local variable settings of c-file-style and c-file-offsets
11640 makes the style variables local to that buffer only.
11641
11642 *** New indentation functions c-lineup-close-paren,
11643 c-indent-one-line-block, c-lineup-dont-change.
11644
11645 *** Improvements (hopefully!) to the way CC Mode is loaded. You
11646 should now be able to do a (require 'cc-mode) to get the entire
11647 package loaded properly for customization in your .emacs file. A new
11648 variable c-initialize-on-load controls this and is t by default.
11649
11650 ** Changes to hippie-expand.
11651
11652 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-skip-space'. If
11653 non-nil, trailing spaces may be included in the abbreviation to search for,
11654 which then gives the same behavior as the original `dabbrev-expand'.
11655
11656 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-dabbrev-as-symbol'. If
11657 non-nil, characters of syntax '_' is considered part of the word when
11658 expanding dynamically.
11659
11660 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-no-restriction'. If
11661 non-nil, narrowed buffers are widened before they are searched.
11662
11663 *** New customization variable `hippie-expand-only-buffers'. If
11664 non-empty, buffers searched are restricted to the types specified in
11665 this list. Useful for example when constructing new special-purpose
11666 expansion functions with `make-hippie-expand-function'.
11667
11668 *** Text properties of the expansion are no longer copied.
11669
11670 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
11671
11672 *** Any titleword matching a regexp in the new variable
11673 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore (case sensitive) is ignored during
11674 automatic key generation. This replaces variable
11675 bibtex-autokey-titleword-first-ignore, which only checked for matches
11676 against the first word in the title.
11677
11678 *** Autokey generation now uses all words from the title, not just
11679 capitalized words. To avoid conflicts with existing customizations,
11680 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore is set up such that words starting with
11681 lowerkey characters will still be ignored. Thus, if you want to use
11682 lowercase words from the title, you will have to overwrite the
11683 bibtex-autokey-titleword-ignore standard setting.
11684
11685 *** Case conversion of names and title words for automatic key
11686 generation is more flexible. Variable bibtex-autokey-preserve-case is
11687 replaced by bibtex-autokey-titleword-case-convert and
11688 bibtex-autokey-name-case-convert.
11689
11690 ** Changes in vcursor.el.
11691
11692 *** Support for character terminals is available: there is a new keymap
11693 and the vcursor will appear as an arrow between buffer text. A
11694 variable `vcursor-interpret-input' allows input from the vcursor to be
11695 entered exactly as if typed. Numerous functions, including
11696 `vcursor-compare-windows', have been rewritten to improve consistency
11697 in the selection of windows and corresponding keymaps.
11698
11699 *** vcursor options can now be altered with M-x customize under the
11700 Editing group once the package is loaded.
11701
11702 *** Loading vcursor now does not define keys by default, as this is
11703 generally a bad side effect. Use M-x customize to set
11704 vcursor-key-bindings to t to restore the old behavior.
11705
11706 *** vcursor-auto-disable can be `copy', which turns off copying from the
11707 vcursor, but doesn't disable it, after any non-vcursor command.
11708
11709 ** Ispell changes.
11710
11711 *** You can now spell check comments and strings in the current
11712 buffer with M-x ispell-comments-and-strings. Comments and strings
11713 are identified by syntax tables in effect.
11714
11715 *** Generic region skipping implemented.
11716 A single buffer can be broken into a number of regions where text will
11717 and will not be checked. The definitions of the regions can be user
11718 defined. New applications and improvements made available by this
11719 include:
11720
11721 o URLs are automatically skipped
11722 o EMail message checking is vastly improved.
11723
11724 *** Ispell can highlight the erroneous word even on non-window terminals.
11725
11726 ** Changes to RefTeX mode
11727
11728 RefTeX has been updated in order to make it more usable with very
11729 large projects (like a several volume math book). The parser has been
11730 re-written from scratch. To get maximum speed from RefTeX, check the
11731 section `Optimizations' in the manual.
11732
11733 *** New recursive parser.
11734
11735 The old version of RefTeX created a single large buffer containing the
11736 entire multifile document in order to parse the document. The new
11737 recursive parser scans the individual files.
11738
11739 *** Parsing only part of a document.
11740
11741 Reparsing of changed document parts can now be made faster by enabling
11742 partial scans. To use this feature, read the documentation string of
11743 the variable `reftex-enable-partial-scans' and set the variable to t.
11744
11745 (setq reftex-enable-partial-scans t)
11746
11747 *** Storing parsing information in a file.
11748
11749 This can improve startup times considerably. To turn it on, use
11750
11751 (setq reftex-save-parse-info t)
11752
11753 *** Using multiple selection buffers
11754
11755 If the creation of label selection buffers is too slow (this happens
11756 for large documents), you can reuse these buffers by setting
11757
11758 (setq reftex-use-multiple-selection-buffers t)
11759
11760 *** References to external documents.
11761
11762 The LaTeX package `xr' allows to cross-reference labels in external
11763 documents. RefTeX can provide information about the external
11764 documents as well. To use this feature, set up the \externaldocument
11765 macros required by the `xr' package and rescan the document with
11766 RefTeX. The external labels can then be accessed with the `x' key in
11767 the selection buffer provided by `reftex-reference' (bound to `C-c )').
11768 The `x' key also works in the table of contents buffer.
11769
11770 *** Many more labeled LaTeX environments are recognized by default.
11771
11772 The built-in command list now covers all the standard LaTeX commands,
11773 and all of the major packages included in the LaTeX distribution.
11774
11775 Also, RefTeX now understands the \appendix macro and changes
11776 the enumeration of sections in the *toc* buffer accordingly.
11777
11778 *** Mouse support for selection and *toc* buffers
11779
11780 The mouse can now be used to select items in the selection and *toc*
11781 buffers. See also the new option `reftex-highlight-selection'.
11782
11783 *** New keymaps for selection and table of contents modes.
11784
11785 The selection processes for labels and citation keys, and the table of
11786 contents buffer now have their own keymaps: `reftex-select-label-map',
11787 `reftex-select-bib-map', `reftex-toc-map'. The selection processes
11788 have a number of new keys predefined. In particular, TAB lets you
11789 enter a label with completion. Check the on-the-fly help (press `?'
11790 at the selection prompt) or read the Info documentation to find out
11791 more.
11792
11793 *** Support for the varioref package
11794
11795 The `v' key in the label selection buffer toggles \ref versus \vref.
11796
11797 *** New hooks
11798
11799 Three new hooks can be used to redefine the way labels, references,
11800 and citations are created. These hooks are
11801 `reftex-format-label-function', `reftex-format-ref-function',
11802 `reftex-format-cite-function'.
11803
11804 *** Citations outside LaTeX
11805
11806 The command `reftex-citation' may also be used outside LaTeX (e.g. in
11807 a mail buffer). See the Info documentation for details.
11808
11809 *** Short context is no longer fontified.
11810
11811 The short context in the label menu no longer copies the
11812 fontification from the text in the buffer. If you prefer it to be
11813 fontified, use
11814
11815 (setq reftex-refontify-context t)
11816
11817 ** file-cache-minibuffer-complete now accepts a prefix argument.
11818 With a prefix argument, it does not try to do completion of
11819 the file name within its directory; it only checks for other
11820 directories that contain the same file name.
11821
11822 Thus, given the file name Makefile, and assuming that a file
11823 Makefile.in exists in the same directory, ordinary
11824 file-cache-minibuffer-complete will try to complete Makefile to
11825 Makefile.in and will therefore never look for other directories that
11826 have Makefile. A prefix argument tells it not to look for longer
11827 names such as Makefile.in, so that instead it will look for other
11828 directories--just as if the name were already complete in its present
11829 directory.
11830
11831 ** New modes and packages
11832
11833 *** There is a new alternative major mode for Perl, Cperl mode.
11834 It has many more features than Perl mode, and some people prefer
11835 it, but some do not.
11836
11837 *** There is a new major mode, M-x vhdl-mode, for editing files of VHDL
11838 code.
11839
11840 *** M-x which-function-mode enables a minor mode that displays the
11841 current function name continuously in the mode line, as you move
11842 around in a buffer.
11843
11844 Which Function mode is effective in major modes which support Imenu.
11845
11846 *** Gametree is a major mode for editing game analysis trees. The author
11847 uses it for keeping notes about his postal Chess games, but it should
11848 be helpful for other two-player games as well, as long as they have an
11849 established system of notation similar to Chess.
11850
11851 *** The new minor mode checkdoc-minor-mode provides Emacs Lisp
11852 documentation string checking for style and spelling. The style
11853 guidelines are found in the Emacs Lisp programming manual.
11854
11855 *** The net-utils package makes some common networking features
11856 available in Emacs. Some of these functions are wrappers around
11857 system utilities (ping, nslookup, etc.); others are implementations of
11858 simple protocols (finger, whois) in Emacs Lisp. There are also
11859 functions to make simple connections to TCP/IP ports for debugging and
11860 the like.
11861
11862 *** highlight-changes-mode is a minor mode that uses colors to
11863 identify recently changed parts of the buffer text.
11864
11865 *** The new package `midnight' lets you specify things to be done
11866 within Emacs at midnight--by default, kill buffers that you have not
11867 used in a considerable time. To use this feature, customize
11868 the user option `midnight-mode' to t.
11869
11870 *** The file generic-x.el defines a number of simple major modes.
11871
11872 apache-generic-mode: For Apache and NCSA httpd configuration files
11873 samba-generic-mode: Samba configuration files
11874 fvwm-generic-mode: For fvwm initialization files
11875 x-resource-generic-mode: For X resource files
11876 hosts-generic-mode: For hosts files (.rhosts, /etc/hosts, etc.)
11877 mailagent-rules-generic-mode: For mailagent .rules files
11878 javascript-generic-mode: For JavaScript files
11879 vrml-generic-mode: For VRML files
11880 java-manifest-generic-mode: For Java MANIFEST files
11881 java-properties-generic-mode: For Java property files
11882 mailrc-generic-mode: For .mailrc files
11883
11884 Platform-specific modes:
11885
11886 prototype-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V prototype files
11887 pkginfo-generic-mode: For Solaris/Sys V pkginfo files
11888 alias-generic-mode: For C shell alias files
11889 inf-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INF files
11890 ini-generic-mode: For MS-Windows INI files
11891 reg-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Registry files
11892 bat-generic-mode: For MS-Windows BAT scripts
11893 rc-generic-mode: For MS-Windows Resource files
11894 rul-generic-mode: For InstallShield scripts
11895
11896 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 since the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11897
11898 ** If you want a Lisp file to be read in unibyte mode,
11899 use -*-unibyte: t;-*- on its first line.
11900 That will force Emacs to read that file in unibyte mode.
11901 Otherwise, the file will be loaded and byte-compiled in multibyte mode.
11902
11903 Thus, each lisp file is read in a consistent way regardless of whether
11904 you started Emacs with --unibyte, so that a Lisp program gives
11905 consistent results regardless of how Emacs was started.
11906
11907 ** The new function assoc-default is useful for searching an alist,
11908 and using a default value if the key is not found there. You can
11909 specify a comparison predicate, so this function is useful for
11910 searching comparing a string against an alist of regular expressions.
11911
11912 ** The functions unibyte-char-to-multibyte and
11913 multibyte-char-to-unibyte convert between unibyte and multibyte
11914 character codes, in a way that is appropriate for the current language
11915 environment.
11916
11917 ** The functions read-event, read-char and read-char-exclusive now
11918 take two optional arguments. PROMPT, if non-nil, specifies a prompt
11919 string. SUPPRESS-INPUT-METHOD, if non-nil, says to disable the
11920 current input method for reading this one event.
11921
11922 ** Two new variables print-escape-nonascii and print-escape-multibyte
11923 now control whether to output certain characters as
11924 backslash-sequences. print-escape-nonascii applies to single-byte
11925 non-ASCII characters; print-escape-multibyte applies to multibyte
11926 characters. Both of these variables are used only when printing
11927 in readable fashion (prin1 uses them, princ does not).
11928
11929 * Lisp changes in Emacs 20.3 before the Emacs Lisp Manual was published
11930
11931 ** Compiled Emacs Lisp files made with the modified "MBSK" version
11932 of Emacs 20.2 do not work in Emacs 20.3.
11933
11934 ** Buffer positions are now measured in characters, as they were
11935 in Emacs 19 and before. This means that (forward-char 1)
11936 always increases point by 1.
11937
11938 The function chars-in-region now just subtracts its arguments. It is
11939 considered obsolete. The function char-boundary-p has been deleted.
11940
11941 See below for additional changes relating to multibyte characters.
11942
11943 ** defcustom, defface and defgroup now accept the keyword `:version'.
11944 Use this to specify in which version of Emacs a certain variable's
11945 default value changed. For example,
11946
11947 (defcustom foo-max 34 "*Maximum number of foo's allowed."
11948 :type 'integer
11949 :group 'foo
11950 :version "20.3")
11951
11952 (defgroup foo-group nil "The foo group."
11953 :version "20.3")
11954
11955 If an entire new group is added or the variables in it have the
11956 default values changed, then just add a `:version' to that group. It
11957 is recommended that new packages added to the distribution contain a
11958 `:version' in the top level group.
11959
11960 This information is used to control the customize-changed-options command.
11961
11962 ** It is now an error to change the value of a symbol whose name
11963 starts with a colon--if it is interned in the standard obarray.
11964
11965 However, setting such a symbol to its proper value, which is that
11966 symbol itself, is not an error. This is for the sake of programs that
11967 support previous Emacs versions by explicitly setting these variables
11968 to themselves.
11969
11970 If you set the variable keyword-symbols-constant-flag to nil,
11971 this error is suppressed, and you can set these symbols to any
11972 values whatever.
11973
11974 ** There is a new debugger command, R.
11975 It evaluates an expression like e, but saves the result
11976 in the buffer *Debugger-record*.
11977
11978 ** Frame-local variables.
11979
11980 You can now make a variable local to various frames. To do this, call
11981 the function make-variable-frame-local; this enables frames to have
11982 local bindings for that variable.
11983
11984 These frame-local bindings are actually frame parameters: you create a
11985 frame-local binding in a specific frame by calling
11986 modify-frame-parameters and specifying the variable name as the
11987 parameter name.
11988
11989 Buffer-local bindings take precedence over frame-local bindings.
11990 Thus, if the current buffer has a buffer-local binding, that binding is
11991 active; otherwise, if the selected frame has a frame-local binding,
11992 that binding is active; otherwise, the default binding is active.
11993
11994 It would not be hard to implement window-local bindings, but it is not
11995 clear that this would be very useful; windows tend to come and go in a
11996 very transitory fashion, so that trying to produce any specific effect
11997 through a window-local binding would not be very robust.
11998
11999 ** `sregexq' and `sregex' are two new functions for constructing
12000 "symbolic regular expressions." These are Lisp expressions that, when
12001 evaluated, yield conventional string-based regexps. The symbolic form
12002 makes it easier to construct, read, and maintain complex patterns.
12003 See the documentation in sregex.el.
12004
12005 ** parse-partial-sexp's return value has an additional element which
12006 is used to pass information along if you pass it to another call to
12007 parse-partial-sexp, starting its scan where the first call ended.
12008 The contents of this field are not yet finalized.
12009
12010 ** eval-region now accepts a fourth optional argument READ-FUNCTION.
12011 If it is non-nil, that function is used instead of `read'.
12012
12013 ** unload-feature by default removes the feature's functions from
12014 known hooks to avoid trouble, but a package providing FEATURE can
12015 define a hook FEATURE-unload-hook to be run by unload-feature instead.
12016
12017 ** read-from-minibuffer no longer returns the argument DEFAULT-VALUE
12018 when the user enters empty input. It now returns the null string, as
12019 it did in Emacs 19. The default value is made available in the
12020 history via M-n, but it is not applied here as a default.
12021
12022 The other, more specialized minibuffer-reading functions continue to
12023 return the default value (not the null string) when the user enters
12024 empty input.
12025
12026 ** The new variable read-buffer-function controls which routine to use
12027 for selecting buffers. For example, if you set this variable to
12028 `iswitchb-read-buffer', iswitchb will be used to read buffer names.
12029 Other functions can also be used if they accept the same arguments as
12030 `read-buffer' and return the selected buffer name as a string.
12031
12032 ** The new function read-passwd reads a password from the terminal,
12033 echoing a period for each character typed. It takes three arguments:
12034 a prompt string, a flag which says "read it twice to make sure", and a
12035 default password to use if the user enters nothing.
12036
12037 ** The variable fill-nobreak-predicate gives major modes a way to
12038 specify not to break a line at certain places. Its value is a
12039 function which is called with no arguments, with point located at the
12040 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns
12041 non-nil, then the line won't be broken there.
12042
12043 ** window-end now takes an optional second argument, UPDATE.
12044 If this is non-nil, then the function always returns an accurate
12045 up-to-date value for the buffer position corresponding to the
12046 end of the window, even if this requires computation.
12047
12048 ** other-buffer now takes an optional argument FRAME
12049 which specifies which frame's buffer list to use.
12050 If it is nil, that means use the selected frame's buffer list.
12051
12052 ** The new variable buffer-display-time, always local in every buffer,
12053 holds the value of (current-time) as of the last time that a window
12054 was directed to display this buffer.
12055
12056 ** It is now meaningful to compare two window-configuration objects
12057 with `equal'. Two window-configuration objects are equal if they
12058 describe equivalent arrangements of windows, in the same frame--in
12059 other words, if they would give the same results if passed to
12060 set-window-configuration.
12061
12062 ** compare-window-configurations is a new function that compares two
12063 window configurations loosely. It ignores differences in saved buffer
12064 positions and scrolling, and considers only the structure and sizes of
12065 windows and the choice of buffers to display.
12066
12067 ** The variable minor-mode-overriding-map-alist allows major modes to
12068 override the key bindings of a minor mode. The elements of this alist
12069 look like the elements of minor-mode-map-alist: (VARIABLE . KEYMAP).
12070
12071 If the VARIABLE in an element of minor-mode-overriding-map-alist has a
12072 non-nil value, the paired KEYMAP is active, and totally overrides the
12073 map (if any) specified for the same variable in minor-mode-map-alist.
12074
12075 minor-mode-overriding-map-alist is automatically local in all buffers,
12076 and it is meant to be set by major modes.
12077
12078 ** The function match-string-no-properties is like match-string
12079 except that it discards all text properties from the result.
12080
12081 ** The function load-average now accepts an optional argument
12082 USE-FLOATS. If it is non-nil, the load average values are returned as
12083 floating point numbers, rather than as integers to be divided by 100.
12084
12085 ** The new variable temporary-file-directory specifies the directory
12086 to use for creating temporary files. The default value is determined
12087 in a reasonable way for your operating system; on GNU and Unix systems
12088 it is based on the TMP and TMPDIR environment variables.
12089
12090 ** Menu changes
12091
12092 *** easymenu.el now uses the new menu item format and supports the
12093 keywords :visible and :filter. The existing keyword :keys is now
12094 better supported.
12095
12096 The variable `easy-menu-precalculate-equivalent-keybindings' controls
12097 a new feature which calculates keyboard equivalents for the menu when
12098 you define the menu. The default is t. If you rarely use menus, you
12099 can set the variable to nil to disable this precalculation feature;
12100 then the calculation is done only if you use the menu bar.
12101
12102 *** A new format for menu items is supported.
12103
12104 In a keymap, a key binding that has the format
12105 (STRING . REAL-BINDING) or (STRING HELP-STRING . REAL-BINDING)
12106 defines a menu item. Now a menu item definition may also be a list that
12107 starts with the symbol `menu-item'.
12108
12109 The format is:
12110 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) or
12111 (menu-item ITEM-NAME REAL-BINDING . ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST)
12112 where ITEM-NAME is an expression which evaluates to the menu item
12113 string, and ITEM-PROPERTY-LIST has the form of a property list.
12114 The supported properties include
12115
12116 :enable FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
12117 item is enabled.
12118 :visible FORM Evaluate FORM to determine whether the
12119 item should appear in the menu.
12120 :filter FILTER-FN
12121 FILTER-FN is a function of one argument,
12122 which will be REAL-BINDING.
12123 It should return a binding to use instead.
12124 :keys DESCRIPTION
12125 DESCRIPTION is a string that describes an equivalent keyboard
12126 binding for REAL-BINDING. DESCRIPTION is expanded with
12127 `substitute-command-keys' before it is used.
12128 :key-sequence KEY-SEQUENCE
12129 KEY-SEQUENCE is a key-sequence for an equivalent
12130 keyboard binding.
12131 :key-sequence nil
12132 This means that the command normally has no
12133 keyboard equivalent.
12134 :help HELP HELP is the extra help string (not currently used).
12135 :button (TYPE . SELECTED)
12136 TYPE is :toggle or :radio.
12137 SELECTED is a form, to be evaluated, and its
12138 value says whether this button is currently selected.
12139
12140 Buttons are at the moment only simulated by prefixes in the menu.
12141 Eventually ordinary X-buttons may be supported.
12142
12143 (menu-item ITEM-NAME) defines unselectable item.
12144
12145 ** New event types
12146
12147 *** The new event type `mouse-wheel' is generated by a wheel on a
12148 mouse (such as the MS Intellimouse). The event contains a delta that
12149 corresponds to the amount and direction that the wheel is rotated,
12150 which is typically used to implement a scroll or zoom. The format is:
12151
12152 (mouse-wheel POSITION DELTA)
12153
12154 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
12155 same format as a mouse-click event, and DELTA is a signed number
12156 indicating the number of increments by which the wheel was rotated. A
12157 negative DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated backwards, towards
12158 the user, and a positive DELTA indicates that the wheel was rotated
12159 forward, away from the user.
12160
12161 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
12162
12163 *** The new event type `drag-n-drop' is generated when a group of
12164 files is selected in an application outside of Emacs, and then dragged
12165 and dropped onto an Emacs frame. The event contains a list of
12166 filenames that were dragged and dropped, which are then typically
12167 loaded into Emacs. The format is:
12168
12169 (drag-n-drop POSITION FILES)
12170
12171 where POSITION is a list describing the position of the event in the
12172 same format as a mouse-click event, and FILES is the list of filenames
12173 that were dragged and dropped.
12174
12175 As of now, this event type is generated only on MS Windows.
12176
12177 ** Changes relating to multibyte characters.
12178
12179 *** The variable enable-multibyte-characters is now read-only;
12180 any attempt to set it directly signals an error. The only way
12181 to change this value in an existing buffer is with set-buffer-multibyte.
12182
12183 *** In a string constant, `\ ' now stands for "nothing at all". You
12184 can use it to terminate a hex escape which is followed by a character
12185 that could otherwise be read as part of the hex escape.
12186
12187 *** String indices are now measured in characters, as they were
12188 in Emacs 19 and before.
12189
12190 The function chars-in-string has been deleted.
12191 The function concat-chars has been renamed to `string'.
12192
12193 *** The function set-buffer-multibyte sets the flag in the current
12194 buffer that says whether the buffer uses multibyte representation or
12195 unibyte representation. If the argument is nil, it selects unibyte
12196 representation. Otherwise it selects multibyte representation.
12197
12198 This function does not change the contents of the buffer, viewed
12199 as a sequence of bytes. However, it does change the contents
12200 viewed as characters; a sequence of two bytes which is treated as
12201 one character when the buffer uses multibyte representation
12202 will count as two characters using unibyte representation.
12203
12204 This function sets enable-multibyte-characters to record which
12205 representation is in use. It also adjusts various data in the buffer
12206 (including its markers, overlays and text properties) so that they are
12207 consistent with the new representation.
12208
12209 *** string-make-multibyte takes a string and converts it to multibyte
12210 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care
12211 about the representation, because Emacs converts when necessary;
12212 however, it makes a difference when you compare strings.
12213
12214 The conversion of non-ASCII characters works by adding the value of
12215 nonascii-insert-offset to each character, or by translating them
12216 using the table nonascii-translation-table.
12217
12218 *** string-make-unibyte takes a string and converts it to unibyte
12219 representation. Most of the time, you don't need to care about the
12220 representation, but it makes a difference when you compare strings.
12221
12222 The conversion from multibyte to unibyte representation
12223 loses information; the only time Emacs performs it automatically
12224 is when inserting a multibyte string into a unibyte buffer.
12225
12226 *** string-as-multibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12227 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as multibyte.
12228
12229 *** string-as-unibyte takes a string, and returns another string
12230 which contains the same bytes, but treats them as unibyte.
12231
12232 *** The new function compare-strings lets you compare
12233 portions of two strings. Unibyte strings are converted to multibyte,
12234 so that a unibyte string can match a multibyte string.
12235 You can specify whether to ignore case or not.
12236
12237 *** assoc-ignore-case now uses compare-strings so that
12238 it can treat unibyte and multibyte strings as equal.
12239
12240 *** Regular expression operations and buffer string searches now
12241 convert the search pattern to multibyte or unibyte to accord with the
12242 buffer or string being searched.
12243
12244 One consequence is that you cannot always use \200-\377 inside of
12245 [...] to match all non-ASCII characters. This does still work when
12246 searching or matching a unibyte buffer or string, but not when
12247 searching or matching a multibyte string. Unfortunately, there is no
12248 obvious choice of syntax to use within [...] for that job. But, what
12249 you want is just to match all non-ASCII characters, the regular
12250 expression [^\0-\177] works for it.
12251
12252 *** Structure of coding system changed.
12253
12254 All coding systems (including aliases and subsidiaries) are named
12255 by symbols; the symbol's `coding-system' property is a vector
12256 which defines the coding system. Aliases share the same vector
12257 as the principal name, so that altering the contents of this
12258 vector affects the principal name and its aliases. You can define
12259 your own alias name of a coding system by the function
12260 define-coding-system-alias.
12261
12262 The coding system definition includes a property list of its own. Use
12263 the new functions `coding-system-get' and `coding-system-put' to
12264 access such coding system properties as post-read-conversion,
12265 pre-write-conversion, character-translation-table-for-decode,
12266 character-translation-table-for-encode, mime-charset, and
12267 safe-charsets. For instance, (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1
12268 'mime-charset) gives the corresponding MIME-charset parameter
12269 `iso-8859-1'.
12270
12271 Among the coding system properties listed above, safe-charsets is new.
12272 The value of this property is a list of character sets which this
12273 coding system can correctly encode and decode. For instance:
12274 (coding-system-get 'iso-latin-1 'safe-charsets) => (ascii latin-iso8859-1)
12275
12276 Here, "correctly encode" means that the encoded character sets can
12277 also be handled safely by systems other than Emacs as far as they
12278 are capable of that coding system. Though, Emacs itself can encode
12279 the other character sets and read it back correctly.
12280
12281 *** The new function select-safe-coding-system can be used to find a
12282 proper coding system for encoding the specified region or string.
12283 This function requires a user interaction.
12284
12285 *** The new functions find-coding-systems-region and
12286 find-coding-systems-string are helper functions used by
12287 select-safe-coding-system. They return a list of all proper coding
12288 systems to encode a text in some region or string. If you don't want
12289 a user interaction, use one of these functions instead of
12290 select-safe-coding-system.
12291
12292 *** The explicit encoding and decoding functions, such as
12293 decode-coding-region and encode-coding-string, now set
12294 last-coding-system-used to reflect the actual way encoding or decoding
12295 was done.
12296
12297 *** The new function detect-coding-with-language-environment can be
12298 used to detect a coding system of text according to priorities of
12299 coding systems used by some specific language environment.
12300
12301 *** The functions detect-coding-region and detect-coding-string always
12302 return a list if the arg HIGHEST is nil. Thus, if only ASCII
12303 characters are found, they now return a list of single element
12304 `undecided' or its subsidiaries.
12305
12306 *** The new functions coding-system-change-eol-conversion and
12307 coding-system-change-text-conversion can be used to get a different
12308 coding system than what specified only in how end-of-line or text is
12309 converted.
12310
12311 *** The new function set-selection-coding-system can be used to set a
12312 coding system for communicating with other X clients.
12313
12314 *** The function `map-char-table' now passes as argument only valid
12315 character codes, plus generic characters that stand for entire
12316 character sets or entire subrows of a character set. In other words,
12317 each time `map-char-table' calls its FUNCTION argument, the key value
12318 either will be a valid individual character code, or will stand for a
12319 range of characters.
12320
12321 *** The new function `char-valid-p' can be used for checking whether a
12322 Lisp object is a valid character code or not.
12323
12324 *** The new function `charset-after' returns a charset of a character
12325 in the current buffer at position POS.
12326
12327 *** Input methods are now implemented using the variable
12328 input-method-function. If this is non-nil, its value should be a
12329 function; then, whenever Emacs reads an input event that is a printing
12330 character with no modifier bits, it calls that function, passing the
12331 event as an argument. Often this function will read more input, first
12332 binding input-method-function to nil.
12333
12334 The return value should be a list of the events resulting from input
12335 method processing. These events will be processed sequentially as
12336 input, before resorting to unread-command-events. Events returned by
12337 the input method function are not passed to the input method function,
12338 not even if they are printing characters with no modifier bits.
12339
12340 The input method function is not called when reading the second and
12341 subsequent events of a key sequence.
12342
12343 *** You can customize any language environment by using
12344 set-language-environment-hook and exit-language-environment-hook.
12345
12346 The hook `exit-language-environment-hook' should be used to undo
12347 customizations that you made with set-language-environment-hook. For
12348 instance, if you set up a special key binding for a specific language
12349 environment by set-language-environment-hook, you should set up
12350 exit-language-environment-hook to restore the normal key binding.
12351
12352 * Changes in Emacs 20.1
12353
12354 ** Emacs has a new facility for customization of its many user
12355 options. It is called M-x customize. With this facility you can look
12356 at the many user options in an organized way; they are grouped into a
12357 tree structure.
12358
12359 M-x customize also knows what sorts of values are legitimate for each
12360 user option and ensures that you don't use invalid values.
12361
12362 With M-x customize, you can set options either for the present Emacs
12363 session or permanently. (Permanent settings are stored automatically
12364 in your .emacs file.)
12365
12366 ** Scroll bars are now on the left side of the window.
12367 You can change this with M-x customize-option scroll-bar-mode.
12368
12369 ** The mode line no longer includes the string `Emacs'.
12370 This makes more space in the mode line for other information.
12371
12372 ** When you select a region with the mouse, it is highlighted
12373 immediately afterward. At that time, if you type the DELETE key, it
12374 kills the region.
12375
12376 The BACKSPACE key, and the ASCII character DEL, do not do this; they
12377 delete the character before point, as usual.
12378
12379 ** In an incremental search the whole current match is highlighted
12380 on terminals which support this. (You can disable this feature
12381 by setting search-highlight to nil.)
12382
12383 ** In the minibuffer, in some cases, you can now use M-n to
12384 insert the default value into the minibuffer as text. In effect,
12385 the default value (if the minibuffer routines know it) is tacked
12386 onto the history "in the future". (The more normal use of the
12387 history list is to use M-p to insert minibuffer input used in the
12388 past.)
12389
12390 ** In Text mode, now only blank lines separate paragraphs.
12391 This makes it possible to get the full benefit of Adaptive Fill mode
12392 in Text mode, and other modes derived from it (such as Mail mode).
12393 TAB in Text mode now runs the command indent-relative; this
12394 makes a practical difference only when you use indented paragraphs.
12395
12396 As a result, the old Indented Text mode is now identical to Text mode,
12397 and is an alias for it.
12398
12399 If you want spaces at the beginning of a line to start a paragraph,
12400 use the new mode, Paragraph Indent Text mode.
12401
12402 ** Scrolling changes
12403
12404 *** Scroll commands to scroll a whole screen now preserve the screen
12405 position of the cursor, if scroll-preserve-screen-position is non-nil.
12406
12407 In this mode, if you scroll several screens back and forth, finishing
12408 on the same screen where you started, the cursor goes back to the line
12409 where it started.
12410
12411 *** If you set scroll-conservatively to a small number, then when you
12412 move point a short distance off the screen, Emacs will scroll the
12413 screen just far enough to bring point back on screen, provided that
12414 does not exceed `scroll-conservatively' lines.
12415
12416 *** The new variable scroll-margin says how close point can come to the
12417 top or bottom of a window. It is a number of screen lines; if point
12418 comes within that many lines of the top or bottom of the window, Emacs
12419 recenters the window.
12420
12421 ** International character set support (MULE)
12422
12423 Emacs now supports a wide variety of international character sets,
12424 including European variants of the Latin alphabet, as well as Chinese,
12425 Devanagari (Hindi and Marathi), Ethiopian, Greek, IPA, Japanese,
12426 Korean, Lao, Russian, Thai, Tibetan, and Vietnamese scripts. These
12427 features have been merged from the modified version of Emacs known as
12428 MULE (for "MULti-lingual Enhancement to GNU Emacs")
12429
12430 Users of these scripts have established many more-or-less standard
12431 coding systems for storing files. Emacs uses a single multibyte
12432 character encoding within Emacs buffers; it can translate from a wide
12433 variety of coding systems when reading a file and can translate back
12434 into any of these coding systems when saving a file.
12435
12436 Keyboards, even in the countries where these character sets are used,
12437 generally don't have keys for all the characters in them. So Emacs
12438 supports various "input methods", typically one for each script or
12439 language, to make it possible to type them.
12440
12441 The Emacs internal multibyte encoding represents a non-ASCII
12442 character as a sequence of bytes in the range 0200 through 0377.
12443
12444 The new prefix key C-x RET is used for commands that pertain
12445 to multibyte characters, coding systems, and input methods.
12446
12447 You can disable multibyte character support as follows:
12448
12449 (setq-default enable-multibyte-characters nil)
12450
12451 Calling the function standard-display-european turns off multibyte
12452 characters, unless you specify a non-nil value for the second
12453 argument, AUTO. This provides compatibility for people who are
12454 already using standard-display-european to continue using unibyte
12455 characters for their work until they want to change.
12456
12457 *** Input methods
12458
12459 An input method is a kind of character conversion which is designed
12460 specifically for interactive input. In Emacs, typically each language
12461 has its own input method (though sometimes several languages which use
12462 the same characters can share one input method). Some languages
12463 support several input methods.
12464
12465 The simplest kind of input method works by mapping ASCII letters into
12466 another alphabet. This is how the Greek and Russian input methods
12467 work.
12468
12469 A more powerful technique is composition: converting sequences of
12470 characters into one letter. Many European input methods use
12471 composition to produce a single non-ASCII letter from a sequence which
12472 consists of a letter followed by diacritics. For example, a' is one
12473 sequence of two characters that might be converted into a single
12474 letter.
12475
12476 The input methods for syllabic scripts typically use mapping followed
12477 by conversion. The input methods for Thai and Korean work this way.
12478 First, letters are mapped into symbols for particular sounds or tone
12479 marks; then, sequences of these which make up a whole syllable are
12480 mapped into one syllable sign--most often a "composite character".
12481
12482 None of these methods works very well for Chinese and Japanese, so
12483 they are handled specially. First you input a whole word using
12484 phonetic spelling; then, after the word is in the buffer, Emacs
12485 converts it into one or more characters using a large dictionary.
12486
12487 Since there is more than one way to represent a phonetically spelled
12488 word using Chinese characters, Emacs can only guess which one to use;
12489 typically these input methods give you a way to say "guess again" if
12490 the first guess is wrong.
12491
12492 *** The command C-x RET m (toggle-enable-multibyte-characters)
12493 turns multibyte character support on or off for the current buffer.
12494
12495 If multibyte character support is turned off in a buffer, then each
12496 byte is a single character, even codes 0200 through 0377--exactly as
12497 they did in Emacs 19.34. This includes the features for support for
12498 the European characters, ISO Latin-1 and ISO Latin-2.
12499
12500 However, there is no need to turn off multibyte character support to
12501 use ISO Latin-1 or ISO Latin-2; the Emacs multibyte character set
12502 includes all the characters in these character sets, and Emacs can
12503 translate automatically to and from either one.
12504
12505 *** Visiting a file in unibyte mode.
12506
12507 Turning off multibyte character support in the buffer after visiting a
12508 file with multibyte code conversion will display the multibyte
12509 sequences already in the buffer, byte by byte. This is probably not
12510 what you want.
12511
12512 If you want to edit a file of unibyte characters (Latin-1, for
12513 example), you can do it by specifying `no-conversion' as the coding
12514 system when reading the file. This coding system also turns off
12515 multibyte characters in that buffer.
12516
12517 If you turn off multibyte character support entirely, this turns off
12518 character conversion as well.
12519
12520 *** Displaying international characters on X Windows.
12521
12522 A font for X typically displays just one alphabet or script.
12523 Therefore, displaying the entire range of characters Emacs supports
12524 requires using many fonts.
12525
12526 Therefore, Emacs now supports "fontsets". Each fontset is a
12527 collection of fonts, each assigned to a range of character codes.
12528
12529 A fontset has a name, like a font. Individual fonts are defined by
12530 the X server; fontsets are defined within Emacs itself. But once you
12531 have defined a fontset, you can use it in a face or a frame just as
12532 you would use a font.
12533
12534 If a fontset specifies no font for a certain character, or if it
12535 specifies a font that does not exist on your system, then it cannot
12536 display that character. It will display an empty box instead.
12537
12538 The fontset height and width are determined by the ASCII characters
12539 (that is, by the font in the fontset which is used for ASCII
12540 characters).
12541
12542 *** Defining fontsets.
12543
12544 Emacs does not use any fontset by default. Its default font is still
12545 chosen as in previous versions. You can tell Emacs to use a fontset
12546 with the `-fn' option or the `Font' X resource.
12547
12548 Emacs creates a standard fontset automatically according to the value
12549 of standard-fontset-spec. This fontset's short name is
12550 `fontset-standard'. Bold, italic, and bold-italic variants of the
12551 standard fontset are created automatically.
12552
12553 If you specify a default ASCII font with the `Font' resource or `-fn'
12554 argument, a fontset is generated from it. This works by replacing the
12555 FOUNDARY, FAMILY, ADD_STYLE, and AVERAGE_WIDTH fields of the font name
12556 with `*' then using this to specify a fontset. This fontset's short
12557 name is `fontset-startup'.
12558
12559 Emacs checks resources of the form Fontset-N where N is 0, 1, 2...
12560 The resource value should have this form:
12561 FONTSET-NAME, [CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME]...
12562 FONTSET-NAME should have the form of a standard X font name, except:
12563 * most fields should be just the wild card "*".
12564 * the CHARSET_REGISTRY field should be "fontset"
12565 * the CHARSET_ENCODING field can be any nickname of the fontset.
12566 The construct CHARSET-NAME:FONT-NAME can be repeated any number
12567 of times; each time specifies the font for one character set.
12568 CHARSET-NAME should be the name of a character set, and FONT-NAME
12569 should specify an actual font to use for that character set.
12570
12571 Each of these fontsets has an alias which is made from the
12572 last two font name fields, CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING.
12573 You can refer to the fontset by that alias or by its full name.
12574
12575 For any character sets that you don't mention, Emacs tries to choose a
12576 font by substituting into FONTSET-NAME. For instance, with the
12577 following resource,
12578 Emacs*Fontset-0: -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-*-*-*-*-fontset-24
12579 the font for ASCII is generated as below:
12580 -*-fixed-medium-r-normal-*-24-*-ISO8859-1
12581 Here is the substitution rule:
12582 Change CHARSET_REGISTRY and CHARSET_ENCODING to that of the charset
12583 defined in the variable x-charset-registries. For instance, ASCII has
12584 the entry (ascii . "ISO8859-1") in this variable. Then, reduce
12585 sequences of wild cards -*-...-*- with a single wildcard -*-.
12586 (This is to prevent use of auto-scaled fonts.)
12587
12588 The function which processes the fontset resource value to create the
12589 fontset is called create-fontset-from-fontset-spec. You can also call
12590 that function explicitly to create a fontset.
12591
12592 With the X resource Emacs.Font, you can specify a fontset name just
12593 like an actual font name. But be careful not to specify a fontset
12594 name in a wildcard resource like Emacs*Font--that tries to specify the
12595 fontset for other purposes including menus, and they cannot handle
12596 fontsets.
12597
12598 *** The command M-x set-language-environment sets certain global Emacs
12599 defaults for a particular choice of language.
12600
12601 Selecting a language environment typically specifies a default input
12602 method and which coding systems to recognize automatically when
12603 visiting files. However, it does not try to reread files you have
12604 already visited; the text in those buffers is not affected. The
12605 language environment may also specify a default choice of coding
12606 system for new files that you create.
12607
12608 It makes no difference which buffer is current when you use
12609 set-language-environment, because these defaults apply globally to the
12610 whole Emacs session.
12611
12612 For example, M-x set-language-environment RET Latin-1 RET
12613 chooses the Latin-1 character set. In the .emacs file, you can do this
12614 with (set-language-environment "Latin-1").
12615
12616 *** The command C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system)
12617 specifies the file coding system for the current buffer. This
12618 specifies what sort of character code translation to do when saving
12619 the file. As an argument, you must specify the name of one of the
12620 coding systems that Emacs supports.
12621
12622 *** The command C-x RET c (universal-coding-system-argument)
12623 lets you specify a coding system when you read or write a file.
12624 This command uses the minibuffer to read a coding system name.
12625 After you exit the minibuffer, the specified coding system
12626 is used for *the immediately following command*.
12627
12628 So if the immediately following command is a command to read or
12629 write a file, it uses the specified coding system for that file.
12630
12631 If the immediately following command does not use the coding system,
12632 then C-x RET c ultimately has no effect.
12633
12634 For example, C-x RET c iso-8859-1 RET C-x C-f temp RET
12635 visits the file `temp' treating it as ISO Latin-1.
12636
12637 *** You can specify the coding system for a file using the -*-
12638 construct. Include `coding: CODINGSYSTEM;' inside the -*-...-*-
12639 to specify use of coding system CODINGSYSTEM. You can also
12640 specify the coding system in a local variable list at the end
12641 of the file.
12642
12643 *** The command C-x RET t (set-terminal-coding-system) specifies
12644 the coding system for terminal output. If you specify a character
12645 code for terminal output, all characters output to the terminal are
12646 translated into that character code.
12647
12648 This feature is useful for certain character-only terminals built in
12649 various countries to support the languages of those countries.
12650
12651 By default, output to the terminal is not translated at all.
12652
12653 *** The command C-x RET k (set-keyboard-coding-system) specifies
12654 the coding system for keyboard input.
12655
12656 Character code translation of keyboard input is useful for terminals
12657 with keys that send non-ASCII graphic characters--for example,
12658 some terminals designed for ISO Latin-1 or subsets of it.
12659
12660 By default, keyboard input is not translated at all.
12661
12662 Character code translation of keyboard input is similar to using an
12663 input method, in that both define sequences of keyboard input that
12664 translate into single characters. However, input methods are designed
12665 to be convenient for interactive use, while the code translations are
12666 designed to work with terminals.
12667
12668 *** The command C-x RET p (set-buffer-process-coding-system)
12669 specifies the coding system for input and output to a subprocess.
12670 This command applies to the current buffer; normally, each subprocess
12671 has its own buffer, and thus you can use this command to specify
12672 translation to and from a particular subprocess by giving the command
12673 in the corresponding buffer.
12674
12675 By default, process input and output are not translated at all.
12676
12677 *** The variable file-name-coding-system specifies the coding system
12678 to use for encoding file names before operating on them.
12679 It is also used for decoding file names obtained from the system.
12680
12681 *** The command C-\ (toggle-input-method) activates or deactivates
12682 an input method. If no input method has been selected before, the
12683 command prompts for you to specify the language and input method you
12684 want to use.
12685
12686 C-u C-\ (select-input-method) lets you switch to a different input
12687 method. C-h C-\ (or C-h I) describes the current input method.
12688
12689 *** Some input methods remap the keyboard to emulate various keyboard
12690 layouts commonly used for particular scripts. How to do this
12691 remapping properly depends on your actual keyboard layout. To specify
12692 which layout your keyboard has, use M-x quail-set-keyboard-layout.
12693
12694 *** The command C-h C (describe-coding-system) displays
12695 the coding systems currently selected for various purposes, plus
12696 related information.
12697
12698 *** The command C-h h (view-hello-file) displays a file called
12699 HELLO, which has examples of text in many languages, using various
12700 scripts.
12701
12702 *** The command C-h L (describe-language-support) displays
12703 information about the support for a particular language.
12704 You specify the language as an argument.
12705
12706 *** The mode line now contains a letter or character that identifies
12707 the coding system used in the visited file. It normally follows the
12708 first dash.
12709
12710 A dash indicates the default state of affairs: no code conversion
12711 (except CRLF => newline if appropriate). `=' means no conversion
12712 whatsoever. The ISO 8859 coding systems are represented by digits
12713 1 through 9. Other coding systems are represented by letters:
12714
12715 A alternativnyj (Russian)
12716 B big5 (Chinese)
12717 C cn-gb-2312 (Chinese)
12718 C iso-2022-cn (Chinese)
12719 D in-is13194-devanagari (Indian languages)
12720 E euc-japan (Japanese)
12721 I iso-2022-cjk or iso-2022-ss2 (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12722 J junet (iso-2022-7) or old-jis (iso-2022-jp-1978-irv) (Japanese)
12723 K euc-korea (Korean)
12724 R koi8 (Russian)
12725 Q tibetan
12726 S shift_jis (Japanese)
12727 T lao
12728 T tis620 (Thai)
12729 V viscii or vscii (Vietnamese)
12730 i iso-2022-lock (Chinese, Japanese, Korean)
12731 k iso-2022-kr (Korean)
12732 v viqr (Vietnamese)
12733 z hz (Chinese)
12734
12735 When you are using a character-only terminal (not a window system),
12736 two additional characters appear in between the dash and the file
12737 coding system. These two characters describe the coding system for
12738 keyboard input, and the coding system for terminal output.
12739
12740 *** The new variable rmail-file-coding-system specifies the code
12741 conversion to use for RMAIL files. The default value is nil.
12742
12743 When you read mail with Rmail, each message is decoded automatically
12744 into Emacs' internal format. This has nothing to do with
12745 rmail-file-coding-system. That variable controls reading and writing
12746 Rmail files themselves.
12747
12748 *** The new variable sendmail-coding-system specifies the code
12749 conversion for outgoing mail. The default value is nil.
12750
12751 Actually, there are three different ways of specifying the coding system
12752 for sending mail:
12753
12754 - If you use C-x RET f in the mail buffer, that takes priority.
12755 - Otherwise, if you set sendmail-coding-system non-nil, that specifies it.
12756 - Otherwise, the default coding system for new files is used,
12757 if that is non-nil. That comes from your language environment.
12758 - Otherwise, Latin-1 is used.
12759
12760 *** The command C-h t (help-with-tutorial) accepts a prefix argument
12761 to specify the language for the tutorial file. Currently, English,
12762 Japanese, Korean and Thai are supported. We welcome additional
12763 translations.
12764
12765 ** An easy new way to visit a file with no code or format conversion
12766 of any kind: Use M-x find-file-literally. There is also a command
12767 insert-file-literally which inserts a file into the current buffer
12768 without any conversion.
12769
12770 ** C-q's handling of octal character codes is changed.
12771 You can now specify any number of octal digits.
12772 RET terminates the digits and is discarded;
12773 any other non-digit terminates the digits and is then used as input.
12774
12775 ** There are new commands for looking up Info documentation for
12776 functions, variables and file names used in your programs.
12777
12778 Type M-x info-lookup-symbol to look up a symbol in the buffer at point.
12779 Type M-x info-lookup-file to look up a file in the buffer at point.
12780
12781 Precisely which Info files are used to look it up depends on the major
12782 mode. For example, in C mode, the GNU libc manual is used.
12783
12784 ** M-TAB in most programming language modes now runs the command
12785 complete-symbol. This command performs completion on the symbol name
12786 in the buffer before point.
12787
12788 With a numeric argument, it performs completion based on the set of
12789 symbols documented in the Info files for the programming language that
12790 you are using.
12791
12792 With no argument, it does completion based on the current tags tables,
12793 just like the old binding of M-TAB (complete-tag).
12794
12795 ** File locking works with NFS now.
12796
12797 The lock file for FILENAME is now a symbolic link named .#FILENAME,
12798 in the same directory as FILENAME.
12799
12800 This means that collision detection between two different machines now
12801 works reasonably well; it also means that no file server or directory
12802 can become a bottleneck.
12803
12804 The new method does have drawbacks. It means that collision detection
12805 does not operate when you edit a file in a directory where you cannot
12806 create new files. Collision detection also doesn't operate when the
12807 file server does not support symbolic links. But these conditions are
12808 rare, and the ability to have collision detection while using NFS is
12809 so useful that the change is worth while.
12810
12811 When Emacs or a system crashes, this may leave behind lock files which
12812 are stale. So you may occasionally get warnings about spurious
12813 collisions. When you determine that the collision is spurious, just
12814 tell Emacs to go ahead anyway.
12815
12816 ** If you wish to use Show Paren mode to display matching parentheses,
12817 it is no longer sufficient to load paren.el. Instead you must call
12818 show-paren-mode.
12819
12820 ** If you wish to use Delete Selection mode to replace a highlighted
12821 selection when you insert new text, it is no longer sufficient to load
12822 delsel.el. Instead you must call the function delete-selection-mode.
12823
12824 ** If you wish to use Partial Completion mode to complete partial words
12825 within symbols or filenames, it is no longer sufficient to load
12826 complete.el. Instead you must call the function partial-completion-mode.
12827
12828 ** If you wish to use uniquify to rename buffers for you,
12829 it is no longer sufficient to load uniquify.el. You must also
12830 set uniquify-buffer-name-style to one of the non-nil legitimate values.
12831
12832 ** Changes in View mode.
12833
12834 *** Several new commands are available in View mode.
12835 Do H in view mode for a list of commands.
12836
12837 *** There are two new commands for entering View mode:
12838 view-file-other-frame and view-buffer-other-frame.
12839
12840 *** Exiting View mode does a better job of restoring windows to their
12841 previous state.
12842
12843 *** New customization variable view-scroll-auto-exit. If non-nil,
12844 scrolling past end of buffer makes view mode exit.
12845
12846 *** New customization variable view-exits-all-viewing-windows. If
12847 non-nil, view-mode will at exit restore all windows viewing buffer,
12848 not just the selected window.
12849
12850 *** New customization variable view-read-only. If non-nil, visiting a
12851 read-only file automatically enters View mode, and toggle-read-only
12852 turns View mode on or off.
12853
12854 *** New customization variable view-remove-frame-by-deleting controls
12855 how to remove a not needed frame at view mode exit. If non-nil,
12856 delete the frame, if nil make an icon of it.
12857
12858 ** C-x v l, the command to print a file's version control log,
12859 now positions point at the entry for the file's current branch version.
12860
12861 ** C-x v =, the command to compare a file with the last checked-in version,
12862 has a new feature. If the file is currently not locked, so that it is
12863 presumably identical to the last checked-in version, the command now asks
12864 which version to compare with.
12865
12866 ** When using hideshow.el, incremental search can temporarily show hidden
12867 blocks if a match is inside the block.
12868
12869 The block is hidden again if the search is continued and the next match
12870 is outside the block. By customizing the variable
12871 isearch-hide-immediately you can choose to hide all the temporarily
12872 shown blocks only when exiting from incremental search.
12873
12874 By customizing the variable hs-isearch-open you can choose what kind
12875 of blocks to temporarily show during isearch: comment blocks, code
12876 blocks, all of them or none.
12877
12878 ** The new command C-x 4 0 (kill-buffer-and-window) kills the
12879 current buffer and deletes the selected window. It asks for
12880 confirmation first.
12881
12882 ** C-x C-w, which saves the buffer into a specified file name,
12883 now changes the major mode according to that file name.
12884 However, the mode will not be changed if
12885 (1) a local variables list or the `-*-' line specifies a major mode, or
12886 (2) the current major mode is a "special" mode,
12887 not suitable for ordinary files, or
12888 (3) the new file name does not particularly specify any mode.
12889
12890 This applies to M-x set-visited-file-name as well.
12891
12892 However, if you set change-major-mode-with-file-name to nil, then
12893 these commands do not change the major mode.
12894
12895 ** M-x occur changes.
12896
12897 *** If the argument to M-x occur contains upper case letters,
12898 it performs a case-sensitive search.
12899
12900 *** In the *Occur* buffer made by M-x occur,
12901 if you type g or M-x revert-buffer, this repeats the search
12902 using the same regular expression and the same buffer as before.
12903
12904 ** In Transient Mark mode, the region in any one buffer is highlighted
12905 in just one window at a time. At first, it is highlighted in the
12906 window where you set the mark. The buffer's highlighting remains in
12907 that window unless you select to another window which shows the same
12908 buffer--then the highlighting moves to that window.
12909
12910 ** The feature to suggest key bindings when you use M-x now operates
12911 after the command finishes. The message suggesting key bindings
12912 appears temporarily in the echo area. The previous echo area contents
12913 come back after a few seconds, in case they contain useful information.
12914
12915 ** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
12916 selected buffers, so that the default for C-x b is now based on the
12917 buffers recently selected in the selected frame.
12918
12919 ** Outline mode changes.
12920
12921 *** Outline mode now uses overlays (this is the former noutline.el).
12922
12923 *** Incremental searches skip over invisible text in Outline mode.
12924
12925 ** When a minibuffer window is active but not the selected window, if
12926 you try to use the minibuffer, you used to get a nested minibuffer.
12927 Now, this not only gives an error, it also cancels the minibuffer that
12928 was already active.
12929
12930 The motive for this change is so that beginning users do not
12931 unknowingly move away from minibuffers, leaving them active, and then
12932 get confused by it.
12933
12934 If you want to be able to have recursive minibuffers, you must
12935 set enable-recursive-minibuffers to non-nil.
12936
12937 ** Changes in dynamic abbrevs.
12938
12939 *** Expanding dynamic abbrevs with M-/ is now smarter about case
12940 conversion. If the expansion has mixed case not counting the first
12941 character, and the abbreviation matches the beginning of the expansion
12942 including case, then the expansion is copied verbatim.
12943
12944 The expansion is also copied verbatim if the abbreviation itself has
12945 mixed case. And using SPC M-/ to copy an additional word always
12946 copies it verbatim except when the previous copied word is all caps.
12947
12948 *** The values of `dabbrev-case-replace' and `dabbrev-case-fold-search'
12949 are no longer Lisp expressions. They have simply three possible
12950 values.
12951
12952 `dabbrev-case-replace' has these three values: nil (don't preserve
12953 case), t (do), or `case-replace' (do like M-x query-replace).
12954 `dabbrev-case-fold-search' has these three values: nil (don't ignore
12955 case), t (do), or `case-fold-search' (do like search).
12956
12957 ** Minibuffer history lists are truncated automatically now to a
12958 certain length. The variable history-length specifies how long they
12959 can be. The default value is 30.
12960
12961 ** Changes in Mail mode.
12962
12963 *** The key C-x m no longer runs the `mail' command directly.
12964 Instead, it runs the command `compose-mail', which invokes the mail
12965 composition mechanism you have selected with the variable
12966 `mail-user-agent'. The default choice of user agent is
12967 `sendmail-user-agent', which gives behavior compatible with the old
12968 behavior.
12969
12970 C-x 4 m now runs compose-mail-other-window, and C-x 5 m runs
12971 compose-mail-other-frame.
12972
12973 *** While composing a reply to a mail message, from Rmail, you can use
12974 the command C-c C-r to cite just the region from the message you are
12975 replying to. This copies the text which is the selected region in the
12976 buffer that shows the original message.
12977
12978 *** The command C-c C-i inserts a file at the end of the message,
12979 with separator lines around the contents.
12980
12981 *** The command M-x expand-mail-aliases expands all mail aliases
12982 in suitable mail headers. Emacs automatically extracts mail alias
12983 definitions from your mail alias file (e.g., ~/.mailrc). You do not
12984 need to expand mail aliases yourself before sending mail.
12985
12986 *** New features in the mail-complete command.
12987
12988 **** The mail-complete command now inserts the user's full name,
12989 for local users or if that is known. The variable mail-complete-style
12990 controls the style to use, and whether to do this at all.
12991 Its values are like those of mail-from-style.
12992
12993 **** The variable mail-passwd-command lets you specify a shell command
12994 to run to fetch a set of password-entries that add to the ones in
12995 /etc/passwd.
12996
12997 **** The variable mail-passwd-file now specifies a list of files to read
12998 to get the list of user ids. By default, one file is used:
12999 /etc/passwd.
13000
13001 ** You can "quote" a file name to inhibit special significance of
13002 special syntax, by adding `/:' to the beginning. Thus, if you have a
13003 directory named `/foo:', you can prevent it from being treated as a
13004 reference to a remote host named `foo' by writing it as `/:/foo:'.
13005
13006 Emacs uses this new construct automatically when necessary, such as
13007 when you start it with a working directory whose name might otherwise
13008 be taken to be magic.
13009
13010 ** There is a new command M-x grep-find which uses find to select
13011 files to search through, and grep to scan them. The output is
13012 available in a Compile mode buffer, as with M-x grep.
13013
13014 M-x grep now uses the -e option if the grep program supports that.
13015 (-e prevents problems if the search pattern starts with a dash.)
13016
13017 ** In Dired, the & command now flags for deletion the files whose names
13018 suggest they are probably not needed in the long run.
13019
13020 In Dired, * is now a prefix key for mark-related commands.
13021
13022 new key dired.el binding old key
13023 ------- ---------------- -------
13024 * c dired-change-marks c
13025 * m dired-mark m
13026 * * dired-mark-executables * (binding deleted)
13027 * / dired-mark-directories / (binding deleted)
13028 * @ dired-mark-symlinks @ (binding deleted)
13029 * u dired-unmark u
13030 * DEL dired-unmark-backward DEL
13031 * ? dired-unmark-all-files C-M-?
13032 * ! dired-unmark-all-marks
13033 * % dired-mark-files-regexp % m
13034 * C-n dired-next-marked-file M-}
13035 * C-p dired-prev-marked-file M-{
13036
13037 ** Rmail changes.
13038
13039 *** When Rmail cannot convert your incoming mail into Babyl format, it
13040 saves the new mail in the file RMAILOSE.n, where n is an integer
13041 chosen to make a unique name. This way, Rmail will not keep crashing
13042 each time you run it.
13043
13044 *** In Rmail, the variable rmail-summary-line-count-flag now controls
13045 whether to include the line count in the summary. Non-nil means yes.
13046
13047 *** In Rmail summary buffers, d and C-d (the commands to delete
13048 messages) now take repeat counts as arguments. A negative argument
13049 means to move in the opposite direction.
13050
13051 *** In Rmail, the t command now takes an optional argument which lets
13052 you specify whether to show the message headers in full or pruned.
13053
13054 *** In Rmail, the new command w (rmail-output-body-to-file) writes
13055 just the body of the current message into a file, without the headers.
13056 It takes the file name from the message subject, by default, but you
13057 can edit that file name in the minibuffer before it is actually used
13058 for output.
13059
13060 ** Gnus changes.
13061
13062 *** nntp.el has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
13063
13064 *** Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
13065 Gnus.
13066
13067 *** Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like
13068 `and', `or', `not', and parent redirection.
13069
13070 *** Article washing status can be displayed in the
13071 article mode line.
13072
13073 *** gnus.el has been split into many smaller files.
13074
13075 *** Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID.
13076
13077 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
13078
13079 *** New variables for specifying what score and adapt files
13080 are to be considered home score and adapt files. See
13081 `gnus-home-score-file' and `gnus-home-adapt-files'.
13082
13083 *** Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics.
13084
13085 *** Article editing has been revamped and is now usable.
13086
13087 *** Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions.
13088 See `gnus-signature-separator' and `gnus-signature-limit'.
13089
13090 *** Summary pick mode has been made to look more nn-like.
13091 Line numbers are displayed and the `.' command can be
13092 used to pick articles.
13093
13094 *** Commands for moving the .newsrc.eld from one server to
13095 another have been added.
13096
13097 `M-x gnus-change-server'
13098
13099 *** A way to specify that "uninteresting" fields be suppressed when
13100 generating lines in buffers.
13101
13102 *** Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with
13103 `C-M-_'.
13104
13105 *** Scoring can be done on words using the new score type `w'.
13106
13107 *** Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis:
13108
13109 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
13110
13111 *** Scores can be decayed.
13112
13113 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
13114
13115 *** Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The
13116 Date is normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first.
13117
13118 *** A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
13119 the native server.
13120
13121 `M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups'
13122
13123 *** A new command for reading collections of documents
13124 (nndoc with nnvirtual on top) has been added -- `C-M-d'.
13125
13126 *** Process mark sets can be pushed and popped.
13127
13128 *** A new mail-to-news backend makes it possible to post
13129 even when the NNTP server doesn't allow posting.
13130
13131 *** A new backend for reading searches from Web search engines
13132 (DejaNews, Alta Vista, InReference) has been added.
13133
13134 Use the `G w' command in the group buffer to create such
13135 a group.
13136
13137 *** Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard
13138 sorting functions, and each topic can be sorted independently.
13139
13140 See the commands under the `T S' submap.
13141
13142 *** Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently.
13143
13144 See the commands under the `G P' submap.
13145
13146 *** Cached articles can be pulled into the groups.
13147
13148 Use the `Y c' command.
13149
13150 *** Score files are now applied in a more reliable order.
13151
13152 *** Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated.
13153
13154 `M-x nnmail-split-history'
13155
13156 *** More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk
13157 from incoming mail before saving the mail.
13158
13159 See `nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook'.
13160
13161 *** The nnml mail backend now understands compressed article files.
13162
13163 *** To enable Gnus to read/post multi-lingual articles, you must execute
13164 the following code, for instance, in your .emacs.
13165
13166 (add-hook 'gnus-startup-hook 'gnus-mule-initialize)
13167
13168 Then, when you start Gnus, it will decode non-ASCII text automatically
13169 and show appropriate characters. (Note: if you are using gnus-mime
13170 from the SEMI package, formerly known as TM, you should NOT add this
13171 hook to gnus-startup-hook; gnus-mime has its own method of handling
13172 this issue.)
13173
13174 Since it is impossible to distinguish all coding systems
13175 automatically, you may need to specify a choice of coding system for a
13176 particular news group. This can be done by:
13177
13178 (gnus-mule-add-group NEWSGROUP 'CODING-SYSTEM)
13179
13180 Here NEWSGROUP should be a string which names a newsgroup or a tree
13181 of newsgroups. If NEWSGROUP is "XXX.YYY", all news groups under
13182 "XXX.YYY" (including "XXX.YYY.ZZZ") will use the specified coding
13183 system. CODING-SYSTEM specifies which coding system to use (for both
13184 for reading and posting).
13185
13186 CODING-SYSTEM can also be a cons cell of the form
13187 (READ-CODING-SYSTEM . POST-CODING-SYSTEM)
13188 Then READ-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you read messages from the
13189 newsgroups, while POST-CODING-SYSTEM is used when you post messages
13190 there.
13191
13192 Emacs knows the right coding systems for certain newsgroups by
13193 default. Here are some of these default settings:
13194
13195 (gnus-mule-add-group "fj" 'iso-2022-7)
13196 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text" 'hz-gb-2312)
13197 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.hk" 'hz-gb-2312)
13198 (gnus-mule-add-group "alt.chinese.text.big5" 'cn-big5)
13199 (gnus-mule-add-group "soc.culture.vietnamese" '(nil . viqr))
13200
13201 When you reply by mail to an article, these settings are ignored;
13202 the mail is encoded according to sendmail-coding-system, as usual.
13203
13204 ** CC mode changes.
13205
13206 *** If you edit primarily one style of C (or C++, Objective-C, Java)
13207 code, you may want to make the CC Mode style variables have global
13208 values so that you can set them directly in your .emacs file. To do
13209 this, set c-style-variables-are-local-p to nil in your .emacs file.
13210 Note that this only takes effect if you do it *before* cc-mode.el is
13211 loaded.
13212
13213 If you typically edit more than one style of C (or C++, Objective-C,
13214 Java) code in a single Emacs session, you may want to make the CC Mode
13215 style variables have buffer local values. By default, all buffers
13216 share the same style variable settings; to make them buffer local, set
13217 c-style-variables-are-local-p to t in your .emacs file. Note that you
13218 must do this *before* CC Mode is loaded.
13219
13220 *** The new variable c-indentation-style holds the C style name
13221 of the current buffer.
13222
13223 *** The variable c-block-comments-indent-p has been deleted, because
13224 it is no longer necessary. C mode now handles all the supported styles
13225 of block comments, with no need to say which one you will use.
13226
13227 *** There is a new indentation style "python", which specifies the C
13228 style that the Python developers like.
13229
13230 *** There is a new c-cleanup-list option: brace-elseif-brace.
13231 This says to put ...} else if (...) {... on one line,
13232 just as brace-else-brace says to put ...} else {... on one line.
13233
13234 ** VC Changes [new]
13235
13236 *** In vc-retrieve-snapshot (C-x v r), if you don't specify a snapshot
13237 name, it retrieves the *latest* versions of all files in the current
13238 directory and its subdirectories (aside from files already locked).
13239
13240 This feature is useful if your RCS directory is a link to a common
13241 master directory, and you want to pick up changes made by other
13242 developers.
13243
13244 You can do the same thing for an individual file by typing C-u C-x C-q
13245 RET in a buffer visiting that file.
13246
13247 *** VC can now handle files under CVS that are being "watched" by
13248 other developers. Such files are made read-only by CVS. To get a
13249 writable copy, type C-x C-q in a buffer visiting such a file. VC then
13250 calls "cvs edit", which notifies the other developers of it.
13251
13252 *** vc-version-diff (C-u C-x v =) now suggests reasonable defaults for
13253 version numbers, based on the current state of the file.
13254
13255 ** Calendar changes.
13256
13257 *** A new function, list-holidays, allows you list holidays or
13258 subclasses of holidays for ranges of years. Related menu items allow
13259 you do this for the year of the selected date, or the
13260 following/previous years.
13261
13262 *** There is now support for the Baha'i calendar system. Use `pb' in
13263 the *Calendar* buffer to display the current Baha'i date. The Baha'i
13264 calendar, or "Badi calendar" is a system of 19 months with 19 days
13265 each, and 4 intercalary days (5 during a Gregorian leap year). The
13266 calendar begins May 23, 1844, with each of the months named after a
13267 supposed attribute of God.
13268
13269 ** ps-print changes
13270
13271 There are some new user variables and subgroups for customizing the page
13272 layout.
13273
13274 *** Headers & Footers (subgroup)
13275
13276 Some printer systems print a header page and force the first page to
13277 be printed on the back of the header page when using duplex. If your
13278 printer system has this behavior, set variable
13279 `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' to t.
13280
13281 If variable `ps-banner-page-when-duplexing' is non-nil, it prints a
13282 blank page as the very first printed page. So, it behaves as if the
13283 very first character of buffer (or region) were a form feed ^L (\014).
13284
13285 The variable `ps-spool-config' specifies who is responsible for
13286 setting duplex mode and page size. Valid values are:
13287
13288 lpr-switches duplex and page size are configured by `ps-lpr-switches'.
13289 Don't forget to set `ps-lpr-switches' to select duplex
13290 printing for your printer.
13291
13292 setpagedevice duplex and page size are configured by ps-print using the
13293 setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13294
13295 nil duplex and page size are configured by ps-print *not* using
13296 the setpagedevice PostScript operator.
13297
13298 The variable `ps-spool-tumble' specifies how the page images on
13299 opposite sides of a sheet are oriented with respect to each other. If
13300 `ps-spool-tumble' is nil, ps-print produces output suitable for
13301 bindings on the left or right. If `ps-spool-tumble' is non-nil,
13302 ps-print produces output suitable for bindings at the top or bottom.
13303 This variable takes effect only if `ps-spool-duplex' is non-nil.
13304 The default value is nil.
13305
13306 The variable `ps-header-frame-alist' specifies a header frame
13307 properties alist. Valid frame properties are:
13308
13309 fore-color Specify the foreground frame color.
13310 Value should be a float number between 0.0 (black
13311 color) and 1.0 (white color), or a string which is a
13312 color name, or a list of 3 float numbers which
13313 correspond to the Red Green Blue color scale, each
13314 float number between 0.0 (dark color) and 1.0 (bright
13315 color). The default is 0 ("black").
13316
13317 back-color Specify the background frame color (similar to fore-color).
13318 The default is 0.9 ("gray90").
13319
13320 shadow-color Specify the shadow color (similar to fore-color).
13321 The default is 0 ("black").
13322
13323 border-color Specify the border color (similar to fore-color).
13324 The default is 0 ("black").
13325
13326 border-width Specify the border width.
13327 The default is 0.4.
13328
13329 Any other property is ignored.
13330
13331 Don't change this alist directly; instead use Custom, or the
13332 `ps-value', `ps-get', `ps-put' and `ps-del' functions (see there for
13333 documentation).
13334
13335 Ps-print can also print footers. The footer variables are:
13336 `ps-print-footer', `ps-footer-offset', `ps-print-footer-frame',
13337 `ps-footer-font-family', `ps-footer-font-size', `ps-footer-line-pad',
13338 `ps-footer-lines', `ps-left-footer', `ps-right-footer' and
13339 `ps-footer-frame-alist'. These variables are similar to those
13340 controlling headers.
13341
13342 *** Color management (subgroup)
13343
13344 If `ps-print-color-p' is non-nil, the buffer's text will be printed in
13345 color.
13346
13347 *** Face Management (subgroup)
13348
13349 If you need to print without worrying about face background colors,
13350 set the variable `ps-use-face-background' which specifies if face
13351 background should be used. Valid values are:
13352
13353 t always use face background color.
13354 nil never use face background color.
13355 (face...) list of faces whose background color will be used.
13356
13357 *** N-up printing (subgroup)
13358
13359 The variable `ps-n-up-printing' specifies the number of pages per
13360 sheet of paper.
13361
13362 The variable `ps-n-up-margin' specifies the margin in points (pt)
13363 between the sheet border and the n-up printing.
13364
13365 If variable `ps-n-up-border-p' is non-nil, a border is drawn around
13366 each page.
13367
13368 The variable `ps-n-up-filling' specifies how the page matrix is filled
13369 on each sheet of paper. Following are the valid values for
13370 `ps-n-up-filling' with a filling example using a 3x4 page matrix:
13371
13372 `left-top' 1 2 3 4 `left-bottom' 9 10 11 12
13373 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
13374 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4
13375
13376 `right-top' 4 3 2 1 `right-bottom' 12 11 10 9
13377 8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
13378 12 11 10 9 4 3 2 1
13379
13380 `top-left' 1 4 7 10 `bottom-left' 3 6 9 12
13381 2 5 8 11 2 5 8 11
13382 3 6 9 12 1 4 7 10
13383
13384 `top-right' 10 7 4 1 `bottom-right' 12 9 6 3
13385 11 8 5 2 11 8 5 2
13386 12 9 6 3 10 7 4 1
13387
13388 Any other value is treated as `left-top'.
13389
13390 *** Zebra stripes (subgroup)
13391
13392 The variable `ps-zebra-color' controls the zebra stripes grayscale or
13393 RGB color.
13394
13395 The variable `ps-zebra-stripe-follow' specifies how zebra stripes
13396 continue on next page. Visually, valid values are (the character `+'
13397 to the right of each column indicates that a line is printed):
13398
13399 `nil' `follow' `full' `full-follow'
13400 Current Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13401 1 XXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXX + 1 XXXXXX + 1 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13402 2 XXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXX + 2 XXXXXX + 2 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13403 3 XXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXX + 3 XXXXXX + 3 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13404 4 + 4 + 4 + 4 +
13405 5 + 5 + 5 + 5 +
13406 6 + 6 + 6 + 6 +
13407 7 XXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXX + 7 XXXXXX + 7 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13408 8 XXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXX + 8 XXXXXX + 8 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13409 9 XXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXX + 9 XXXXXX + 9 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13410 10 + 10 +
13411 11 + 11 +
13412 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13413 Next Page -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13414 12 XXXXX + 12 + 10 XXXXXX + 10 +
13415 13 XXXXX + 13 XXXXXXXX + 11 XXXXXX + 11 +
13416 14 XXXXX + 14 XXXXXXXX + 12 XXXXXX + 12 +
13417 15 + 15 XXXXXXXX + 13 + 13 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13418 16 + 16 + 14 + 14 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13419 17 + 17 + 15 + 15 XXXXXXXXXXXXX +
13420 18 XXXXX + 18 + 16 XXXXXX + 16 +
13421 19 XXXXX + 19 XXXXXXXX + 17 XXXXXX + 17 +
13422 20 XXXXX + 20 XXXXXXXX + 18 XXXXXX + 18 +
13423 21 + 21 XXXXXXXX +
13424 22 + 22 +
13425 -------- ----------- --------- ----------------
13426
13427 Any other value is treated as `nil'.
13428
13429
13430 *** Printer management (subgroup)
13431
13432 The variable `ps-printer-name-option' determines the option used by
13433 some utilities to indicate the printer name; it's used only when
13434 `ps-printer-name' is a non-empty string. If you're using the lpr
13435 utility to print, for example, `ps-printer-name-option' should be set
13436 to "-P".
13437
13438 The variable `ps-manual-feed' indicates if the printer requires manual
13439 paper feeding. If it's nil, automatic feeding takes place. If it's
13440 non-nil, manual feeding takes place.
13441
13442 The variable `ps-end-with-control-d' specifies whether C-d (\x04)
13443 should be inserted at end of the generated PostScript. Non-nil means
13444 do so.
13445
13446 *** Page settings (subgroup)
13447
13448 If variable `ps-warn-paper-type' is nil, it's *not* treated as an
13449 error if the PostScript printer doesn't have a paper with the size
13450 indicated by `ps-paper-type'; the default paper size will be used
13451 instead. If `ps-warn-paper-type' is non-nil, an error is signaled if
13452 the PostScript printer doesn't support a paper with the size indicated
13453 by `ps-paper-type'. This is used when `ps-spool-config' is set to
13454 `setpagedevice'.
13455
13456 The variable `ps-print-upside-down' determines the orientation for
13457 printing pages: nil means `normal' printing, non-nil means
13458 `upside-down' printing (that is, the page is rotated by 180 degrees).
13459
13460 The variable `ps-selected-pages' specifies which pages to print. If
13461 it's nil, all pages are printed. If it's a list, list elements may be
13462 integers specifying a single page to print, or cons cells (FROM . TO)
13463 specifying to print from page FROM to TO. Invalid list elements, that
13464 is integers smaller than one, or elements whose FROM is greater than
13465 its TO, are ignored.
13466
13467 The variable `ps-even-or-odd-pages' specifies how to print even/odd
13468 pages. Valid values are:
13469
13470 nil print all pages.
13471
13472 `even-page' print only even pages.
13473
13474 `odd-page' print only odd pages.
13475
13476 `even-sheet' print only even sheets.
13477 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13478 `even-page', but for values greater than 1, it'll
13479 print only the even sheet of paper.
13480
13481 `odd-sheet' print only odd sheets.
13482 That is, if `ps-n-up-printing' is 1, it behaves like
13483 `odd-page'; but for values greater than 1, it'll print
13484 only the odd sheet of paper.
13485
13486 Any other value is treated as nil.
13487
13488 If you set `ps-selected-pages' (see there for documentation), pages
13489 are filtered by `ps-selected-pages', and then by
13490 `ps-even-or-odd-pages'. For example, if we have:
13491
13492 (setq ps-selected-pages '(1 4 (6 . 10) (12 . 16) 20))
13493
13494 and we combine this with `ps-even-or-odd-pages' and
13495 `ps-n-up-printing', we get:
13496
13497 `ps-n-up-printing' = 1:
13498 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13499 nil 1, 4, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10, 12, 13, 14, 15, 16, 20
13500 even-page 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13501 odd-page 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13502 even-sheet 4, 6, 8, 10, 12, 14, 16, 20
13503 odd-sheet 1, 7, 9, 13, 15
13504
13505 `ps-n-up-printing' = 2:
13506 `ps-even-or-odd-pages' PAGES PRINTED
13507 nil 1/4, 6/7, 8/9, 10/12, 13/14, 15/16, 20
13508 even-page 4/6, 8/10, 12/14, 16/20
13509 odd-page 1/7, 9/13, 15
13510 even-sheet 6/7, 10/12, 15/16
13511 odd-sheet 1/4, 8/9, 13/14, 20
13512
13513 *** Miscellany (subgroup)
13514
13515 The variable `ps-error-handler-message' specifies where error handler
13516 messages should be sent.
13517
13518 It is also possible to add a user-defined PostScript prologue code in
13519 front of all generated prologue code by setting the variable
13520 `ps-user-defined-prologue'.
13521
13522 The variable `ps-line-number-font' specifies the font for line numbers.
13523
13524 The variable `ps-line-number-font-size' specifies the font size in
13525 points for line numbers.
13526
13527 The variable `ps-line-number-color' specifies the color for line
13528 numbers. See `ps-zebra-color' for documentation.
13529
13530 The variable `ps-line-number-step' specifies the interval in which
13531 line numbers are printed. For example, if `ps-line-number-step' is set
13532 to 2, the printing will look like:
13533
13534 1 one line
13535 one line
13536 3 one line
13537 one line
13538 5 one line
13539 one line
13540 ...
13541
13542 Valid values are:
13543
13544 integer an integer specifying the interval in which line numbers are
13545 printed. If it's smaller than or equal to zero, 1
13546 is used.
13547
13548 `zebra' specifies that only the line number of the first line in a
13549 zebra stripe is to be printed.
13550
13551 Any other value is treated as `zebra'.
13552
13553 The variable `ps-line-number-start' specifies the starting point in
13554 the interval given by `ps-line-number-step'. For example, if
13555 `ps-line-number-step' is set to 3, and `ps-line-number-start' is set to
13556 3, the output will look like:
13557
13558 one line
13559 one line
13560 3 one line
13561 one line
13562 one line
13563 6 one line
13564 one line
13565 one line
13566 9 one line
13567 one line
13568 ...
13569
13570 The variable `ps-postscript-code-directory' specifies the directory
13571 where the PostScript prologue file used by ps-print is found.
13572
13573 The variable `ps-line-spacing' determines the line spacing in points,
13574 for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13575 `ps-font-size').
13576
13577 The variable `ps-paragraph-spacing' determines the paragraph spacing,
13578 in points, for ordinary text, when generating PostScript (similar to
13579 `ps-font-size').
13580
13581 The variable `ps-paragraph-regexp' specifies the paragraph delimiter.
13582
13583 The variable `ps-begin-cut-regexp' and `ps-end-cut-regexp' specify the
13584 start and end of a region to cut out when printing.
13585
13586 ** hideshow changes.
13587
13588 *** now supports hiding of blocks of single line comments (like // for
13589 C++, ; for lisp).
13590
13591 *** Support for java-mode added.
13592
13593 *** When doing `hs-hide-all' it is now possible to also hide the comments
13594 in the file if `hs-hide-comments-when-hiding-all' is set.
13595
13596 *** The new function `hs-hide-initial-comment' hides the comments at
13597 the beginning of the files. Finally those huge RCS logs don't stay in your
13598 way! This is run by default when entering the `hs-minor-mode'.
13599
13600 *** Now uses overlays instead of `selective-display', so is more
13601 robust and a lot faster.
13602
13603 *** A block beginning can span multiple lines.
13604
13605 *** The new variable `hs-show-hidden-short-form' if t, directs hideshow
13606 to show only the beginning of a block when it is hidden. See the
13607 documentation for more details.
13608
13609 ** Changes in Enriched mode.
13610
13611 *** When you visit a file in enriched-mode, Emacs will make sure it is
13612 filled to the current fill-column. This behavior is now independent
13613 of the size of the window. When you save the file, the fill-column in
13614 use is stored as well, so that the whole buffer need not be refilled
13615 the next time unless the fill-column is different.
13616
13617 *** use-hard-newlines is now a minor mode. When it is enabled, Emacs
13618 distinguishes between hard and soft newlines, and treats hard newlines
13619 as paragraph boundaries. Otherwise all newlines inserted are marked
13620 as soft, and paragraph boundaries are determined solely from the text.
13621
13622 ** Font Lock mode
13623
13624 *** Custom support
13625
13626 The variables font-lock-face-attributes, font-lock-display-type and
13627 font-lock-background-mode are now obsolete; the recommended way to specify
13628 the faces to use for Font Lock mode is with M-x customize-group on the new
13629 custom group font-lock-faces. If you set font-lock-face-attributes in your
13630 ~/.emacs file, Font Lock mode will respect its value. However, you should
13631 consider converting from setting that variable to using M-x customize.
13632
13633 You can still use X resources to specify Font Lock face appearances.
13634
13635 *** Maximum decoration
13636
13637 Fontification now uses the maximum level of decoration supported by
13638 default. Previously, fontification used a mode-specific default level
13639 of decoration, which is typically the minimum level of decoration
13640 supported. You can set font-lock-maximum-decoration to nil
13641 to get the old behavior.
13642
13643 *** New support
13644
13645 Support is now provided for Java, Objective-C, AWK and SIMULA modes.
13646
13647 Note that Font Lock mode can be turned on without knowing exactly what modes
13648 support Font Lock mode, via the command global-font-lock-mode.
13649
13650 *** Configurable support
13651
13652 Support for C, C++, Objective-C and Java can be more easily configured for
13653 additional types and classes via the new variables c-font-lock-extra-types,
13654 c++-font-lock-extra-types, objc-font-lock-extra-types and, you guessed it,
13655 java-font-lock-extra-types. These value of each of these variables should be a
13656 list of regexps matching the extra type names. For example, the default value
13657 of c-font-lock-extra-types is ("\\sw+_t") which means fontification follows the
13658 convention that C type names end in _t. This results in slower fontification.
13659
13660 Of course, you can change the variables that specify fontification in whatever
13661 way you wish, typically by adding regexps. However, these new variables make
13662 it easier to make specific and common changes for the fontification of types.
13663
13664 *** Adding highlighting patterns to existing support
13665
13666 You can use the new function font-lock-add-keywords to add your own
13667 highlighting patterns, such as for project-local or user-specific constructs,
13668 for any mode.
13669
13670 For example, to highlight `FIXME:' words in C comments, put:
13671
13672 (font-lock-add-keywords 'c-mode '(("\\<FIXME:" 0 font-lock-warning-face t)))
13673
13674 in your ~/.emacs.
13675
13676 *** New faces
13677
13678 Font Lock now defines two new faces, font-lock-builtin-face and
13679 font-lock-warning-face. These are intended to highlight builtin keywords,
13680 distinct from a language's normal keywords, and objects that should be brought
13681 to user attention, respectively. Various modes now use these new faces.
13682
13683 *** Changes to fast-lock support mode
13684
13685 The fast-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now process
13686 cache files silently. You can use the new variable fast-lock-verbose, in the
13687 same way as font-lock-verbose, to control this feature.
13688
13689 *** Changes to lazy-lock support mode
13690
13691 The lazy-lock package, one of the two Font Lock support modes, can now fontify
13692 according to the true syntactic context relative to other lines. You can use
13693 the new variable lazy-lock-defer-contextually to control this feature. If
13694 non-nil, changes to the buffer will cause subsequent lines in the buffer to be
13695 refontified after lazy-lock-defer-time seconds of idle time. If nil, then only
13696 the modified lines will be refontified; this is the same as the previous Lazy
13697 Lock mode behavior and the behavior of Font Lock mode.
13698
13699 This feature is useful in modes where strings or comments can span lines.
13700 For example, if a string or comment terminating character is deleted, then if
13701 this feature is enabled subsequent lines in the buffer will be correctly
13702 refontified to reflect their new syntactic context. Previously, only the line
13703 containing the deleted character would be refontified and you would have to use
13704 the command M-o M-o (font-lock-fontify-block) to refontify some lines.
13705
13706 As a consequence of this new feature, two other variables have changed:
13707
13708 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-driven' is renamed `lazy-lock-defer-on-scrolling'.
13709 Variable `lazy-lock-defer-time' can now only be a time, i.e., a number.
13710 Buffer modes for which on-the-fly deferral applies can be specified via the
13711 new variable `lazy-lock-defer-on-the-fly'.
13712
13713 If you set these variables in your ~/.emacs, then you may have to change those
13714 settings.
13715
13716 ** Ada mode changes.
13717
13718 *** There is now better support for using find-file.el with Ada mode.
13719 If you switch between spec and body, the cursor stays in the same
13720 procedure (modulo overloading). If a spec has no body file yet, but
13721 you try to switch to its body file, Ada mode now generates procedure
13722 stubs.
13723
13724 *** There are two new commands:
13725 - `ada-make-local' : invokes gnatmake on the current buffer
13726 - `ada-check-syntax' : check syntax of current buffer.
13727
13728 The user options `ada-compiler-make', `ada-make-options',
13729 `ada-language-version', `ada-compiler-syntax-check', and
13730 `ada-compile-options' are used within these commands.
13731
13732 *** Ada mode can now work with Outline minor mode. The outline level
13733 is calculated from the indenting, not from syntactic constructs.
13734 Outlining does not work if your code is not correctly indented.
13735
13736 *** The new function `ada-gnat-style' converts the buffer to the style of
13737 formatting used in GNAT. It places two blanks after a comment start,
13738 places one blank between a word end and an opening '(', and puts one
13739 space between a comma and the beginning of a word.
13740
13741 ** Scheme mode changes.
13742
13743 *** Scheme mode indentation now uses many of the facilities of Lisp
13744 mode; therefore, the variables to customize it are the variables used
13745 for Lisp mode which have names starting with `lisp-'. The variables
13746 with names starting with `scheme-' which used to do this no longer
13747 have any effect.
13748
13749 If you want to use different indentation for Scheme and Lisp, this is
13750 still possible, but now you must do it by adding a hook to
13751 scheme-mode-hook, which could work by setting the `lisp-' indentation
13752 variables as buffer-local variables.
13753
13754 *** DSSSL mode is a variant of Scheme mode, for editing DSSSL scripts.
13755 Use M-x dsssl-mode.
13756
13757 ** Changes to the emacsclient program
13758
13759 *** If a socket can't be found, and environment variables LOGNAME or
13760 USER are set, emacsclient now looks for a socket based on the UID
13761 associated with the name. That is an emacsclient running as root
13762 can connect to an Emacs server started by a non-root user.
13763
13764 *** The emacsclient program now accepts an option --no-wait which tells
13765 it to return immediately without waiting for you to "finish" the
13766 buffer in Emacs.
13767
13768 *** The new option --alternate-editor allows to specify an editor to
13769 use if Emacs is not running. The environment variable
13770 ALTERNATE_EDITOR can be used for the same effect; the command line
13771 option takes precedence.
13772
13773 ** M-x eldoc-mode enables a minor mode in which the echo area
13774 constantly shows the parameter list for function being called at point
13775 (in Emacs Lisp and Lisp Interaction modes only).
13776
13777 ** C-x n d now runs the new command narrow-to-defun,
13778 which narrows the accessible parts of the buffer to just
13779 the current defun.
13780
13781 ** Emacs now handles the `--' argument in the standard way; all
13782 following arguments are treated as ordinary file names.
13783
13784 ** On MSDOS and Windows, the bookmark file is now called _emacs.bmk,
13785 and the saved desktop file is now called _emacs.desktop (truncated if
13786 necessary).
13787
13788 ** When you kill a buffer that visits a file,
13789 if there are any registers that save positions in the file,
13790 these register values no longer become completely useless.
13791 If you try to go to such a register with C-x j, then you are
13792 asked whether to visit the file again. If you say yes,
13793 it visits the file and then goes to the same position.
13794
13795 ** When you visit a file that changes frequently outside Emacs--for
13796 example, a log of output from a process that continues to run--it may
13797 be useful for Emacs to revert the file without querying you whenever
13798 you visit the file afresh with C-x C-f.
13799
13800 You can request this behavior for certain files by setting the
13801 variable revert-without-query to a list of regular expressions. If a
13802 file's name matches any of these regular expressions, find-file and
13803 revert-buffer revert the buffer without asking for permission--but
13804 only if you have not edited the buffer text yourself.
13805
13806 ** set-default-font has been renamed to set-frame-font
13807 since it applies only to the current frame.
13808
13809 ** In TeX mode, you can use the variable tex-main-file to specify the
13810 file for tex-file to run TeX on. (By default, tex-main-file is nil,
13811 and tex-file runs TeX on the current visited file.)
13812
13813 This is useful when you are editing a document that consists of
13814 multiple files. In each of the included files, you can set up a local
13815 variable list which specifies the top-level file of your document for
13816 tex-main-file. Then tex-file will run TeX on the whole document
13817 instead of just the file you are editing.
13818
13819 ** RefTeX mode
13820
13821 RefTeX mode is a new minor mode with special support for \label, \ref
13822 and \cite macros in LaTeX documents. RefTeX distinguishes labels of
13823 different environments (equation, figure, ...) and has full support for
13824 multifile documents. To use it, select a buffer with a LaTeX document and
13825 turn the mode on with M-x reftex-mode. Here are the main user commands:
13826
13827 C-c ( reftex-label
13828 Creates a label semi-automatically. RefTeX is context sensitive and
13829 knows which kind of label is needed.
13830
13831 C-c ) reftex-reference
13832 Offers in a menu all labels in the document, along with context of the
13833 label definition. The selected label is referenced as \ref{LABEL}.
13834
13835 C-c [ reftex-citation
13836 Prompts for a regular expression and displays a list of matching BibTeX
13837 database entries. The selected entry is cited with a \cite{KEY} macro.
13838
13839 C-c & reftex-view-crossref
13840 Views the cross reference of a \ref or \cite command near point.
13841
13842 C-c = reftex-toc
13843 Shows a table of contents of the (multifile) document. From there you
13844 can quickly jump to every section.
13845
13846 Under X, RefTeX installs a "Ref" menu in the menu bar, with additional
13847 commands. Press `?' to get help when a prompt mentions this feature.
13848 Full documentation and customization examples are in the file
13849 reftex.el. You can use the finder to view the file documentation:
13850 C-h p --> tex --> reftex.el
13851
13852 ** Changes in BibTeX mode.
13853
13854 *** Info documentation is now available.
13855
13856 *** Don't allow parentheses in string constants anymore. This confused
13857 both the BibTeX program and Emacs BibTeX mode.
13858
13859 *** Renamed variable bibtex-mode-user-optional-fields to
13860 bibtex-user-optional-fields.
13861
13862 *** Removed variable bibtex-include-OPTannote
13863 (use bibtex-user-optional-fields instead).
13864
13865 *** New interactive functions to copy and kill fields and complete
13866 entries to the BibTeX kill ring, from where they can be yanked back by
13867 appropriate functions.
13868
13869 *** New interactive functions for repositioning and marking of
13870 entries. They are bound by default to C-M-l and C-M-h.
13871
13872 *** New hook bibtex-clean-entry-hook. It is called after entry has
13873 been cleaned.
13874
13875 *** New variable bibtex-field-delimiters, which replaces variables
13876 bibtex-field-{left|right}-delimiter.
13877
13878 *** New variable bibtex-entry-delimiters to determine how entries
13879 shall be delimited.
13880
13881 *** Allow preinitialization of fields. See documentation of
13882 bibtex-user-optional-fields, bibtex-entry-field-alist, and
13883 bibtex-include-OPTkey for details.
13884
13885 *** Book and InBook entries require either an author or an editor
13886 field. This is now supported by bibtex.el. Alternative fields are
13887 prefixed with `ALT'.
13888
13889 *** New variable bibtex-entry-format, which replaces variable
13890 bibtex-clean-entry-zap-empty-opts and allows specification of many
13891 formatting options performed on cleaning an entry (see variable
13892 documentation).
13893
13894 *** Even more control on how automatic keys are generated. See
13895 documentation of bibtex-generate-autokey for details. Transcriptions
13896 for foreign languages other than German are now handled, too.
13897
13898 *** New boolean user option bibtex-comma-after-last-field to decide if
13899 comma should be inserted at end of last field.
13900
13901 *** New boolean user option bibtex-align-at-equal-sign to determine if
13902 alignment should be made at left side of field contents or at equal
13903 signs. New user options to control entry layout (e.g. indentation).
13904
13905 *** New function bibtex-fill-entry to realign entries.
13906
13907 *** New function bibtex-reformat to reformat region or buffer.
13908
13909 *** New function bibtex-convert-alien to convert a BibTeX database
13910 from alien sources.
13911
13912 *** New function bibtex-complete-key (similar to bibtex-complete-string)
13913 to complete prefix to a key defined in buffer. Mainly useful in
13914 crossref entries.
13915
13916 *** New function bibtex-count-entries to count entries in buffer or
13917 region.
13918
13919 *** Added support for imenu.
13920
13921 *** The function `bibtex-validate' now checks current region instead
13922 of buffer if mark is active. Now it shows all errors of buffer in a
13923 `compilation mode' buffer. You can use the normal commands (e.g.
13924 `next-error') for compilation modes to jump to errors.
13925
13926 *** New variable `bibtex-string-file-path' to determine where the files
13927 from `bibtex-string-files' are searched.
13928
13929 ** Iso Accents mode now supports Latin-3 as an alternative.
13930
13931 ** The command next-error now opens blocks hidden by hideshow.
13932
13933 ** The function using-unix-filesystems has been replaced by the
13934 functions add-untranslated-filesystem and remove-untranslated-filesystem.
13935 Each of these functions takes the name of a drive letter or directory
13936 as an argument.
13937
13938 When a filesystem is added as untranslated, all files on it are read
13939 and written in binary mode (no cr/lf translation is performed).
13940
13941 ** browse-url changes
13942
13943 *** New methods for: Grail (browse-url-generic), MMM (browse-url-mmm),
13944 Lynx in a separate xterm (browse-url-lynx-xterm) or in an Emacs window
13945 (browse-url-lynx-emacs), remote W3 (browse-url-w3-gnudoit), generic
13946 non-remote-controlled browsers (browse-url-generic) and associated
13947 customization variables.
13948
13949 *** New commands `browse-url-of-region' and `browse-url'.
13950
13951 *** URLs marked up with <URL:...> (RFC1738) work if broken across
13952 lines. Browsing methods can be associated with URL regexps
13953 (e.g. mailto: URLs) via `browse-url-browser-function'.
13954
13955 ** Changes in Ediff
13956
13957 *** Clicking Mouse-2 on a brief command description in Ediff control panel
13958 pops up the Info file for this command.
13959
13960 *** There is now a variable, ediff-autostore-merges, which controls whether
13961 the result of a merge is saved in a file. By default, this is done only when
13962 merge is done from a session group (eg, when merging files in two different
13963 directories).
13964
13965 *** Since Emacs 19.31 (this hasn't been announced before), Ediff can compare
13966 and merge groups of files residing in different directories, or revisions of
13967 files in the same directory.
13968
13969 *** Since Emacs 19.31, Ediff can apply multi-file patches interactively.
13970 The patches must be in the context format or GNU unified format. (The bug
13971 related to the GNU format has now been fixed.)
13972
13973 ** Changes in Viper
13974
13975 *** The startup file is now .viper instead of .vip
13976 *** All variable/function names have been changed to start with viper-
13977 instead of vip-.
13978 *** C-\ now simulates the meta-key in all Viper states.
13979 *** C-z in Insert state now escapes to Vi for the duration of the next
13980 Viper command. In Vi and Insert states, C-z behaves as before.
13981 *** C-c \ escapes to Vi for one command if Viper is in Insert or Emacs states.
13982 *** _ is no longer the meta-key in Vi state.
13983 *** The variable viper-insert-state-cursor-color can be used to change cursor
13984 color when Viper is in insert state.
13985 *** If search lands the cursor near the top or the bottom of the window,
13986 Viper pulls the window up or down to expose more context. The variable
13987 viper-adjust-window-after-search controls this behavior.
13988
13989 ** Etags changes.
13990
13991 *** In C, C++, Objective C and Java, Etags tags global variables by
13992 default. The resulting tags files are inflated by 30% on average.
13993 Use --no-globals to turn this feature off. Etags can also tag
13994 variables which are members of structure-like constructs, but it does
13995 not by default. Use --members to turn this feature on.
13996
13997 *** C++ member functions are now recognized as tags.
13998
13999 *** Java is tagged like C++. In addition, "extends" and "implements"
14000 constructs are tagged. Files are recognized by the extension .java.
14001
14002 *** Etags can now handle programs written in Postscript. Files are
14003 recognized by the extensions .ps and .pdb (Postscript with C syntax).
14004 In Postscript, tags are lines that start with a slash.
14005
14006 *** Etags now handles Objective C and Objective C++ code. The usual C and
14007 C++ tags are recognized in these languages; in addition, etags
14008 recognizes special Objective C syntax for classes, class categories,
14009 methods and protocols.
14010
14011 *** Etags also handles Cobol. Files are recognized by the extension
14012 .cobol. The tagged lines are those containing a word that begins in
14013 column 8 and ends in a full stop, i.e. anything that could be a
14014 paragraph name.
14015
14016 *** Regexps in Etags now support intervals, as in ed or grep. The syntax of
14017 an interval is \{M,N\}, and it means to match the preceding expression
14018 at least M times and as many as N times.
14019
14020 ** The format for specifying a custom format for time-stamp to insert
14021 in files has changed slightly.
14022
14023 With the new enhancements to the functionality of format-time-string,
14024 time-stamp-format will change to be eventually compatible with it.
14025 This conversion is being done in two steps to maintain compatibility
14026 with old time-stamp-format values.
14027
14028 In the new scheme, alternate case is signified by the number-sign
14029 (`#') modifier, rather than changing the case of the format character.
14030 This feature is as yet incompletely implemented for compatibility
14031 reasons.
14032
14033 In the old time-stamp-format, all numeric fields defaulted to their
14034 natural width. (With format-time-string, each format has a
14035 fixed-width default.) In this version, you can specify the colon
14036 (`:') modifier to a numeric conversion to mean "give me the historical
14037 time-stamp-format width default." Do not use colon if you are
14038 specifying an explicit width, as in "%02d".
14039
14040 Numbers are no longer truncated to the requested width, except in the
14041 case of "%02y", which continues to give a two-digit year. Digit
14042 truncation probably wasn't being used for anything else anyway.
14043
14044 The new formats will work with old versions of Emacs. New formats are
14045 being recommended now to allow time-stamp-format to change in the
14046 future to be compatible with format-time-string. The new forms being
14047 recommended now will continue to work then.
14048
14049 See the documentation string for the variable time-stamp-format for
14050 details.
14051
14052 ** There are some additional major modes:
14053
14054 dcl-mode, for editing VMS DCL files.
14055 m4-mode, for editing files of m4 input.
14056 meta-mode, for editing MetaFont and MetaPost source files.
14057
14058 ** In Shell mode, the command shell-copy-environment-variable lets you
14059 copy the value of a specified environment variable from the subshell
14060 into Emacs.
14061
14062 ** New Lisp packages include:
14063
14064 *** battery.el displays battery status for laptops.
14065
14066 *** M-x bruce (named after Lenny Bruce) is a program that might
14067 be used for adding some indecent words to your email.
14068
14069 *** M-x crisp-mode enables an emulation for the CRiSP editor.
14070
14071 *** M-x dirtrack arranges for better tracking of directory changes
14072 in shell buffers.
14073
14074 *** The new library elint.el provides for linting of Emacs Lisp code.
14075 See the documentation for `elint-initialize', `elint-current-buffer'
14076 and `elint-defun'.
14077
14078 *** M-x expand-add-abbrevs defines a special kind of abbrev which is
14079 meant for programming constructs. These abbrevs expand like ordinary
14080 ones, when you type SPC, but only at the end of a line and not within
14081 strings or comments.
14082
14083 These abbrevs can act as templates: you can define places within an
14084 abbrev for insertion of additional text. Once you expand the abbrev,
14085 you can then use C-x a p and C-x a n to move back and forth to these
14086 insertion points. Thus you can conveniently insert additional text
14087 at these points.
14088
14089 *** filecache.el remembers the location of files so that you
14090 can visit them by short forms of their names.
14091
14092 *** find-func.el lets you find the definition of the user-loaded
14093 Emacs Lisp function at point.
14094
14095 *** M-x handwrite converts text to a "handwritten" picture.
14096
14097 *** M-x iswitchb-buffer is a command for switching to a buffer, much like
14098 switch-buffer, but it reads the argument in a more helpful way.
14099
14100 *** M-x landmark implements a neural network for landmark learning.
14101
14102 *** M-x locate provides a convenient interface to the `locate' program.
14103
14104 *** M4 mode is a new mode for editing files of m4 input.
14105
14106 *** mantemp.el creates C++ manual template instantiations
14107 from the GCC error messages which indicate which instantiations are needed.
14108
14109 *** mouse-copy.el provides a one-click copy and move feature.
14110 You can drag a region with M-mouse-1, and it is automatically
14111 inserted at point. M-Shift-mouse-1 deletes the text from its
14112 original place after inserting the copy.
14113
14114 *** mouse-drag.el lets you do scrolling by dragging Mouse-2
14115 on the buffer.
14116
14117 You click the mouse and move; that distance either translates into the
14118 velocity to scroll (with mouse-drag-throw) or the distance to scroll
14119 (with mouse-drag-drag). Horizontal scrolling is enabled when needed.
14120
14121 Enable mouse-drag with:
14122 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-throw)
14123 -or-
14124 (global-set-key [down-mouse-2] 'mouse-drag-drag)
14125
14126 *** mspools.el is useful for determining which mail folders have
14127 mail waiting to be read in them. It works with procmail.
14128
14129 *** Octave mode is a major mode for editing files of input for Octave.
14130 It comes with a facility for communicating with an Octave subprocess.
14131
14132 *** ogonek
14133
14134 The ogonek package provides functions for changing the coding of
14135 Polish diacritic characters in buffers. Codings known from various
14136 platforms are supported such as ISO8859-2, Mazovia, IBM Latin2, and
14137 TeX. For example, you can change the coding from Mazovia to
14138 ISO8859-2. Another example is a change of coding from ISO8859-2 to
14139 prefix notation (in which `/a' stands for the aogonek character, for
14140 instance) and vice versa.
14141
14142 To use this package load it using
14143 M-x load-library [enter] ogonek
14144 Then, you may get an explanation by calling one of
14145 M-x ogonek-jak -- in Polish
14146 M-x ogonek-how -- in English
14147 The info specifies the commands and variables provided as well as the
14148 ways of customization in `.emacs'.
14149
14150 *** Interface to ph.
14151
14152 Emacs provides a client interface to CCSO Nameservers (ph/qi)
14153
14154 The CCSO nameserver is used in many universities to provide directory
14155 services about people. ph.el provides a convenient Emacs interface to
14156 these servers.
14157
14158 *** uce.el is useful for replying to unsolicited commercial email.
14159
14160 *** vcursor.el implements a "virtual cursor" feature.
14161 You can move the virtual cursor with special commands
14162 while the real cursor does not move.
14163
14164 *** webjump.el is a "hot list" package which you can set up
14165 for visiting your favorite web sites.
14166
14167 *** M-x winner-mode is a minor mode which saves window configurations,
14168 so you can move back to other configurations that you have recently used.
14169
14170 ** movemail change
14171
14172 Movemail no longer needs to be installed setuid root in order for POP
14173 mail retrieval to function properly. This is because it no longer
14174 supports the RPOP (reserved-port POP) protocol; instead, it uses the
14175 user's POP password to authenticate to the mail server.
14176
14177 This change was made earlier, but not reported in NEWS before.
14178
14179 * Emacs 20.1 changes for MS-DOS and MS-Windows.
14180
14181 ** Changes in handling MS-DOS/MS-Windows text files.
14182
14183 Emacs handles three different conventions for representing
14184 end-of-line: CRLF for MSDOS, LF for Unix and GNU, and CR (used on the
14185 Macintosh). Emacs determines which convention is used in a specific
14186 file based on the contents of that file (except for certain special
14187 file names), and when it saves the file, it uses the same convention.
14188
14189 To save the file and change the end-of-line convention, you can use
14190 C-x RET f (set-buffer-file-coding-system) to specify a different
14191 coding system for the buffer. Then, when you save the file, the newly
14192 specified coding system will take effect. For example, to save with
14193 LF, specify undecided-unix (or some other ...-unix coding system); to
14194 save with CRLF, specify undecided-dos.
14195
14196 * Lisp Changes in Emacs 20.1
14197
14198 ** Byte-compiled files made with Emacs 20 will, in general, work in
14199 Emacs 19 as well, as long as the source code runs in Emacs 19. And
14200 vice versa: byte-compiled files made with Emacs 19 should also run in
14201 Emacs 20, as long as the program itself works in Emacs 20.
14202
14203 ** Windows-specific functions and variables have been renamed
14204 to start with w32- instead of win32-.
14205
14206 In hacker language, calling something a "win" is a form of praise. We
14207 don't want to praise a non-free Microsoft system, so we don't call it
14208 "win".
14209
14210 ** Basic Lisp changes
14211
14212 *** A symbol whose name starts with a colon now automatically
14213 evaluates to itself. Therefore such a symbol can be used as a constant.
14214
14215 *** The defined purpose of `defconst' has been changed. It should now
14216 be used only for values that should not be changed whether by a program
14217 or by the user.
14218
14219 The actual behavior of defconst has not been changed.
14220
14221 *** There are new macros `when' and `unless'
14222
14223 (when CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION (progn BODY...))
14224 (unless CONDITION BODY...) is short for (if CONDITION nil BODY...)
14225
14226 *** Emacs now defines functions caar, cadr, cdar and cddr with their
14227 usual Lisp meanings. For example, caar returns the car of the car of
14228 its argument.
14229
14230 *** equal, when comparing strings, now ignores their text properties.
14231
14232 *** The new function `functionp' tests whether an object is a function.
14233
14234 *** arrayp now returns t for char-tables and bool-vectors.
14235
14236 *** Certain primitives which use characters (as integers) now get an
14237 error if the integer is not a valid character code. These primitives
14238 include insert-char, char-to-string, and the %c construct in the
14239 `format' function.
14240
14241 *** The `require' function now insists on adding a suffix, either .el
14242 or .elc, to the file name. Thus, (require 'foo) will not use a file
14243 whose name is just foo. It insists on foo.el or foo.elc.
14244
14245 *** The `autoload' function, when the file name does not contain
14246 either a directory name or the suffix .el or .elc, insists on
14247 adding one of these suffixes.
14248
14249 *** string-to-number now takes an optional second argument BASE
14250 which specifies the base to use when converting an integer.
14251 If BASE is omitted, base 10 is used.
14252
14253 We have not implemented other radices for floating point numbers,
14254 because that would be much more work and does not seem useful.
14255
14256 *** substring now handles vectors as well as strings.
14257
14258 *** The Common Lisp function eql is no longer defined normally.
14259 You must load the `cl' library to define it.
14260
14261 *** The new macro `with-current-buffer' lets you evaluate an expression
14262 conveniently with a different current buffer. It looks like this:
14263
14264 (with-current-buffer BUFFER BODY-FORMS...)
14265
14266 BUFFER is the expression that says which buffer to use.
14267 BODY-FORMS say what to do in that buffer.
14268
14269 *** The new primitive `save-current-buffer' saves and restores the
14270 choice of current buffer, like `save-excursion', but without saving or
14271 restoring the value of point or the mark. `with-current-buffer'
14272 works using `save-current-buffer'.
14273
14274 *** The new macro `with-temp-file' lets you do some work in a new buffer and
14275 write the output to a specified file. Like `progn', it returns the value
14276 of the last form.
14277
14278 *** The new macro `with-temp-buffer' lets you do some work in a new buffer,
14279 which is discarded after use. Like `progn', it returns the value of the
14280 last form. If you wish to return the buffer contents, use (buffer-string)
14281 as the last form.
14282
14283 *** The new function split-string takes a string, splits it at certain
14284 characters, and returns a list of the substrings in between the
14285 matches.
14286
14287 For example, (split-string "foo bar lose" " +") returns ("foo" "bar" "lose").
14288
14289 *** The new macro with-output-to-string executes some Lisp expressions
14290 with standard-output set up so that all output feeds into a string.
14291 Then it returns that string.
14292
14293 For example, if the current buffer name is `foo',
14294
14295 (with-output-to-string
14296 (princ "The buffer is ")
14297 (princ (buffer-name)))
14298
14299 returns "The buffer is foo".
14300
14301 ** Non-ASCII characters are now supported, if enable-multibyte-characters
14302 is non-nil.
14303
14304 These characters have character codes above 256. When inserted in the
14305 buffer or stored in a string, they are represented as multibyte
14306 characters that occupy several buffer positions each.
14307
14308 *** When enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, a single character in
14309 a buffer or string can be two or more bytes (as many as four).
14310
14311 Buffers and strings are still made up of unibyte elements;
14312 character positions and string indices are always measured in bytes.
14313 Therefore, moving forward one character can increase the buffer
14314 position by 2, 3 or 4. The function forward-char moves by whole
14315 characters, and therefore is no longer equivalent to
14316 (lambda (n) (goto-char (+ (point) n))).
14317
14318 ASCII characters (codes 0 through 127) are still single bytes, always.
14319 Sequences of byte values 128 through 255 are used to represent
14320 non-ASCII characters. These sequences are called "multibyte
14321 characters".
14322
14323 The first byte of a multibyte character is always in the range 128
14324 through 159 (octal 0200 through 0237). These values are called
14325 "leading codes". The second and subsequent bytes are always in the
14326 range 160 through 255 (octal 0240 through 0377). The first byte, the
14327 leading code, determines how many bytes long the sequence is.
14328
14329 *** The function forward-char moves over characters, and therefore
14330 (forward-char 1) may increase point by more than 1 if it moves over a
14331 multibyte character. Likewise, delete-char always deletes a
14332 character, which may be more than one buffer position.
14333
14334 This means that some Lisp programs, which assume that a character is
14335 always one buffer position, need to be changed.
14336
14337 However, all ASCII characters are always one buffer position.
14338
14339 *** The regexp [\200-\377] no longer matches all non-ASCII characters,
14340 because when enable-multibyte-characters is non-nil, these characters
14341 have codes that are not in the range octal 200 to octal 377. However,
14342 the regexp [^\000-\177] does match all non-ASCII characters,
14343 guaranteed.
14344
14345 *** The function char-boundary-p returns non-nil if position POS is
14346 between two characters in the buffer (not in the middle of a
14347 character).
14348
14349 When the value is non-nil, it says what kind of character follows POS:
14350
14351 0 if POS is at an ASCII character or at the end of range,
14352 1 if POS is before a 2-byte length multi-byte form,
14353 2 if POS is at a head of 3-byte length multi-byte form,
14354 3 if POS is at a head of 4-byte length multi-byte form,
14355 4 if POS is at a head of multi-byte form of a composite character.
14356
14357 *** The function char-bytes returns how many bytes the character CHAR uses.
14358
14359 *** Strings can contain multibyte characters. The function
14360 `length' returns the string length counting bytes, which may be
14361 more than the number of characters.
14362
14363 You can include a multibyte character in a string constant by writing
14364 it literally. You can also represent it with a hex escape,
14365 \xNNNNNNN..., using as many digits as necessary. Any character which
14366 is not a valid hex digit terminates this construct. If you want to
14367 follow it with a character that is a hex digit, write backslash and
14368 newline in between; that will terminate the hex escape.
14369
14370 *** The function concat-chars takes arguments which are characters
14371 and returns a string containing those characters.
14372
14373 *** The function sref access a multibyte character in a string.
14374 (sref STRING INDX) returns the character in STRING at INDEX. INDEX
14375 counts from zero. If INDEX is at a position in the middle of a
14376 character, sref signals an error.
14377
14378 *** The function chars-in-string returns the number of characters
14379 in a string. This is less than the length of the string, if the
14380 string contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14381
14382 *** The function chars-in-region returns the number of characters
14383 in a region from BEG to END. This is less than (- END BEG) if the
14384 region contains multibyte characters (the length counts bytes).
14385
14386 *** The function string-to-list converts a string to a list of
14387 the characters in it. string-to-vector converts a string
14388 to a vector of the characters in it.
14389
14390 *** The function store-substring alters part of the contents
14391 of a string. You call it as follows:
14392
14393 (store-substring STRING IDX OBJ)
14394
14395 This says to alter STRING, by storing OBJ starting at index IDX in
14396 STRING. OBJ may be either a character or a (smaller) string.
14397 This function really does alter the contents of STRING.
14398 Since it is impossible to change the length of an existing string,
14399 it is an error if OBJ doesn't fit within STRING's actual length.
14400
14401 *** char-width returns the width (in columns) of the character CHAR,
14402 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14403
14404 *** string-width returns the width (in columns) of the text in STRING,
14405 if it were displayed in the current buffer and the selected window.
14406
14407 *** truncate-string-to-width shortens a string, if necessary,
14408 to fit within a certain number of columns. (Of course, it does
14409 not alter the string that you give it; it returns a new string
14410 which contains all or just part of the existing string.)
14411
14412 (truncate-string-to-width STR END-COLUMN &optional START-COLUMN PADDING)
14413
14414 This returns the part of STR up to column END-COLUMN.
14415
14416 The optional argument START-COLUMN specifies the starting column.
14417 If this is non-nil, then the first START-COLUMN columns of the string
14418 are not included in the resulting value.
14419
14420 The optional argument PADDING, if non-nil, is a padding character to be added
14421 at the beginning and end the resulting string, to extend it to exactly
14422 WIDTH columns. If PADDING is nil, that means do not pad; then, if STRING
14423 is narrower than WIDTH, the value is equal to STRING.
14424
14425 If PADDING and START-COLUMN are both non-nil, and if there is no clean
14426 place in STRING that corresponds to START-COLUMN (because one
14427 character extends across that column), then the padding character
14428 PADDING is added one or more times at the beginning of the result
14429 string, so that its columns line up as if it really did start at
14430 column START-COLUMN.
14431
14432 *** When the functions in the list after-change-functions are called,
14433 the third argument is the number of bytes in the pre-change text, not
14434 necessarily the number of characters. It is, in effect, the
14435 difference in buffer position between the beginning and the end of the
14436 changed text, before the change.
14437
14438 *** The characters Emacs uses are classified in various character
14439 sets, each of which has a name which is a symbol. In general there is
14440 one character set for each script, not for each language.
14441
14442 **** The function charsetp tests whether an object is a character set name.
14443
14444 **** The variable charset-list holds a list of character set names.
14445
14446 **** char-charset, given a character code, returns the name of the character
14447 set that the character belongs to. (The value is a symbol.)
14448
14449 **** split-char, given a character code, returns a list containing the
14450 name of the character set, followed by one or two byte-values
14451 which identify the character within that character set.
14452
14453 **** make-char, given a character set name and one or two subsequent
14454 byte-values, constructs a character code. This is roughly the
14455 opposite of split-char.
14456
14457 **** find-charset-region returns a list of the character sets
14458 of all the characters between BEG and END.
14459
14460 **** find-charset-string returns a list of the character sets
14461 of all the characters in a string.
14462
14463 *** Here are the Lisp facilities for working with coding systems
14464 and specifying coding systems.
14465
14466 **** The function coding-system-list returns a list of all coding
14467 system names (symbols). With optional argument t, it returns a list
14468 of all distinct base coding systems, not including variants.
14469 (Variant coding systems are those like latin-1-dos, latin-1-unix
14470 and latin-1-mac which specify the end-of-line conversion as well
14471 as what to do about code conversion.)
14472
14473 **** coding-system-p tests a symbol to see if it is a coding system
14474 name. It returns t if so, nil if not.
14475
14476 **** file-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14477 for certain file names. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14478 except that the PATTERN is matched against the file name.
14479
14480 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14481 which file names the element applies to. PATTERN should be a regexp
14482 to match against a file name.
14483
14484 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14485 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14486 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14487 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14488 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14489 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14490
14491 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14492 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14493
14494 **** The variable network-coding-system-alist specifies
14495 the coding system to use for network sockets.
14496
14497 Each element has the format (PATTERN . VAL), where PATTERN determines
14498 which network sockets the element applies to. PATTERN should be
14499 either a port number or a regular expression matching some network
14500 service names.
14501
14502 VAL is a coding system, a cons cell containing two coding systems, or
14503 a function symbol. If VAL is a coding system, it is used for both
14504 decoding what received from the network stream and encoding what sent
14505 to the network stream. If VAL is a cons cell containing two coding
14506 systems, the car specifies the coding system for decoding, and the cdr
14507 specifies the coding system for encoding.
14508
14509 If VAL is a function symbol, the function must return a coding system
14510 or a cons cell containing two coding systems, which is used as above.
14511
14512 **** process-coding-system-alist specifies which coding systems to use
14513 for certain subprocess. It works like network-coding-system-alist,
14514 except that the PATTERN is matched against the program name used to
14515 start the subprocess.
14516
14517 **** The variable default-process-coding-system specifies the coding
14518 systems to use for subprocess (and net connection) input and output,
14519 when nothing else specifies what to do. The value is a cons cell
14520 (OUTPUT-CODING . INPUT-CODING). OUTPUT-CODING applies to output
14521 to the subprocess, and INPUT-CODING applies to input from it.
14522
14523 **** The variable coding-system-for-write, if non-nil, specifies the
14524 coding system to use for writing a file, or for output to a synchronous
14525 subprocess.
14526
14527 It also applies to any asynchronous subprocess or network connection,
14528 but in a different way: the value of coding-system-for-write when you
14529 start the subprocess or connection affects that subprocess or
14530 connection permanently or until overridden.
14531
14532 The variable coding-system-for-write takes precedence over
14533 file-coding-system-alist, process-coding-system-alist and
14534 network-coding-system-alist, and all other methods of specifying a
14535 coding system for output. But most of the time this variable is nil.
14536 It exists so that Lisp programs can bind it to a specific coding
14537 system for one operation at a time.
14538
14539 **** coding-system-for-read applies similarly to input from
14540 files, subprocesses or network connections.
14541
14542 **** The function process-coding-system tells you what
14543 coding systems(s) an existing subprocess is using.
14544 The value is a cons cell,
14545 (DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM . ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM)
14546 where DECODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for decoding output from
14547 the subprocess, and ENCODING-CODING-SYSTEM is used for encoding
14548 input to the subprocess.
14549
14550 **** The function set-process-coding-system can be used to
14551 change the coding systems in use for an existing subprocess.
14552
14553 ** Emacs has a new facility to help users manage the many
14554 customization options. To make a Lisp program work with this facility,
14555 you need to use the new macros defgroup and defcustom.
14556
14557 You use defcustom instead of defvar, for defining a user option
14558 variable. The difference is that you specify two additional pieces of
14559 information (usually): the "type" which says what values are
14560 legitimate, and the "group" which specifies the hierarchy for
14561 customization.
14562
14563 Thus, instead of writing
14564
14565 (defvar foo-blurgoze nil
14566 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely.")
14567
14568 you would now write this:
14569
14570 (defcustom foo-blurgoze nil
14571 "*Non-nil means that foo will act very blurgozely."
14572 :type 'boolean
14573 :group foo)
14574
14575 The type `boolean' means that this variable has only
14576 two meaningful states: nil and non-nil. Other type values
14577 describe other possibilities; see the manual for Custom
14578 for a description of them.
14579
14580 The "group" argument is used to specify a group which the option
14581 should belong to. You define a new group like this:
14582
14583 (defgroup ispell nil
14584 "Spell checking using Ispell."
14585 :group 'processes)
14586
14587 The "group" argument in defgroup specifies the parent group. The root
14588 group is called `emacs'; it should not contain any variables itself,
14589 but only other groups. The immediate subgroups of `emacs' correspond
14590 to the keywords used by C-h p. Under these subgroups come
14591 second-level subgroups that belong to individual packages.
14592
14593 Each Emacs package should have its own set of groups. A simple
14594 package should have just one group; a more complex package should
14595 have a hierarchy of its own groups. The sole or root group of a
14596 package should be a subgroup of one or more of the "keyword"
14597 first-level subgroups.
14598
14599 ** New `widget' library for inserting UI components in buffers.
14600
14601 This library, used by the new custom library, is documented in a
14602 separate manual that accompanies Emacs.
14603
14604 ** easy-mmode
14605
14606 The easy-mmode package provides macros and functions that make
14607 developing minor modes easier. Roughly, the programmer has to code
14608 only the functionality of the minor mode. All the rest--toggles,
14609 predicate, and documentation--can be done in one call to the macro
14610 `easy-mmode-define-minor-mode' (see the documentation). See also
14611 `easy-mmode-define-keymap'.
14612
14613 ** Text property changes
14614
14615 *** The `intangible' property now works on overlays as well as on a
14616 text property.
14617
14618 *** The new functions next-char-property-change and
14619 previous-char-property-change scan through the buffer looking for a
14620 place where either a text property or an overlay might change. The
14621 functions take two arguments, POSITION and LIMIT. POSITION is the
14622 starting position for the scan. LIMIT says where to stop the scan.
14623
14624 If no property change is found before LIMIT, the value is LIMIT. If
14625 LIMIT is nil, scan goes to the beginning or end of the accessible part
14626 of the buffer. If no property change is found, the value is the
14627 position of the beginning or end of the buffer.
14628
14629 *** In the `local-map' text property or overlay property, the property
14630 value can now be a symbol whose function definition is a keymap. This
14631 is an alternative to using the keymap itself.
14632
14633 ** Changes in invisibility features
14634
14635 *** Isearch can now temporarily show parts of the buffer which are
14636 hidden by an overlay with a invisible property, when the search match
14637 is inside that portion of the buffer. To enable this the overlay
14638 should have a isearch-open-invisible property which is a function that
14639 would be called having the overlay as an argument, the function should
14640 make the overlay visible.
14641
14642 During incremental search the overlays are shown by modifying the
14643 invisible and intangible properties, if beside this more actions are
14644 needed the overlay should have a isearch-open-invisible-temporary
14645 which is a function. The function is called with 2 arguments: one is
14646 the overlay and the second is nil when it should show the overlay and
14647 t when it should hide it.
14648
14649 *** add-to-invisibility-spec, remove-from-invisibility-spec
14650
14651 Modes that use overlays to hide portions of a buffer should set the
14652 invisible property of the overlay to the mode's name (or another symbol)
14653 and modify the `buffer-invisibility-spec' to include that symbol.
14654 Use `add-to-invisibility-spec' and `remove-from-invisibility-spec' to
14655 manipulate the `buffer-invisibility-spec'.
14656 Here is an example of how to do this:
14657
14658 ;; If we want to display an ellipsis:
14659 (add-to-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14660 ;; If you don't want ellipsis:
14661 (add-to-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14662
14663 ...
14664 (overlay-put (make-overlay beginning end) 'invisible 'my-symbol)
14665
14666 ...
14667 ;; When done with the overlays:
14668 (remove-from-invisibility-spec '(my-symbol . t))
14669 ;; Or respectively:
14670 (remove-from-invisibility-spec 'my-symbol)
14671
14672 ** Changes in syntax parsing.
14673
14674 *** The syntax-directed buffer-scan functions (such as
14675 `parse-partial-sexp', `forward-word' and similar functions) can now
14676 obey syntax information specified by text properties, if the variable
14677 `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil.
14678
14679 If the value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is nil, the behavior
14680 is as before: the syntax-table of the current buffer is always
14681 used to determine the syntax of the character at the position.
14682
14683 When `parse-sexp-lookup-properties' is non-nil, the syntax of a
14684 character in the buffer is calculated thus:
14685
14686 a) if the `syntax-table' text-property of that character
14687 is a cons, this cons becomes the syntax-type;
14688
14689 Valid values of `syntax-table' text-property are: nil, a valid
14690 syntax-table, and a valid syntax-table element, i.e.,
14691 a cons cell of the form (SYNTAX-CODE . MATCHING-CHAR).
14692
14693 b) if the character's `syntax-table' text-property
14694 is a syntax table, this syntax table is used
14695 (instead of the syntax-table of the current buffer) to
14696 determine the syntax type of the character.
14697
14698 c) otherwise the syntax-type is determined by the syntax-table
14699 of the current buffer.
14700
14701 *** The meaning of \s in regular expressions is also affected by the
14702 value of `parse-sexp-lookup-properties'. The details are the same as
14703 for the syntax-directed buffer-scan functions.
14704
14705 *** There are two new syntax-codes, `!' and `|' (numeric values 14
14706 and 15). A character with a code `!' starts a comment which is ended
14707 only by another character with the same code (unless quoted). A
14708 character with a code `|' starts a string which is ended only by
14709 another character with the same code (unless quoted).
14710
14711 These codes are mainly meant for use as values of the `syntax-table'
14712 text property.
14713
14714 *** The function `parse-partial-sexp' has new semantics for the sixth
14715 arg COMMENTSTOP. If it is `syntax-table', parse stops after the start
14716 of a comment or a string, or after end of a comment or a string.
14717
14718 *** The state-list which the return value from `parse-partial-sexp'
14719 (and can also be used as an argument) now has an optional ninth
14720 element: the character address of the start of last comment or string;
14721 nil if none. The fourth and eighth elements have special values if the
14722 string/comment is started by a "!" or "|" syntax-code.
14723
14724 *** Since new features of `parse-partial-sexp' allow a complete
14725 syntactic parsing, `font-lock' no longer supports
14726 `font-lock-comment-start-regexp'.
14727
14728 ** Changes in face features
14729
14730 *** The face functions are now unconditionally defined in Emacs, even
14731 if it does not support displaying on a device that supports faces.
14732
14733 *** The function face-documentation returns the documentation string
14734 of a face (or nil if it doesn't have one).
14735
14736 *** The function face-bold-p returns t if a face should be bold.
14737 set-face-bold-p sets that flag.
14738
14739 *** The function face-italic-p returns t if a face should be italic.
14740 set-face-italic-p sets that flag.
14741
14742 *** You can now specify foreground and background colors for text
14743 by adding elements of the form (foreground-color . COLOR-NAME)
14744 and (background-color . COLOR-NAME) to the list of faces in
14745 the `face' property (either the character's text property or an
14746 overlay property).
14747
14748 This means that you no longer need to create named faces to use
14749 arbitrary colors in a Lisp package.
14750
14751 ** Changes in file-handling functions
14752
14753 *** File-access primitive functions no longer discard an extra redundant
14754 directory name from the beginning of the file name. In other words,
14755 they no longer do anything special with // or /~. That conversion
14756 is now done only in substitute-in-file-name.
14757
14758 This makes it possible for a Lisp program to open a file whose name
14759 begins with ~.
14760
14761 *** If copy-file is unable to set the date of the output file,
14762 it now signals an error with the condition file-date-error.
14763
14764 *** The inode number returned by file-attributes may be an integer (if
14765 the number fits in a Lisp integer) or a list of integers.
14766
14767 *** insert-file-contents can now read from a special file,
14768 as long as the arguments VISIT and REPLACE are nil.
14769
14770 *** The RAWFILE arg to find-file-noselect, if non-nil, now suppresses
14771 character code conversion as well as other things.
14772
14773 Meanwhile, this feature does work with remote file names
14774 (formerly it did not).
14775
14776 *** Lisp packages which create temporary files should use the TMPDIR
14777 environment variable to decide which directory to put them in.
14778
14779 *** interpreter-mode-alist elements now specify regexps
14780 instead of constant strings.
14781
14782 *** expand-file-name no longer treats `//' or `/~' specially. It used
14783 to delete all the text of a file name up through the first slash of
14784 any `//' or `/~' sequence. Now it passes them straight through.
14785
14786 substitute-in-file-name continues to treat those sequences specially,
14787 in the same way as before.
14788
14789 *** The variable `format-alist' is more general now.
14790 The FROM-FN and TO-FN in a format definition can now be strings
14791 which specify shell commands to use as filters to perform conversion.
14792
14793 *** The new function access-file tries to open a file, and signals an
14794 error if that fails. If the open succeeds, access-file does nothing
14795 else, and returns nil.
14796
14797 *** The function insert-directory now signals an error if the specified
14798 directory cannot be listed.
14799
14800 ** Changes in minibuffer input
14801
14802 *** The functions read-buffer, read-variable, read-command, read-string
14803 read-file-name, read-from-minibuffer and completing-read now take an
14804 additional argument which specifies the default value. If this
14805 argument is non-nil, it should be a string; that string is used in two
14806 ways:
14807
14808 It is returned if the user enters empty input.
14809 It is available through the history command M-n.
14810
14811 *** The functions read-string, read-from-minibuffer,
14812 read-no-blanks-input and completing-read now take an additional
14813 argument INHERIT-INPUT-METHOD. If this is non-nil, then the
14814 minibuffer inherits the current input method and the setting of
14815 enable-multibyte-characters from the previously current buffer.
14816
14817 In an interactive spec, you can use M instead of s to read an
14818 argument in this way.
14819
14820 *** All minibuffer input functions discard text properties
14821 from the text you enter in the minibuffer, unless the variable
14822 minibuffer-allow-text-properties is non-nil.
14823
14824 ** Echo area features
14825
14826 *** Clearing the echo area now runs the normal hook
14827 echo-area-clear-hook. Note that the echo area can be used while the
14828 minibuffer is active; in that case, the minibuffer is still active
14829 after the echo area is cleared.
14830
14831 *** The function current-message returns the message currently displayed
14832 in the echo area, or nil if there is none.
14833
14834 ** Keyboard input features
14835
14836 *** tty-erase-char is a new variable that reports which character was
14837 set up as the terminal's erase character when time Emacs was started.
14838
14839 *** num-nonmacro-input-events is the total number of input events
14840 received so far from the terminal. It does not count those generated
14841 by keyboard macros.
14842
14843 ** Frame-related changes
14844
14845 *** make-frame runs the normal hook before-make-frame-hook just before
14846 creating a frame, and just after creating a frame it runs the abnormal
14847 hook after-make-frame-functions with the new frame as arg.
14848
14849 *** The new hook window-configuration-change-hook is now run every time
14850 the window configuration has changed. The frame whose configuration
14851 has changed is the selected frame when the hook is run.
14852
14853 *** Each frame now independently records the order for recently
14854 selected buffers, in its buffer-list frame parameter, so that the
14855 value of other-buffer is now based on the buffers recently displayed
14856 in the selected frame.
14857
14858 *** The value of the frame parameter vertical-scroll-bars
14859 is now `left', `right' or nil. A non-nil value specifies
14860 which side of the window to put the scroll bars on.
14861
14862 ** X Windows features
14863
14864 *** You can examine X resources for other applications by binding
14865 x-resource-class around a call to x-get-resource. The usual value of
14866 x-resource-class is "Emacs", which is the correct value for Emacs.
14867
14868 *** In menus, checkboxes and radio buttons now actually work.
14869 The menu displays the current status of the box or button.
14870
14871 *** The function x-list-fonts now takes an optional fourth argument
14872 MAXIMUM which sets a limit on how many matching fonts to return.
14873 A smaller value of MAXIMUM makes the function faster.
14874
14875 If the only question is whether *any* font matches the pattern,
14876 it is good to supply 1 for this argument.
14877
14878 ** Subprocess features
14879
14880 *** A reminder: it is no longer necessary for subprocess filter
14881 functions and sentinels to do save-match-data, because Emacs does this
14882 automatically.
14883
14884 *** The new function shell-command-to-string executes a shell command
14885 and returns the output from the command as a string.
14886
14887 *** The new function process-contact returns t for a child process,
14888 and (HOSTNAME SERVICE) for a net connection.
14889
14890 ** An error in running pre-command-hook or post-command-hook
14891 does clear the variable to nil. The documentation was wrong before.
14892
14893 ** In define-key-after, if AFTER is t, the new binding now always goes
14894 at the end of the keymap. If the keymap is a menu, this means it
14895 goes after the other menu items.
14896
14897 ** If you have a program that makes several changes in the same area
14898 of the buffer, you can use the macro combine-after-change-calls
14899 around that Lisp code to make it faster when after-change hooks
14900 are in use.
14901
14902 The macro arranges to call the after-change functions just once for a
14903 series of several changes--if that seems safe.
14904
14905 Don't alter the variables after-change-functions and
14906 after-change-function within the body of a combine-after-change-calls
14907 form.
14908
14909 ** If you define an abbrev (with define-abbrev) whose EXPANSION
14910 is not a string, then the abbrev does not expand in the usual sense,
14911 but its hook is still run.
14912
14913 ** Normally, the Lisp debugger is not used (even if you have enabled it)
14914 for errors that are handled by condition-case.
14915
14916 If you set debug-on-signal to a non-nil value, then the debugger is called
14917 regardless of whether there is a handler for the condition. This is
14918 useful for debugging problems that happen inside of a condition-case.
14919
14920 This mode of operation seems to be unreliable in other ways. Errors that
14921 are normal and ought to be handled, perhaps in timers or process
14922 filters, will instead invoke the debugger. So don't say you weren't
14923 warned.
14924
14925 ** The new variable ring-bell-function lets you specify your own
14926 way for Emacs to "ring the bell".
14927
14928 ** If run-at-time's TIME argument is t, the action is repeated at
14929 integral multiples of REPEAT from the epoch; this is useful for
14930 functions like display-time.
14931
14932 ** You can use the function locate-library to find the precise file
14933 name of a Lisp library. This isn't new, but wasn't documented before.
14934
14935 ** Commands for entering view mode have new optional arguments that
14936 can be used from Lisp. Low-level entrance to and exit from view mode
14937 is done by functions view-mode-enter and view-mode-exit.
14938
14939 ** batch-byte-compile-file now makes Emacs return a nonzero status code
14940 if there is an error in compilation.
14941
14942 ** pop-to-buffer, switch-to-buffer-other-window and
14943 switch-to-buffer-other-frame now accept an additional optional
14944 argument NORECORD, much like switch-to-buffer. If it is non-nil,
14945 they don't put the buffer at the front of the buffer list.
14946
14947 ** If your .emacs file leaves the *scratch* buffer non-empty,
14948 Emacs does not display the startup message, so as to avoid changing
14949 the *scratch* buffer.
14950
14951 ** The new function regexp-opt returns an efficient regexp to match a string.
14952 The arguments are STRINGS and (optionally) PAREN. This function can be used
14953 where regexp matching or searching is intensively used and speed is important,
14954 e.g., in Font Lock mode.
14955
14956 ** The variable buffer-display-count is local to each buffer,
14957 and is incremented each time the buffer is displayed in a window.
14958 It starts at 0 when the buffer is created.
14959
14960 ** The new function compose-mail starts composing a mail message
14961 using the user's chosen mail composition agent (specified with the
14962 variable mail-user-agent). It has variants compose-mail-other-window
14963 and compose-mail-other-frame.
14964
14965 ** The `user-full-name' function now takes an optional parameter which
14966 can either be a number (the UID) or a string (the login name). The
14967 full name of the specified user will be returned.
14968
14969 ** Lisp packages that load files of customizations, or any other sort
14970 of user profile, should obey the variable init-file-user in deciding
14971 where to find it. They should load the profile of the user name found
14972 in that variable. If init-file-user is nil, meaning that the -q
14973 option was used, then Lisp packages should not load the customization
14974 files at all.
14975
14976 ** format-time-string now allows you to specify the field width
14977 and type of padding. This works as in printf: you write the field
14978 width as digits in the middle of a %-construct. If you start
14979 the field width with 0, it means to pad with zeros.
14980
14981 For example, %S normally specifies the number of seconds since the
14982 minute; %03S means to pad this with zeros to 3 positions, %_3S to pad
14983 with spaces to 3 positions. Plain %3S pads with zeros, because that
14984 is how %S normally pads to two positions.
14985
14986 ** thing-at-point now supports a new kind of "thing": url.
14987
14988 ** imenu.el changes.
14989
14990 You can now specify a function to be run when selecting an
14991 item from menu created by imenu.
14992
14993 An example of using this feature: if we define imenu items for the
14994 #include directives in a C file, we can open the included file when we
14995 select one of those items.
14996
14997 * For older news, see the file ONEWS
14998
14999 ---------------------------------------------------------------------- 5755 ----------------------------------------------------------------------
15000 Copyright information: 5756 Copyright information:
15001 5757
15002 Copyright (C) 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 5758 Copyright (C) 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006
15003 2005, 2006 Free Software Foundation, Inc. 5759 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
15004 5760
15005 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies 5761 Permission is granted to anyone to make or distribute verbatim copies
15006 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the 5762 of this document as received, in any medium, provided that the
15007 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved, 5763 copyright notice and this permission notice are preserved,
15008 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn. 5764 thus giving the recipient permission to redistribute in turn.